INTERPOOL INC
S-4, 1998-06-04
EQUIPMENT RENTAL & LEASING, NEC
Previous: TR FINANCIAL CORP, SC 13D, 1998-06-04
Next: HARRYS FARMERS MARKET INC, S-8, 1998-06-04




      As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 4,1998
                               REGISTRATION STATEMENT NO. 333-_______________
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------


                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

                             WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
                              --------------------

                                    FORM S-4

                             REGISTRATION STATEMENT

                                      UNDER

                           THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

                              --------------------

                                 INTERPOOL, INC.
             (Exact name of registrant is specified in its charter)

DELAWARE                       7359
(State or other                 6159                         13-3467669
jurisdiction              (Primary Standard                (I.R.S. Employer
of incorporation       Industrial Classification         Identification Number)
organization)               Code No.)

                            ------------------------
                              211 COLLEGE ROAD EAST
                           PRINCETON, NEW JERSEY 08540
                                 (609) 452-8900
               (Address, including zip code, and telephone number,
        including area code, of registrant's principal executive offices)

                                 MARTIN TUCHMAN
                      CHAIRMAN AND CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER
                                 Interpool, Inc.
                              211 College Road East
                           Princeton, New Jersey 08540
                                 (609) 452-8900
            (Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number,
                   including area code, of agent for service)

                                   Copies to:


                           JEFFREY S. LOWENTHAL, ESQ.
                          Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP
                                 180 Maiden Lane
                            New York, New York 10038


                       APPROXIMATE DATE OF COMMENCEMENT OF
                 PROPOSED SALE TO PUBLIC: As soon as practicable
                    after this Registration Statement becomes
                                   effective.

          If the only securities being registered on this form are being in
connection with the formation of a holding company and there is compliance with
General Instruction G, check the following box. |_|

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                        CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
========================================================================================================================
TITLE OF EACH CLASS OF               AMOUNT TO             PROPOSED             PROPOSED                  AMOUNT OF
  SECURITIES TO BE                 BE REGISTERED       MAXIMUM AGGREGATE     MAXIMUM AGGREGATE         REGISTRATION FEE
    REGISTERED                                         PRICE PER UNIT (1)    OFFERING PRICE (1)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                 <C>                       <C>               <C>                       <C>    
6 5/8%  Notes due 2003              $100,000,000              100%              $100,000,000              $29,500.00
========================================================================================================================
<FN>
(1)      Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the registration fee
         pursuant to Rule 457(f).
</FN>
</TABLE>


          THE REGISTRANT HEREBY AMENDS THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON SUCH DATE
OR DATES AS MAY BE NECESSARY TO DELAY ITS EFFECTIVE DATE UNTIL THE REGISTRANT
SHALL FILE A FURTHER AMENDMENT WHICH SPECIFICALLY STATES THAT THIS REGISTRATION
STATEMENT SHALL THEREAFTER BECOME EFFECTIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 8(A) OF
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933 OR UNTIL THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL BECOME
EFFECTIVE ON SUCH DATE AS THE COMMISSION, ACTING PURSUANT TO SAID SECTION 8(A),
MAY DETERMINE.

- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<PAGE>

Information contained herein is subject to completion or amendment. A
registration statement relating to these securities has been filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission. These securities may not be sold nor may
offers to buy be accepted prior to the time the registration statement becomes
effective. This prospectus shall not constitute an offer to sell or the
solicitation of an offer to buy nor shall there be any sale of these securities
in any jurisdiction in which such offer, solicitation or sale would be unlawful
prior to the registration or qualification under the securities laws of any such
jurisdiction.

<PAGE>

                SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED JUNE 4, 1998
PROSPECTUS
                                 INTERPOOL, INC.
                                OFFER TO EXCHANGE
                              6 5/8% NOTES DUE 2003
                           FOR ANY AND ALL OUTSTANDING
                              6 5/8% NOTES DUE 2003

          THE EXCHANGE OFFER WILL EXPIRE AT 5:00 P.M., NEW YORK CITY TIME, ON
___________, ____________, 1998, UNLESS EXTENDED BY INTERPOOL, INC. As more
fully described herein under "The Exchange Offer--Expiration Date; Extensions;
Amendment," the time the Exchange Offer expires (including extensions, if any,
by the Company) is referred to as the "Expiration Date."

          Interpool, Inc., a Delaware corporation ("Interpool" or the
"Company"), is hereby offering (the "Exchange Offer"), upon the terms and
subject to the conditions set forth in this prospectus (the "Prospectus") and
the accompanying letter of transmittal (the "Letter of Transmittal"), to
exchange $1,000 principal amount of its 6 5/8% Notes due 2003 (the "Exchange
Notes"), which exchange has been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended (the "Securities Act") pursuant to a registration statement of which
this Prospectus is a part (the "Registration Statement"), for each $1,000
principal amount of its outstanding 6 5/8% Notes due 2003 (the "Private Notes"
and, collectively with the Exchange Notes, the "Notes"), of which $100,000,000
aggregate principal amount was issued and sold in a transaction exempt from
registration under the Securities Act and is outstanding on the date hereof.

          The form and terms of the Exchange Notes are substantially identical
in all respects (including principal amount, interest rate, maturity and
ranking) to the form and terms of the Private Notes, except that (i) the
Exchange Notes will have been registered under the Securities Act and,
therefore, will not bear legends restricting the transfer thereof, (ii) the
Exchange Notes will not provide for payment of additional distributions thereon,
and (iii) holders of the Exchange Notes will not be entitled to certain rights
of holders of the Private Notes under the Registration Rights Agreements (as
defined herein), which rights will terminate upon consummation of the Exchange
Offer. The Exchange Notes will evidence the same indebtedness as the Private
Notes and will be issued pursuant to, and entitled to the benefits of, the
Indenture (as defined herein) governing the Private Notes. The Exchange Offer is
being made to satisfy the obligations of the Company under the Registration
Rights Agreement relating to the Private Notes. See "The Exchange Offer" and
"Description of Exchange Notes."

          The Exchange Notes will bear interest at the rate of 6 5/8% per annum.
Interest on the Exchange Notes will be payable semiannually on September 1 and
March 1 of each year, commencing September 1, 1998. The Exchange Notes will bear
interest from and including the date of issuance of the Private Notes (February
24, 1998). The Exchange Notes will mature on March 1, 2003. The Exchange Notes
will be redeemable at any time at the option of the Company, in whole or from
time to time in part, at a redemption price equal to the sum of (i) the
principal amount of the Exchange Notes being redeemed plus accrued interest
thereon to the redemption date and (ii) the Make-Whole Amount (as defined
herein), if any. The Exchange Notes will be unsecured obligations of the Company
and will rank equally with all unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness of the
Company. See "Description of Notes."
                          ---------------------------

          SEE "RISK FACTORS BEGINNING ON PAGE 15 HEREOF FOR CERTAIN INFORMATION
RELEVANT TO AN INVESTMENT IN THE NOTES.
                          ---------------------------

  THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
       EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE
           SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES
            COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS
               PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A
                               CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
                           ---------------------------

              The date of this Prospectus is _______________, 1998

<PAGE>

          The Private Notes were originally issued and sold in reliance upon the
exemption provided in Section 4(2) of the Securities Act and Rule 144A of the
Securities Act. Accordingly, the Private Notes may not be reoffered, resold or
otherwise pledged, hypothecated or transferred in the United States or to a U.S.
person unless registered under the Securities Act or unless an applicable
exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act is available.
Based on an interpretation by the staff of the Commission set forth in no-action
letters issued to third parties, the Company believes that the Exchange Notes
issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer in exchange for Private Notes may be
offered for resale, resold and otherwise transferred by a holder thereof (other
than (i) an "affiliate" of the Company within the meaning of Rule 405 under the
Securities Act, (ii) a broker-dealer who acquired Private Notes directly from
the Company to resell pursuant to Rule 144A or any other available exemption
under the Securities Act or (iii) a broker-dealer who acquired Private Notes as
a result of market making or other trading activities), without compliance with
the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act;
PROVIDED that the holder is acquiring Exchange Notes in the ordinary course of
its business and is not participating, and has no arrangement or understanding
with any person to participate, in the distribution of the Exchange Notes.
Holders of Private Notes wishing to accept the Exchange Offer must represent to
the Company, as required by the Registration Rights Agreement, that such
conditions have been met. The Company believes that none of the registered
holders of the Private Notes is an affiliate (as such term is defined in Rule
405 under the Securities Act) of the Company.

          Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account in
exchange for Private Notes must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in
connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes. The Letter of Transmittal
states that by so acknowledging and by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer
will not be deemed to admit that it is an "underwriter" within the meaning of
the Securities Act. This Prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from
time to time, may be used by a broker-dealer in connection with resales of
Exchange Notes received in exchange for Private Notes, where such Private Notes
were acquired by such broker-dealer as a result of market-making or other
trading activities. The Company has agreed to make this Prospectus (as it may be
amended or supplemented) available to any broker-dealer, upon request, for use
in connection with any such resale, for a period of one year after the
Registration Statement is declared effective by the Commission or until such
earlier date on which all the Exchange Notes are freely tradeable. However, any
broker-dealer who acquired the Private Notes directly from the Company may not
fulfill its prospectus delivery requirements with this Prospectus, but must
comply with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the
Securities Act. See "The Exchange Offer--Resale of the Exchange Notes" and "Plan
of Distribution."

          The Company will not receive any proceeds from, and has agreed to bear
the expenses of, the Exchange Offer. No underwriter is being used in connection
with the Exchange Offer. See "The Exchange Offer--Resale of the Exchange Notes."

          Prior to the Exchange Offer, there has been no public market for the
Notes. The Exchange Notes will not be listed on any securities exchange. There
can be no assurance that an active market for the Notes will develop. To the
extent that a market for the Notes does develop the market value of the Notes
will depend on market conditions (such as yields on alternative investments),
general economic conditions, the Company's financial condition and certain other
factors. Such conditions might cause the Notes, to the extent they are traded,
to trade at a significant discount from face value. In addition, any Private
Notes not tendered and accepted in the Exchange Offer will remain outstanding.
To the extent that the Private Notes are tendered and accepted in the Exchange
Offer, a holder's ability to sell untendered, and tendered but unaccepted,
Private Notes could be adversely affected. Following consummation of the
Exchange Offer, the holders of Private Notes will continue to be subject to the
existing restrictions on transfer thereof and the Company will not have any
further obligation to such holders to provide for the registration under the
Securities Act of the Private Notes except under certain limited circumstances.
See "The Exchange Offer--Termination of Certain Rights."

          The Company will accept for exchange any and all validly tendered
Private Notes not withdrawn prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the
Expiration Date. Tenders of Private Notes may be withdrawn at any time prior to
5:00 p.m., New York City Time, on the Expiration Date. The Exchange Offer is not
conditioned on any minimum aggregate principal amount of Private Notes being
tendered or accepted for exchange; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, Private Notes may be
tendered only in integral multiples of $1,000. The Exchange Offer is subject to
certain customary conditions. See "The Exchange Offer--Conditions."

                           ---------------------------

<PAGE>

        THE EXCHANGE OFFER IS NOT BEING MADE TO, NOR WILL THE COMPANY ACCEPT
SURRENDERS FOR EXCHANGE FROM, HOLDERS OF PRIVATE NOTES IN ANY JURISDICTION IN
WHICH THE EXCHANGE OFFER OR THE ACCEPTANCE THEREOF WOULD NOT BE IN COMPLIANCE
WITH THE SECURITIES OR BLUE SKY LAWS OF SUCH JURISDICTION.

          NO PERSON IS AUTHORIZED IN CONNECTION WITH THE EXCHANGE OFFER TO GIVE
ANY INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATION NOT CONTAINED IN THIS PROSPECTUS
OR THE ACCOMPANYING LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL, AND, IF GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH OTHER
INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATION MUST NOT BE RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN AUTHORIZED
BY THE COMPANY. THE INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IS AS OF THE DATE HEREOF AND
SUBJECT TO CHANGE, COMPLETION OR AMENDMENT WITHOUT NOTICE. NEITHER THE DELIVERY
OF THIS PROSPECTUS OR THE ACCOMPANYING LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL AT ANY TIME NOR ANY
EXCHANGE MADE HEREUNDER SHALL UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES CREATE ANY IMPLICATION
THAT THE INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN OR THEREIN IS CORRECT AS OF ANY DATE
SUBSEQUENT TO THE DATE HEREOF.

          IN MAKING AN INVESTMENT DECISION REGARDING THE SECURITIES OFFERED
HEREBY, PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS MUST RELY ON THEIR OWN EXAMINATION OF THE COMPANY
AND THE TERMS OF THE OFFERING, INCLUDING THE MERITS AND RISKS INVOLVED. THE
OFFERING IS BEING MADE ON THE BASIS OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY DECISION TO EXCHANGE
NOTES IN THE EXCHANGE OFFER MUST BE BASED ON THE INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN.

          Except as described herein, the Exchange Notes will be represented by
global Exchange Notes in fully registered form, deposited with a custodian for
and registered in the name of a nominee of The Depository Trust Company ("DTC").
Beneficial interests in such Exchange Notes will be shown on, and transfers
thereof will be effected through, records maintained by DTC and its
participants. Beneficial interests in such Exchange Notes will trade in DTC's
Same-Day Funds Settlement System and secondary market trading activity in such
interests will therefore settle in immediately available funds.

                                TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                                                          PAGE

Available Information.......................................................4
Incorporation Of Certain Documents By Reference.............................5
Forward Looking Statements..................................................5
Prospectus Summary..........................................................6
Risk Factors...............................................................15
Ratio Of Earnings To Fixed Charges.........................................19
Use Of Proceeds............................................................19
Capitalization.............................................................20
Business...................................................................21
The Exchange Offer.........................................................30
Description Of Exchange Notes..............................................38
Description Of Private Notes...............................................47
Certain Federal Income Tax Considerations..................................48
ERISA Considerations.......................................................48
Plan Of Distribution.......................................................48
Legal Matters..............................................................49
Experts....................................................................50

<PAGE>

                              AVAILABLE INFORMATION

          The Company is subject to the informational requirements of the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"), and in
accordance therewith files reports, proxy statements and other information with
the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission"). Reports, proxy
statements and other information filed by the Company with the Commission can be
inspected and copied at the public reference facilities maintained by the
Commission at Room 1024, 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549 and at
the Commission's regional offices located at Seven World Trade Center, New York,
New York 10048, and Suite 1400, Northwestern Atrium Center, 500 West Madison
Street, Chicago, Illinois 60661. Copies of such materials can be obtained from
the Public Reference Section of the Commission at Room 1024, 450 Fifth Street,
N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549, at prescribed rates. Such materials can also be
inspected at the New York Stock Exchange, 20 Broad Street, New York, New York
10005. The Commission maintains an Internet web site that contains reports,
proxy and information statements and other information regarding Issuers who
file electronically with the Commission. The address of that site is
http://www.sec.gov.

          The Company has filed with the Commission a Registration Statement on
Form S-4 (together with all amendments, exhibits, annexes and schedules thereto,
the "Registration Statement") pursuant to the Securities Act, and the rules and
regulations promulgated thereunder, with respect to the securities being offered
hereby. This Prospectus does not contain all the information set forth in the
Registration Statement, certain parts of which are omitted in accordance with
the rules and regulations of the Commission. For further information with
respect to the Company and the securities offered hereby, reference is made to
the Registration Statement, including the exhibits filed as a part thereof and
otherwise incorporated therein. Statements made in this Prospectus as to the
contents of any contract, agreement or other document referred to are
necessarily summaries of the material elements of such contract, agreement or
document, and with respect to each contract, agreement or other document filed
as an exhibit to the Registration Statement, reference is made to such exhibit
for a more complete description of the matter involved. Each such statement
shall be deemed qualified in its entirety by such reference. Copies of the
Registration Statement and the exhibits may be inspected, without charge, at the
offices of the Commission, or obtained at prescribed rates from the Public
Reference Section of the Commission at the address set forth above.

<PAGE>

                 INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE

          The following documents previously filed with the Commission by the
Company pursuant to the Exchange Act are incorporated by reference in this
Prospectus and made a part hereof:

          (a)  the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year
               ended December 31, 1997;

          (b)  the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended
               March 31, 1998;

          (c)  the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K dated February 24, 1998;
               and

          (d)  the Company's Proxy Statement dated April 20, 1998 in connection
               with the Company's Annual Meeting of Stockholders in 1998.

          All documents filed by the Company pursuant to Sections 13(a), 13(c),
14 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act subsequent to the date hereof and prior to the
termination of the Offering shall be deemed to be incorporated by reference
herein and to be a part hereof from the date of filing of such documents. Any
statement contained in a document incorporated or deemed to be incorporated by
reference herein shall be deemed to be modified or superseded for purposes of
this Prospectus to the extent that a statement contained herein or in any other
subsequently filed document which is also incorporated or deemed to be
incorporated by reference herein modifies, supersedes or replaces such
statement. Any statement so modified or superseded shall not be deemed, except
as so modified or superseded, to constitute a part of this Prospectus.

          The Company will provide without charge to any person to whom this
Prospectus is delivered, upon written or oral request of such person, a copy of
any or all of the documents which have been incorporated by reference in this
Prospectus, other than exhibits to such documents, unless such exhibits are
specifically incorporated by reference into the documents so incorporated. Any
such request should be directed to Interpool, Inc., 211 College Road East,
Princeton, New Jersey 08540, Attention: Investor Relations. Telephone requests
may be directed to (609) 452-8900.

                           FORWARD LOOKING STATEMENTS

          This Prospectus, including certain information incorporated by
reference herein, contains certain forward-looking statements within the meaning
of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. These forward-looking
statements are subject to risks and uncertainties that could cause actual
results to differ materially from those contemplated in such forward-looking
statements, including in particular the risks and uncertainties described under
"Risk Factors." See also "The Company," "Summary Financial Data" and
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations" (incorporated by reference). Prospective investors are cautioned not
to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements, which speak only as
of the date hereof. The Company undertakes no obligation to publicly release any
revisions to these forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances
after the date hereof or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events.

<PAGE>

                               PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

          THE FOLLOWING SUMMARY IS QUALIFIED IN ITS ENTIRETY BY THE MORE
DETAILED INFORMATION AND FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, INCLUDING THE NOTES THERETO,
APPEARING ELSEWHERE OR INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE IN THIS PROSPECTUS. UNLESS THE
CONTEXT OTHERWISE REQUIRES, ALL REFERENCES HEREIN TO THE "COMPANY" OR
"INTERPOOL" INCLUDE INTERPOOL, INC. AND ITS SUBSIDIARIES.

                                   THE COMPANY

          Interpool is one of the world's leading lessors of intermodal dry
freight standard containers and is the second largest lessor of intermodal
container chassis in the United States. At March 31, 1998, the Company's
container fleet totaled approximately 435,000 twenty-foot equivalent units
("TEUs"), the industry standard measure of dimension for containers used in
international trade, and its chassis fleet totaled approximately 65,000 chassis.
The Company leases its containers and chassis to over 200 customers, including
nearly all of the world's 20 largest international container shipping lines.

          The Company focuses on leasing dry freight standard containers and
container chassis on a long-term basis in order to achieve high utilization of
its equipment and stable and predictable earnings. From 1991 through 1994, the
combined utilization rate of the Company's container and chassis fleets averaged
at least 90%. From 1995 through 1997, the combined utilization rate of the
Company's container and chassis fleets was approximately 97% and at March 31,
1998 such rate was approximately 98%. Substantially all of the Company's newly
acquired equipment is leased on a long-term basis, and at March 31, 1998
approximately 93% of its total equipment fleet is currently leased on this
basis. The remainder of the Company's equipment is leased under short-term
agreements to satisfy customers' peak or seasonal requirements, generally at
higher rates than under long-term leases. The Company concentrates on dry
freight standard containers and chassis because such equipment may be more
readily remarketed upon expiration of a lease than specialized equipment. In
financing its equipment acquisitions, the Company generally seeks to meet debt
service requirements from the leasing revenue generated by its equipment.

          The Company conducts its container and chassis leasing business
through two subsidiaries, Interpool Limited and Trac Lease, Inc. ("Trac Lease").
Certain other United States equipment leasing activities are conducted through
Interpool itself. The Company and its predecessors have been involved in the
leasing of containers and chassis since 1968.

          The Company leases containers throughout the world, with particular
emphasis on the Pacific Rim. The Company leases chassis to customers for use in
the United States. The Company maintains contact with its customers through a
worldwide network of offices, agents and sales representatives. The Company
believes one of the key factors in its ability to compete effectively has been
the long-standing relationships management has established with most of the
world's large shipping lines. In addition, Interpool relies on its strong credit
rating and low financing costs to maintain its competitive position.

          From time to time the Company considers possible acquisitions of
complementary businesses and asset portfolios.

<PAGE>

                               THE EXCHANGE OFFER

The Exchange Offer..................     The Company is hereby offering to
                                         exchange $1,000 principal amount of
                                         Exchange Notes for each $1,000
                                         principal amount of Private Notes that
                                         are properly tendered and accepted.
                                         Private Notes may be tendered for
                                         exchange in multiples of $1,000. The
                                         Company will issue Exchange Notes on or
                                         promptly after the Expiration Date. As
                                         of the date hereof, $100,000,000
                                         aggregate principal amount of Private
                                         Notes are outstanding. See "The
                                         Exchange Offer--Purpose of the Exchange
                                         Offer."

                                         Based on an interpretation by the staff
                                         of the Commission set forth in
                                         no-action letters issued to third
                                         parties, the Company believes that the
                                         Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the
                                         Exchange Offer in exchange for Private
                                         Notes may be offered for resale, resold
                                         and otherwise transferred by a holder
                                         thereof (other than (i) an "affiliate"
                                         of the Company within the meaning of
                                         Rule 405 under the Securities Act, (ii)
                                         a broker-dealer who acquired Private
                                         Notes directly from the Company to
                                         resell pursuant to Rule 144A or any
                                         other available exemption under the
                                         Securities Act or (iii) a broker-dealer
                                         who acquired Private Notes as a result
                                         of market making or other trading
                                         activities), without compliance with
                                         the registration and prospectus
                                         delivery requirements of the Securities
                                         Act; PROVIDED that the holder is
                                         acquiring Exchange Notes in the
                                         ordinary course of its business and is
                                         not participating, and has no
                                         arrangement or understanding with any
                                         person to participate, in the
                                         distribution of the Exchange Notes.
                                         Holders of Private Notes wishing to
                                         accept the Exchange Offer must
                                         represent to the Company, as required
                                         by the Registration Rights Agreement,
                                         that such conditions have been met. The
                                         Company believes that none of the
                                         registered holders of the Private Notes
                                         is an affiliate (as such term is
                                         defined in Rule 405 under the
                                         Securities Act) of the Company.

                                         Each broker-dealer that receives
                                         Exchange Notes for its own account in
                                         exchange for Private Notes must
                                         acknowledge that it will deliver a
                                         prospectus in connection with any
                                         resale of such Exchange Notes. The
                                         Letter of Transmittal states that by so
                                         acknowledging and by delivering a
                                         prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be
                                         deemed to admit that it is an
                                         "underwriter" within the meaning of the
                                         Securities Act. This Prospectus, as it
                                         may be amended or supplemented from
                                         time to time, may be used by a
                                         broker-dealer in connection with
                                         resales of Exchange Notes received in
                                         exchange for Private Notes, where such
                                         Private Notes were acquired by such
                                         broker-dealer as a result of
                                         market-making or other trading
                                         activities. The Company has agreed to
                                         make this Prospectus (as it may be
                                         amended or supplemented) available to
                                         any broker-dealer, upon request, for
                                         use in connection with any such resale,
                                         for a period of one year after the
                                         Registration Statement is declared
                                         effective by the Commission or until
                                         such earlier date on which all the
                                         Exchange Notes are freely tradeable.
                                         However, any broker-dealer who acquired
                                         the Private Notes directly from the
                                         Company other than as a result of
                                         market-making activities or ordinary
                                         trading activities may not fulfill its
                                         prospectus delivery requirements with
                                         this Prospectus, but must comply with
                                         the registration and prospectus
                                         delivery requirements of the Securities
                                         Act. See "The Exchange Offer--Resale of
                                         the Exchange Notes."

Registration Rights Agreement.......     The Private Notes were sold by the
                                         Company on February 24, 1998 to
                                         Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities
                                         Corporation (the "Initial Purchaser")
                                         pursuant to a Purchase Agreement, dated
                                         February 19, 1998, by and between the
                                         Company and the Initial Purchaser (the
                                         "Purchase Agreement"). Pursuant to the
                                         Purchase Agreement, the Company and the
                                         Initial Purchaser entered into a
                                         Registration Rights Agreement, dated as
                                         of February 24, 1998 (the "Registration
                                         Rights Agreement"), which grants the
                                         holders of the Private Notes certain
                                         exchange and registration rights. The
                                         Exchange Offer is intended to satisfy
                                         such rights, which will terminate upon
                                         the consummation of the Exchange Offer
                                         except under certain limited
                                         circumstances. See "The Exchange
                                         Offer--Termination of Certain Rights."

                                         Holders of Private Notes who do not
                                         tender their Private Notes in the
                                         Exchange Offer will continue to hold
                                         such Private Notes and will be entitled
                                         to all the rights and limitations
                                         applicable thereto under the Indenture.
                                         All untendered, and tendered but not
                                         unaccepted Private Notes will continue
                                         to be subject to the restrictions on
                                         transfer provided for in the Private
                                         Notes and the Indenture. To the extent
                                         that Private Notes are tendered and
                                         accepted in the Exchange Offer, the
                                         trading market, if any, for the Private
                                         Notes could be adversely affected.

Expiration Date.....................     The Exchange Offer will expire at 5:00
                                         p.m., New York City time, on
                                         _____________, 1998, unless the
                                         Exchange Offer is extended by the
                                         Company, in its sole discretion, in
                                         which case the term "Expiration Date"
                                         shall mean the latest date and time to
                                         which the Exchange Offer is extended.
                                         See "The Exchange Offer--Expiration
                                         Date; Extensions; Amendments."

Accrued Interest on the
   Exchange Notes and the
   Private Notes..................       The Exchange Notes will bear interest
                                         from and including the date of issuance
                                         of the Private Notes (February 24,
                                         1998). Holders whose Private Notes are
                                         accepted for exchange will be deemed to
                                         have waived the right to receive any
                                         interest accrued on the Private Notes.
                                         See "The Exchange Offer --
                                         Distributions on Exchange Notes."

Conditions to the Exchange
   Offer..........................       The Exchange Offer is subject to
                                         certain customary conditions that may
                                         be waived by the Company. The Exchange
                                         Offer is not conditioned upon any
                                         minimum principal amount of Private
                                         Notes being tendered for exchange. See
                                         "The Exchange Offer--Conditions."

Procedures for Tendering
     Private Notes.................      Each Holder of Private Notes wishing to
                                         accept the Exchange Offer must
                                         complete, sign and date the Letter of
                                         Transmittal, or a facsimile thereof, in
                                         accordance with the instructions
                                         contained herein and therein, and mail
                                         or otherwise deliver such Letter of
                                         Transmittal, or such facsimile,
                                         together with such Private Notes and
                                         any other required documentation to
                                         United States Trust Company of New
                                         York, as exchange agent (the "Exchange
                                         Agent") at its address set forth
                                         herein. By executing the Letter of
                                         Transmittal, the holder will represent
                                         to and agree with the Company that,
                                         among other things, (i) the Exchange
                                         Notes to be acquired by such holder of
                                         Private Notes in connection with the
                                         Exchange Offer are being acquired by
                                         such holder in the ordinary course of
                                         its business, (ii) such holder is not
                                         currently participating and has no
                                         arrangement or understanding with any
                                         person to participate in a distribution
                                         of the Exchange Notes, (iii) if such
                                         holder is a broker-dealer registered
                                         under the Exchange Act or is
                                         participating in the Exchange Offer for
                                         the purposes of distributing the
                                         Exchange Notes, such holder will comply
                                         with the registration and prospectus
                                         delivery requirements of the Securities
                                         Act in connection with a secondary
                                         resale transaction of the Exchange
                                         Notes acquired by such person and
                                         cannot rely on the position of the
                                         staff of the Commission set forth in
                                         no-action letters (see "The Exchange
                                         Offer--Resale of Exchange Notes"), (iv)
                                         such holder understands that a
                                         secondary resale transaction described
                                         in clause (iii) above and any resales
                                         of Exchange Notes obtained by such
                                         holder in exchange for Private Notes
                                         acquired by such holder directly from
                                         the Company should be covered by an
                                         effective registration statement
                                         containing the selling securityholder
                                         information required by Item 507 of
                                         Regulation S-K of the Commission and
                                         (v) such holder is not an "affiliate,"
                                         as defined in Rule 405 under the
                                         Securities Act, of the Company. If the
                                         holder is a broker-dealer that will
                                         receive Exchange Notes for its own
                                         account in exchange for Private Notes
                                         that were acquired as a result of
                                         market-making activities or other
                                         trading activities, such holder will be
                                         required to acknowledge in the Letter
                                         of Transmittal that such holder will
                                         deliver a prospectus in connection with
                                         any resale of such Exchange Notes;
                                         however, by so acknowledging and by
                                         delivering a prospectus, such holder
                                         will not be deemed to admit that it is
                                         an "underwriter" within the meaning of
                                         the Securities Act. See "The Exchange
                                         Offer- -Procedures for Tendering."

Special Procedures for
   Beneficial Owners................     Any beneficial owner whose Private
                                         Notes are registered in the name of a
                                         broker, commercial bank, trust company
                                         or other nominee and who wishes to
                                         tender such Private Notes in the
                                         Exchange Offer should contact such
                                         registered holder promptly and instruct
                                         such registered holder to tender on
                                         such beneficial owner's behalf. If such
                                         beneficial owner wishes to tender on
                                         such owner's own behalf, such owner
                                         must, prior to completing and executing
                                         the Letter of Transmittal and
                                         delivering such owner's Private Notes,
                                         either make appropriate arrangements to
                                         register ownership of the Private Notes
                                         in such owner's name or obtain a
                                         properly completed bond power from the
                                         registered holder. The transfer of
                                         registered ownership may take
                                         considerable time and may not be able
                                         to be completed prior to the Expiration
                                         Date. See "The Exchange
                                         Offer--Procedures for Tendering."

Guaranteed Delivery
   Procedures......................      Holders of Private Notes who wish to
                                         tender their Private Notes and whose
                                         Private Notes are not immediately
                                         available or who cannot deliver their
                                         Private Notes, the Letter of
                                         Transmittal or any other documentation
                                         required by the Letter of Transmittal
                                         to the Exchange Agent prior to the
                                         Expiration Date must tender their
                                         Private Notes according to the
                                         guaranteed delivery procedures set
                                         forth under "The Exchange
                                         Offer--Guaranteed Delivery Procedures."

Acceptance of the Private
   Securities and Delivery
   of the Exchange Capital
   Securities.......................     Subject to the satisfaction or waiver
                                         of the conditions to the Exchange
                                         Offer, the Company will accept for
                                         exchange any and all Private Notes that
                                         are properly tendered in the Exchange
                                         Offer prior to the Expiration Date. The
                                         Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the
                                         Exchange Offer will be delivered on the
                                         earliest practicable date following the
                                         Expiration Date. See "The Exchange
                                         Offer--Terms of the Exchange Offer."

Withdrawal Rights..................      Tenders of Private Notes may be
                                         withdrawn at any time prior to the
                                         Expiration Date.  See "The Exchange
                                         Offer--Withdrawal of Tenders."

Certain Federal Income Tax
   Considerations..................      For a discussion of certain material
                                         federal income tax considerations
                                         relating to the exchange of the
                                         Exchange Notes for the Private Notes,
                                         see "Certain Federal Income Tax
                                         Considerations."

Exchange Agent.....................      United States Trust Company of New York
                                         is serving as the Exchange Agent in
                                         connection with the Exchange Offer.

Use of Proceeds....................      The Company will not receive any cash
                                         proceeds from the issuance of the
                                         Exchange Notes offered hereby. See "Use
                                         of Proceeds."

Risk Factors.......................      Investors should carefully consider the
                                         risk factors relating to the Company
                                         and the Exchange Offer described on
                                         pages 15 through 18 of this Prospectus.

                           TERMS OF THE EXCHANGE NOTES

          The Exchange Offer applies to $100,000,000 aggregate principal amount
of the Private Notes. The form and terms of the Exchange Notes are substantially
identical in all respects (including principal amount, interest rate, maturity
and ranking) to the form and terms of the Private Notes, except that (i) the
Exchange Notes will have been registered under the Securities Act and,
therefore, will not bear legends restricting the transfer thereof, (ii) the
Exchange Notes will not provide for payment of additional distributions thereon,
and (iii) holders of the Exchange Notes will not be entitled to certain rights
of holders of the Private Notes under the Registration Rights Agreement, which
rights will terminate upon consummation of the Exchange Offer. The Exchange
Notes will evidence the same obligations as the Private Notes and will be issued
pursuant to, and entitled to the benefits of, the Indenture governing the
Private Notes. The Exchange Offer is being made to satisfy the obligations of
the Company under the Registration Rights Agreement relating to the Private
Notes. For further information and for definitions of certain capitalized terms
used below, see "The Exchange Offer" and "Description of the Exchange Notes."

Securities Offered..................     $100,000,000 of 6 5/8% Exchange Notes
                                         due 2003.

Interest ...........................     The Exchange Notes will bear interest
                                         at the rate of 6 5/8% per annum.

Interest Payment Dates..............     Interest will be payable semi-annually
                                         on March 1 and September 1, commencing
                                         September 1, 1998.

Maturity ...........................     March 1, 2003 (5 years).

Optional Redemption.................     The Exchange Notes will be redeemable
                                         at any time at the option of the
                                         Company, in whole or from time to time
                                         in part, at a redemption price equal to
                                         the sum of (i) the principal amount of
                                         the Exchange Notes being redeemed plus
                                         accrued interest thereon to the
                                         redemption date and (ii) the Make-Whole
                                         Amount, if any. See "Description of
                                         Exchange Notes--Optional Redemption by
                                         the Company."

Mandatory Redemption................     The Company is not required to make
                                         any mandatory redemption or annual
                                         sinking fund payments.

Ranking.............................     The Exchange Notes will be general
                                         unsecured obligations of the Company
                                         and will rank equally with the
                                         Company's other unsecured and
                                         unsubordinated indebtedness.

Certain Covenants...................     The Company will not create, incur or
                                         assume any Lien (as defined herein) on
                                         any assets of the Company unless the
                                         Exchange Notes are equally and ratably
                                         secured with the other obligations
                                         secured by such Lien, so long as such
                                         obligations shall be so secured;
                                         PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that such
                                         restriction will not apply if at the
                                         time of, and immediately after giving
                                         PRO FORMA effect to, the transaction
                                         giving rise to such lien, the
                                         Consolidated Indebtedness-to-
                                         Stockholders' Equity Ratio (as defined
                                         herein) does not exceed 4.0 to 1.0. In
                                         addition, such restriction will not
                                         apply to certain categories of liens
                                         specified in the Indenture. See
                                         "Description of Exchange Notes--Certain
                                         Covenants--Limitation on Liens."

Absence of Market for the
  Exchange Notes....................     There is currently no market for the
                                         Exchange Notes. Although the Initial
                                         Purchaser has informed the Company that
                                         it currently intends to make a market
                                         in the Exchange Notes, the Initial
                                         Purchaser is not obligated to do so,
                                         and any such market making may be
                                         discontinued at any time without
                                         notice. Accordingly, there can be no
                                         assurance as to the development or
                                         liquidity of any market for the
                                         Exchange Notes. The Company does not
                                         intend to apply for listing of the
                                         Notes on any securities exchange or for
                                         quotation through the Nasdaq Stock
                                         Market. See "Plan of Distribution."

Risk Factors........................     Investors should carefully consider the
                                         risk factors affecting the Company and
                                         the Exchange Offer described on pages
                                         15 through 18 of this Prospectus.

<PAGE>

                      SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

          The following table sets forth selected historical consolidated
financial data for the Company, for the periods and at the dates indicated. The
historical financial data for each of the five years in the period ended
December 31, 1997, and at December 31, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996 and 1997, have
been derived from and are qualified by reference to the historical consolidated
financial statements that have been audited and reported upon by Arthur Andersen
LLP, independent public accountants. The historical financial data for the three
months ended and at March 31, 1997 and 1998 have been derived from the unaudited
financial statements of the Company. The historical financial information for
the three months ended and at March 31, 1997 and 1998 reflects, in the opinion
of management, all adjustments (consisting only of normal recurring adjustments)
necessary to present fairly the results for the interim period. This information
should be read in conjunction with the historical consolidated financial
statements of the Company and the notes thereto and the other financial
information included elsewhere or incorporated by reference in this Prospectus.
The historical financial information for the three months ended March 31, 1998
is not necessarily indicative of results for the full year ending December 31,
1998.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                  Three Months
                                                                    Year Ended December 31,                     Ended March 31,
                                                  ------------------------------------------------------     --------------------
                                                    1993      1994        1995       1996(1)      1997        1997        1998
                                                  -------   -------      -------   ----------   -------     -------      --------
                                                                    (in thousands, except per share amounts)
Income Statement Data:
<S>                                                <C>       <C>         <C>        <C>          <C>         <C>         <C> 
Revenues..............................            $79,526    $92,272    $127,925    $147,148    $161,425     $38,176    $42,832

Income before provision for income
  taxes and extraordinary item........             23,604     28,602      35,670      41,996      37,591      10,569      9,210

Provision for income taxes(2).........              3,600      4,500       6,125       7,800       4,500       1,475      1,100
                                                  -------    -------    --------    --------    --------     --------   -------

Income before extraordinary item......             20,004     24,102      29,545      34,196      33,091       9,094      8,110

Extraordinary item - gain (loss) on early                                                            
retirement of debt, net of taxes......               ---        ---        2,422        ---       (5,428)       (328)       ---
                                                  -------    -------    --------    --------    --------     --------   -------
Net income............................            $20,004    $24,102     $31,967    $34,196      $27,663      $8,766     $8,110
                                                  =======    =======     =======    =======      =======      ======     ======
Income per share before extraordinary
  items and premium paid on redemption
  of preferred stock in 1997(1)(3):

      Basic...........................             $0.86      $0.93        $1.09      $1.24        $1.17         $.31       $.29
      Diluted.........................              N/A       $0.87        $1.02      $1.16        $1.13         $.29       $.28

Weighted average shares outstanding:

      Basic...........................             23,180     25,953      25,953     25,953       27,552       26,326     27,552
      Diluted.........................              N/A       30,293      30,533     31,438       29,370       31,773      28,510

</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                       At December 31,                            At March 31,
                                                  ------------------------------------------------------     --------------------
                                                    1993      1994        1995        1996       1997         1997         1998
                                                  -------   -------      -------   ----------   -------     -------      --------
                                                                    (Dollars in thousands)
BALANCE SHEET DATA:

<S>                                              <C>        <C>          <C>         <C>        <C>          <C>         <C>     
Cash and short-term investments.......           $105,182   $69,112      $ 40,208    $ 45,333   $ 30,402     $ 52,697    $ 11,608

Marketable securities.................             19,392    38,286        30,453      24,722     12,574       11,027      13,453

Net investment in direct financing leases          47,657   123,158       202,576     264,955    363,366      278,575     377,493

Leasing equipment, net of accumulated
  depreciation and amortization.......            239,021   397,202       523,620     541,371    608,362      531,427     618,289

Total assets..........................            435,984   664,792       851,600     939,418  1,114,456      942,974   1,130,944

Total long-term debt and capital
  lease obligations(4)................            226,799   385,247       499,998     521,873    669,397      524,688     672,603

Stockholders' equity..................            133,454   156,147       246,690     280,546    250,446      234,399     258,145

Total liabilities and stockholders'
  equity..............................            435,984   664,792       851,600     939,418  1,114,456      942,974    1,130,944

                                                                                                                 Three Months
                                                                    Year Ended December 31,                     Ended March 31,
                                                  ------------------------------------------------------     --------------------
                                                    1993      1994        1995       1996(1)      1997        1997        1998
                                                  -------   -------      -------   ----------   -------     -------      --------
                                                                       (Dollars in thousands)
OTHER  DATA:
Adjusted EBITDA (5)...................            $ 56,613    $79,888   $127,293    $168,257    $182,649     $ 44,357     $ 50,855

Interest expense, net, on senior debt.              11,512      17,568    35,082      39,485      42,050        9,784       11,342

Interest expense on Capital
  Securities..........................                ---         ---       ---         ---        6,833        1,278        1,852

  Total interest expense, net.........              11,512      17,568    35,082     39,485       48,883       11,062       13,194

Ratio of Adjusted EBITDA to interest
  expense on senior debt(5)...........               4.92x       4.55x     3.63x     4.26x        4.34x         4.53x        4.48x

Ratio of Adjusted EBITDA to total
  interest expense, net including
  interest on 9 7/8% Capital
  Securities(5)......................                4.92         4.55     3.63      4.26         3.74          4.01         3.85

Ratio of earnings to fixed
  charges (6)................                        2.36         2.17     1.85      1.91         1.66          1.81         1.57

Total capitalization (7).............             $360,253    $541,394  $746,688  $802,419     $994,843      $834,087   $1,005,748

Total long-term debt and capital lease
  obligations as a % of total
  capitalization.....................               62.96%     71.16%    66.96%     65.04%      67.29%        62.91%       66.88%

Capital expenditures.................             $120,526    $277,726   $273,643 $166,602     $263,750      $ 27,939   $   53,511

(DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE AMOUNTS)

<FN>
(1)  The 1996 income statement data include a non-cash and non-recurring charge
     of $2,392 representing cumulative unpaid dividends of the Company's
     subsidiary Trac Lease which resulted from the acquisition of the
     outstanding preferred stock of Trac Lease through the issuance of shares of
     the Company's 5 3/4% Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock (the "5 3/4%
     Preferred Stock"). Such change had no impact on income per share because
     unpaid dividends were included in the computation of income per share in
     prior periods.

(2)  In connection with its initial public offering in May 1993, the Company
     ceased to be a Subchapter "S" corporation for federal income tax purposes
     and thereafter became subject to federal income taxes. The Company's
     financial statements for the year ended December 31, 1993 include a pro
     forma provision for taxes as if the Company had been subject to federal
     income taxes for such periods.

(3)  Restated to give effect to a three-for-two stock split effective March 27,
     1997.

(4)  Debt at December 31, 1993 and 1994 included $60,000 and $67,600,
     respectively, of the Company's 5 1/4% Convertible Exchangeable Subordinated
     Notes due 2018. On July 29, 1997, the Company issued and sold $150,000
     aggregate principal amount of its 7.35% Notes due 2007 (the "7.35% Notes").
     On August 4, 1997, the Company issued and sold $75,000 aggregate principal
     amount of its 7.20% Notes due 2007 (the "7.20% Notes"). Subsequent to
     December 31, 1997, the Company issued and sold the Private Notes.

(5)  "Adjusted EBITDA" is defined as earnings before net interest expense,
     provision for income taxes, depreciation and amortization of leasing
     equipment and return of principal from direct financing leases. Adjusted
     EBITDA is presented because it is an indicator of funds available to
     service debt, although it is not a measure of liquidity or financial
     performance under United States generally accepted accounting principles
     ("GAAP"). The Company believes that Adjusted EBITDA, while providing useful
     information, should not be considered in isolation or as an alternative to
     net income and cash flows as determined under GAAP. 

(6)  For the purpose of calculating the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, (i)
     earnings consist of income before provision for income taxes, extraordinary
     items and fixed charges and (ii) fixed charges consist of interest expense
     and 75% of rental payments under operating leases (an amount estimated by
     management to be the interest component of such rentals). 

(7)  Total capitalization equals total long-term debt and capital lease
     obligations, plus the sum of $75,000 of Company obligated mandatorily
     redeemable preferred securities of grantor trusts (holding solely $77,300
     aggregate principal amount of the Company's 9 7/8% Junior Subordinated 
     Deferrable Interest Debentures Due February 15, 2027 (the "Junior 
     Subordinated Debentures")) and stockholders' equity.  See "Capitalization."
</FN>
</TABLE>

                                  RISK FACTORS

          PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS SHOULD CAREFULLY REVIEW THE INFORMATION
CONTAINED ELSEWHERE IN THIS PROSPECTUS AND SHOULD PARTICULARLY CONSIDER THE
FOLLOWING MATTERS IN CONNECTION WITH THE EXCHANGE OFFER AND EXCHANGE NOTES
OFFERED HEREBY.

RISK FACTORS RELATING TO THE EXCHANGE NOTES

RANKING OF THE NOTES AND HOLDING COMPANY STRUCTURE

          The Exchange Notes will be unsecured general obligations of the
Company and rank equally with the Company's other unsecured and unsubordinated
indebtedness. The Exchange Notes will be effectively subordinated to the secured
debt of the Company with respect to the assets pledged as collateral therefor
and, consequently, the rights of the holders of the Exchange Notes to receive
payments from the assets of the Company will be subject to the rights of the
secured creditors of the Company. As of March 31, 1998, the aggregate amount of
the Company's secured debt was $433 million. In addition, the Indenture and the
covenants thereunder will permit the Company to incur substantial secured
indebtedness in the future.

          Most of the Company's business activities and assets are operated or
held by subsidiaries. As a holding company, the Company's ability to meet its
financial obligations, including its obligations under the Exchange Notes, and
its ability to pay dividends is dependent primarily upon the receipt of cash
dividends, advances and other payments from its subsidiaries, principally Trac
Lease and Interpool Limited. In addition, the Exchange Notes are effectively
subordinated to all existing and future liabilities, including trade payables,
of the Company's subsidiaries. Any right of the Company to participate in any
distribution of the assets of any of the Company's subsidiaries upon the
liquidation, reorganization or insolvency of such subsidiary (and the consequent
right of the holders of the Notes to participate in such distributions) will be
subject to the claims of the creditors (including trade creditors) and preferred
shareholders of such subsidiaries. As of March 31, 1998, liabilities (excluding
intercompany payables) of the subsidiaries of the Company, to which the Exchange
Notes would have been effectively subordinated, aggregated approximately $293.5
million. See "Description of Exchange Notes."

CONSEQUENCES OF A FAILURE TO EXCHANGE PRIVATE NOTES

          The Private Notes have not been registered under the Securities Act or
any state securities laws and therefore may not be offered, sold or otherwise
transferred except in compliance with the registration requirements of the
Securities Act and any other applicable securities laws, or pursuant to an
exemption therefrom or in a transaction not subject thereto, and in each case in
compliance with certain other conditions and restrictions. Private Notes which
remain outstanding after consummation of the Exchange Offer will continue to
bear a legend reflecting such restrictions on transfer. In addition, upon
consummation of the Exchange Offer, holders of Private Notes which remain
outstanding will not be entitled to any rights to have such Private Notes
registered under the Securities Act or to any similar rights under the
Registration Rights Agreement (subject to certain limited exceptions). The
Company does not intend to register under the Securities Act any Private Notes
which remain outstanding after consummation of the Exchange Offer (subject to
such limited exceptions, if applicable). To the extent that Private Notes are
tendered and accepted in the Exchange Offer, a holder's ability to sell
untendered Private Notes could be adversely affected.

          The Exchange Notes and any Private Notes which remain outstanding
after consummation of the Exchange Offer will vote together as a single class
for purposes of determining whether holders of the requisite percentage in
outstanding principal amount thereof have taken certain actions or exercised
certain rights under the Indenture. See "Description of Exchange Notes-- Voting
Rights; Amendment of the Indenture."

          The Private Notes provide, among other things, that, if a registration
statement relating to the Exchange Offer has not been declared effective by July
24, 1998, additional distributions will be payable on the Private Notes at a
rate of 0.25% per annum until the Exchange Offer is consummated. Upon
consummation of the Exchange Offer, holders of Private Notes will not be
entitled to any additional distributions thereon or any further registration
rights under the Registration Rights Agreement, except under limited
circumstances. See "Description of Private Notes."

ABSENCE OF PUBLIC MARKET

          The Private Notes were issued to, and the Company believes such
securities are currently owned by, a relatively small number of beneficial
owners. The Private Notes have not been registered under the Securities Act and
will be subject to restrictions on transferability if they are not exchanged for
the Exchange Notes. Although the Exchange Notes may be resold or otherwise
transferred by the holders (who are not affiliates of the Company) without
compliance with the registration requirements under the Securities Act, they
will constitute a new issue of securities with no established trading market.
Exchange Notes may be transferred by the holders thereof in blocks having a
principal amount of $1,000 (one Exchange Note) or integral multiples thereof.
The Company has been advised by the Initial Purchaser that the Initial Purchaser
presently intends to make a market in the Exchange Notes. However, the Initial
Purchaser is not obligated to do so and any market-making activity with respect
to the Exchange Notes may be discontinued at any time without notice. In
addition, such market-making activity will be subject to the limits imposed by
the Securities Act and the Exchange Act and may be limited during the Exchange
Offer. Accordingly, no assurance can be given that an active public or other
market will develop for the Exchange Notes or the Private Notes. If an active
public market does not develop, the market price and liquidity of the Exchange
Notes may be adversely affected.

          If a public trading market develops for the Exchange Notes, future
trading prices will depend on many factors, including, among other things,
prevailing interest rates, the Company's results and the market for similar
securities. Depending on prevailing interest rates, the market for similar
securities and other factors, including the financial condition of the Company,
the Exchange Notes may trade at a discount.

          Notwithstanding the registration of the Exchange Notes in the Exchange
Offer, holders who are "affiliates" (as defined under Rule 405 of the Securities
Act) of the Company may publicly offer for sale or resell the Exchange Notes
only in compliance with the provisions of Rule 144 under the Securities Act.

          Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account in
exchange for Private Notes, where such Private Notes were acquired by such
broker-dealer as a result of market-making activities or other trading
activities, must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection
with any resale of such Exchange Notes. See "Plan of Distribution."

EXCHANGE OFFER PROCEDURE

          Issuance of the Exchange Notes in exchange for Private Notes pursuant
to the Exchange Offer will be made only after a timely receipt by the Company of
such Private Notes, a properly completed and duly executed Letter of Transmittal
and all other required documents. Therefore, holders of the Private Notes
desiring to tender such Private Notes in exchange for Exchange Notes should
allow sufficient time to ensure timely delivery. The Company is not under any
duty to give notification of defects or irregularities with respect to the
tenders of Private Notes for exchange.

RISK FACTORS RELATING TO THE COMPANY

CYCLICALITY OF WORLD TRADE

          The demand for the Company's containers and chassis primarily depends
upon levels of world trade of finished goods and component parts. Recessionary
business cycles, as well as political conditions, the status of trade agreements
and international conflicts, can have an impact on the operating results of the
Company. The demand for leased chassis also depends upon domestic economic
conditions and import-export volumes. In addition, operating costs such as
storage and repair and maintenance costs increase as utilization decreases. When
the volume of world trade decreases, the Company's business of leasing
containers and chassis may be adversely affected as the demand for such
equipment is reduced. Suppliers of leased containers and chassis, such as the
Company, are dependent upon decisions by shipping lines and other transportation
companies to lease rather than buy their equipment. Most of these factors are
outside the control of the Company. A substantial decline in world trade may
also adversely affect the Company's customers, leading to possible defaults and
the return of equipment prior to the end of a lease term. The Company expects
that the maritime container industry would be adversely affected during an
economic downturn.

DEPENDENCE ON SHIPPING TRAFFIC IN ASIA

          Certain of the shipping lines to which the Company leases containers
are entities domiciled in several Asian countries. In addition, many of the
Company's customers are substantially dependent upon shipments of goods exported
from Asia. Economic disruption, political instability or military disturbances
in these areas of the world could adversely affect these customers and thereby
lead to a reduced demand for leasing of the Company's containers or otherwise
adversely affect the Company. Although the Company has not experienced any
material adverse impact on its business as a result of the recent financial
conditions in certain Asian markets, there can be no assurance that financial
turmoil in one or more of the Asian markets would not adversely affect the
Company's business.

COMPETITION

          The transportation equipment leasing industry is highly competitive.
The Company competes with numerous domestic and foreign leasing companies, some
of which are much larger than the Company, or are divisions of much larger
companies, and have larger equipment fleets and greater financial resources than
the Company. In addition, if the available supply of intermodal transportation
equipment were to increase significantly as a result of, among other factors,
new companies entering the business of leasing and selling such equipment, the
Company's competitive position could be adversely affected.

ELIGIBILITY FOR TAX BENEFITS UNDER U.S.-BARBADOS TAX TREATY

          The Company currently receives certain tax benefits under an income
tax convention (the "Tax Convention") between the United States and Barbados,
the jurisdiction in which the Company's subsidiary Interpool Limited is
incorporated. There can be no assurance that at some future date the Tax
Convention will not be modified in a manner adverse to the Company or repealed
in its entirety, nor can there be any assurance that the Company will continue
to be eligible for such tax benefits.

RISK OF MANUFACTURING IN CHINA

          China is currently the largest container producing nation in the world
and the Company currently purchases a substantial majority of its containers
from manufacturers in China. In the event that it were to become more expensive
for the Company to procure containers in China or to transport these containers
at a low cost from China to the locations where needed by customers, either
because of increased tariffs imposed by the United States or other governments
or for any other reason, the Company would have to seek alternative sources of
supply. Although the Company believes it has strong relationships with many
manufacturers throughout the world, there can be no assurance that upon the
occurrence of such an event the Company would be able to make alternative
arrangements quickly to meet its equipment needs, nor can there be any assurance
that such alternative arrangements would not increase the costs to the Company.

VOLATILITY OF RESIDUAL VALUE OF EQUIPMENT

          Although the Company's operating results primarily depend upon
equipment leasing, the Company's profitability is also affected by the residual
values (either for sale or continued operation) of its containers and chassis
upon expiration of its leases. These values, which can vary substantially,
depend upon, among other factors, the maintenance standards observed by lessees,
the need for refurbishment, the ability of the Company to remarket equipment,
the cost of comparable new equipment, the availability of used equipment, rates
of inflation, market conditions, the costs of materials and labor and the
obsolescence of the equipment. Most of these factors are outside the control of
the Company.

CONTROL OF THE COMPANY

          Currently, approximately 68% of the Company's common stock is
beneficially owned, directly or indirectly, in the aggregate by Warren L.
Serenbetz, Martin Tuchman, Raoul J. Witteveen and Arthur L. Burns, each of whom
is a director of and/or either an executive officer of or a consultant to the
Company, and certain members of their immediate families. Such individuals,
either directly or indirectly, have the ability to elect all of the members of
the Board of Directors of the Company and to control the outcome of all matters
submitted to a vote of the Company's stockholders. Messrs. Serenbetz, Tuchman,
Witteveen and Burns, as well as certain family members and affiliated entities,
are parties to a Stockholders Agreement that imposes certain restrictions on
their ability to dispose of their shares of the Company's common stock and
requires them to vote for the re-election of Messrs. Serenbetz, Tuchman,
Witteveen and Burns as directors of the Company. In addition, the Company's
Restated Certificate of Incorporation and Restated Bylaws contain provisions
that may discourage acquisition bids for the Company.

DEPENDENCE UPON MANAGEMENT

          The Company's growth and continued profitability are dependent upon,
among other things, the abilities, experience and continued service of certain
members of its senior management, particularly Martin Tuchman, its Chairman and
Chief Executive Officer, and Raoul J. Witteveen, its President, Chief Operating
Officer and Chief Financial Officer. Each of Messrs. Tuchman and Witteveen
holds, either directly or indirectly, a substantial equity interest in the
Company and also is a director of the Company. There can be no assurance,
however, that the Company will be able to retain the services of either of
Messrs. Tuchman or Witteveen. The loss of either such individual could adversely
affect the Company's business and prospects.

POTENTIAL TAX CONSEQUENCES OF PERSONAL HOLDING COMPANY STATUS

          Based upon current management projections, Interpool will likely be
considered a personal holding company for federal income tax purposes in 1998
(and possibly for subsequent years). If Interpool or any of its subsidiaries
were to be classified as a personal holding company for federal income tax
purposes, in addition to its regular federal income tax liability, Interpool's
or such subsidiary's undistributed personal holding company income (generally,
taxable income with certain adjustments, including a deduction for federal
income taxes and dividends paid) would be subject to a personal holding company
tax of 39.6%. Management anticipates that in 1998 Interpool's current level of
dividends would be sufficient to avoid having any undistributed personal holding
company income, and thus does not anticipate that there will be any personal
holding company tax imposed in 1998. There can be no assurance, however, that
the Company will not at some point in the future become liable for such personal
holding company tax. Furthermore, the Company may at a future date elect to
increase the dividend rate on its common stock in order to avoid such tax.

<PAGE>

                       RATIO OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES

          The following table sets forth the ratio of earnings to fixed charges
for the Company for the periods indicated.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                  Three Months
                                                                    Year Ended December 31,                     Ended March 31,
                                                  ------------------------------------------------------     --------------------
                                                    1993      1994        1995       1996       1997        1997        1998
                                                  -------   -------      -------   --------   -------     -------      --------
<S>                                                <C>       <C>         <C>        <C>          <C>         <C>         <C> 
Ratio of Earnings to Fixed
Charges                                            2.36x     2.17x        1.85x      1.91x      1.66x       1.81x        1.57x

</TABLE>

                                 USE OF PROCEEDS

          The Company will not receive any cash proceeds from the issuance of
the Exchange Notes offered hereby. In consideration for issuing the Exchange
Notes in exchange for Private Notes as described in this Prospectus, the Company
will receive Private Notes in like principal amount. The Private Notes
surrendered in exchange for the Exchange Notes will be retired and canceled.

          The proceeds to the Company (without giving effect to expenses of the
offering payable by the Company) from the offering of the Private Notes was
$92,272,000. The Company used $83.0 million of the proceeds from the sale of the
Private Notes to repay all outstanding borrowings under the Company's revolving
credit agreement. The remaining net proceeds of approximately $9.1 million were
invested in interest bearing accounts and other investments and used for general
corporate purposes.

<PAGE>

                                 CAPITALIZATION

          The following table sets forth the cash and short-term investments,
marketable securities, short-term debt and consolidated capitalization of the
Company at March 31, 1998. The table should be read in conjunction with the
Company's consolidated financial statements and notes thereto included in the
documents incorporated by reference herein. See "Incorporation of Certain
Documents by Reference."

                                                      AT MARCH 31, 1998
                                                   (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)

Cash and short-term investments..................    $     11,608
                                                     =============
Marketable securities............................    $     13,453
                                                     =============
Other Assets.....................................    $     41,021
                                                     =============
Short-term debt (including current portion of
  long-term debt and capital lease obligations)      $     85,417
                                                     =============
Long-term debt:
  Revolving credit debt..........................    $     26,000
  Other existing senior debt and capital lease
    obligations (less current portion)...........         546,603
  6 5/8% Notes due 2003..........................         100,000
    Total long-term debt and capital lease
      obligations................................         672,603
                                                         --------
Company obligated mandatory redeemable preferred
  securities of subsidiary grantor trust
  (holding solely junior subordinated deferrable
  interest debentures of the Company) (75,000 shares
  9 7/8% Capital Securities outstanding and as
  adjusted, liquidation preference $75,000)(1)...         75,000
Stockholders' equity:
  Preferred stock, par value $0.001 per share,
    1,000,000 shares authorized; none issued.....           ---
  Common stock, par value $0.001 per share,
    100,000,000 shares authorized; 27,551,728
    shares issued and outstanding................             28
  Additional paid-in capital.....................        124,046
  Retained earnings..............................        132,734
  Net unrealized gain on marketable securities...          1,337
                                                      ----------
    Total stockholders' equity...................       258,145
                                                      ----------
    Total capitalization.........................    $ 1,005,748
                                                     ===========

- --------------------

(1)  The sole asset of this trust is $77.3 million aggregate principal amount of
     the Company's 9 7/8% Junior Subordinated Debentures.

<PAGE>

                                    BUSINESS

          Interpool is one of the world's leading lessors of intermodal dry
freight standard containers and is the second largest lessor of intermodal
container chassis in the United States. At March 31, 1998, the Company's
container fleet totaled approximately 435,000 twenty foot equivalent units
("TEUs"), the industry standard measure of dimension for containers used in
international trade, and its chassis fleet totaled approximately 65,000 chassis.
The Company leases its containers and chassis to over 200 customers, including
nearly all of the world's 20 largest international container shipping lines.

          The efficiencies and cost savings inherent in intermodal
transportation of containerized cargo have facilitated the dramatic growth of
international trade. Intermodal transportation permits movement of cargo in a
standard steel container by means of a combination of ship, rail and truck
without unpacking and repacking of the contents during transit. The world's dry
freight standard container fleet has grown from fewer than 0.4 million TEUs in
1970 to approximately 9.6 million TEUs by mid-1997. During the twelve month
period ending in mid-1997 approximately 1.2 million TEUs were produced, of which
0.3 million have been estimated as replacements of older containers.
Concurrently with this growth of the world's container fleet, the domestic
chassis fleet has grown to accommodate the increased container traffic. Leasing
companies have played a significant role in the growth of intermodal
transportation, supplying approximately half of the world's container and
chassis requirements.

          The Company focuses on leasing dry freight standard containers and
container chassis on a long-term basis in order to achieve high utilization of
its equipment and stable and predictable earnings. From 1991 through 1994, the
combined utilization rate of the Company's container and chassis fleets averaged
at least 90%. From 1995 through 1997, the combined utilization rate of the
Company's container and chassis fleets was approximately 97% and at March 31,
1998 such rate was approximately 98%. Substantially all of the Company's newly
acquired equipment is leased on a long-term basis, and at March 31, 1998
approximately 93% of its total equipment fleet is currently leased on this
basis. The remainder of the Company's equipment is leased under short-term
agreements to satisfy customers' peak or seasonal requirements, generally at
higher rates than under long-term leases. The Company concentrates on dry
freight standard containers and chassis because such equipment may be more
readily remarketed upon expiration of a lease than specialized equipment. In
financing its equipment acquisitions, Interpool generally seeks to meet debt
service requirements from the leasing revenue generated by its equipment.

          The Company conducts its container and chassis leasing business
through its two subsidiaries, Interpool Limited and Trac Lease, respectively.
Certain other United States equipment leasing activities are conducted through
Interpool itself.

          The Company and its predecessors have been involved in the leasing of
containers and chassis since 1968. The Company leases containers throughout the
world, with particular emphasis on the Pacific Rim. The Company leases chassis
to customers for use in the United States. The Company maintains contact with
its customers through a worldwide network of offices, agents and sales
representatives. The Company believes one of the key factors in its ability to
compete effectively has been the long-standing relationships management has
established with most of the world's large shipping lines. In addition, the
Company relies on its strong credit rating and low financing costs to maintain
its competitive position.

          From time to time the Company considers possible acquisitions of
complementary business and asset portfolios. On April 30, 1998, the Company
acquired a 50% interest in Container Applications International, Inc. ("CAI"), a
container leasing company whose business is primarily in the short-term master
lease market. CAI would not be deemed a "significant subsidiary" of the Company
for purposes of the Securities and Exchange Commission accounting requirements.

          The Company is a Delaware corporation formed in February 1988 with its
principal executive offices located at 211 College Road East, Princeton, New
Jersey 08540. Its telephone number is (609) 452-8900.

<PAGE>

COMPANY HISTORY

          The Company is the successor to a line of container and chassis
leasing businesses that traces its beginning to the 1960s. Interpool Limited, a
container and chassis leasing business, was formed in 1968 by Warren L.
Serenbetz, a director of the Company and executive consultant until January
1995, Martin Tuchman, currently Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer
and director of the Company, and two other individuals. In 1978, Interpool
Limited was sold to Thyssen-Bornemisza, N.V. ("Thyssen"). As part of Thyssen,
Interpool Limited continued to be managed by Messrs. Serenbetz and Tuchman. In
1986, Messrs. Serenbetz and Tuchman, along with Mr. Raoul J. Witteveen and two
other senior executives formed and became the stockholders of Trac Lease. In
1988, the Company was formed by Messrs. Serenbetz, Tuchman and Witteveen and
acquired Interpool Limited from Thyssen. In 1993, Trac Lease was combined with
the Company such that the Company then owned 87.5% of Trac Lease (the "Trac
Lease Acquisition"). In the first quarter of 1996 pursuant to an Agreement of
Merger between Trac Lease and Trac Lease Merger Corp., a newly formed subsidiary
(the "Trac Merger"), the Company acquired the minority interests in Trac Lease
and Trac Lease became a wholly owned subsidiary.

INTERMODAL TRANSPORTATION

          The fundamental component of intermodal transportation is the
container. Containers provide a secure and cost-effective method of transporting
finished goods and component parts because they are generally freely
inter-changeable between different modes of transport, making it possible to
move cargo from a point of origin to a final destination without the repeated
unpacking and repacking of the goods required by traditional shipping methods.
The same container may be carried successively on a ship, rail car and truck and
across international borders with minimal customs formalities. Containerization
is more efficient, more economical and safer in the transportation of cargo than
"break bulk transport" in which the goods are unpacked and repacked at various
intermediate points enroute to their final destination. By eliminating manual
repacking operations when differing modes of transportation are used,
containerization reduces freight and labor costs. In addition, automated
handling of containers permits faster loading and unloading and more efficient
utilization of transportation equipment, thereby reducing transit time. The
protection provided by sealed containers also reduces damage to goods and loss
and theft of goods during shipment. Containers may also be picked up, dropped
off, stored and repaired at independent common user depots located throughout
the world.

          The adoption of uniform standards for containers in 1968 by the
International Standards Organization (the "ISO") precipitated a rapid growth of
the container industry, as shipping companies recognized the advantages of
containerization over traditional break bulk transportation of cargo. This
growth resulted in substantial investments in containers, container ships, port
facilities, chassis, specialized rail cars and handling equipment.

          Most containers are constructed of steel in accordance with
recommendations of the ISO. The basic container type is the general purpose dry
freight standard container (accounting for approximately 87% of the world's
container fleet), which measures 20 or 40 feet long, 8 feet wide and 8 1/2 or 9
1/2 feet high. In general, 20-foot containers are used to carry heavy, dense
cargo loads (such as industrial parts and certain food products) and in areas
where transport facilities are less developed, while 40-foot containers are used
for lighter weight finished goods (such as apparel, electronic appliances and
other consumer goods) in areas with better developed transport facilities.
Standards adopted by the International Convention for Safe Containers and the
Institute of International Container Lessors govern the operation and
maintenance of containers.

          The demand for containers is influenced primarily by the volume of
international and domestic trade. In recent years, however, the rate of growth
in the container industry has exceeded that of world trade as a whole due to
several factors, including the existence of geographical trade imbalances, the
expansion of shipping lines, and changes in manufacturing practices, such as
growing reliance on "just-in-time" delivery methods and increased exports by
certain technologically advanced countries of component parts for assembly in
other countries and the subsequent re-importation of finished products.

          When a container vessel arrives in port, each container is loaded onto
a chassis or rail car. A chassis is a rectangular, wheeled steel frame,
generally 20 or 40 feet in length, built specifically for the purpose of
transporting a container. Once mounted, the container and chassis are the
functional equivalent of a trailer. When mounted on a chassis, the container may
be trucked either to its final destination or to a railroad terminal for loading
onto a rail car. Similarly, a container shipped by rail may be transferred to a
chassis to travel over the road to its final destination. As the use of
containers has become a predominant factor in the intermodal movement of cargo,
the chassis has become a prerequisite for the domestic segment of the journey. A
chassis seldom travels permanently with a single container, but instead serves
as a transport vehicle for containers that are loaded or unloaded at ports or
railroad terminals. Because of differing international road regulations and the
lack of international standards for chassis, chassis used in the United States
are seldom used in other countries.

          The Company's management believes that over the recent years, domestic
railroads and trucking lines have begun actively marketing intermodal use of
services for the domestic transportation of freight. In 1992, container loadings
represented, for the first time, a majority of total domestic rail loadings of
intermodal transportation equipment. Management further believes that this trend
should serve to accelerate the growth of intermodal transportation, and hence
result in increased container and chassis demand.

          As a result of the advantages of intermodal containerization and the
increased globalization of the world economy, the use of containers for domestic
intermodal transportation has also grown over the last few years. Greater use of
containers on cargo ships led railroad and trucking companies to develop the
capacity to transport containers domestically by chassis and rail car. In
addition, shipping companies began soliciting domestic cargo in order to
mitigate the cost of moving empty containers back to the port areas for use
again in international trade. The introduction in the mid-1980's of the double
stack railroad car, specially designed to carry containers stacked one on top of
another, accelerated the growth of domestic intermodal transportation by
reducing shipping costs still further. Due to these trends, an increasing
portion of domestic cargo is now being shipped by container instead of by a
conventional highway trailer. The Company has acquired over 7,000 units of
equipment, including domestic trailers, domestic chassis and domestic containers
in order to increase its participation in the growing domestic intermodal
market.

THE LEASING MARKET AND THE COMPANY'S STRATEGY

BENEFITS OF LEASING

          Leasing companies own approximately half of the world's container
fleet and half of the domestic chassis fleet, with the balance owned
predominantly by shipping lines. Leasing companies have maintained this market
position because container shipping lines receive both financial and operational
benefits by leasing a portion of their equipment. The principal benefits to
shipping lines of leasing are:

          -    to provide shipping lines with an alternative source of financing
               in a traditionally capital-intensive industry;

          -    to enable shipping lines to expand their routes and market shares
               at a relatively inexpensive cost without making a permanent
               commitment to support their new structure;

          -    to enable shipping lines to benefit from leasing companies'
               anticipatory buying and volume purchases, thereby offering them
               attractive pricing and prompt delivery schedules;

          -    to enable shipping lines to accommodate seasonal and/or
               directional trade route demand, thereby limiting their capital
               investment and storage costs; and

          -    to enable shipping lines at all times to maintain the optimal mix
               of equipment types in their fleets.

          Because of these benefits, container shipping lines generally obtain a
significant portion of their container fleets from leasing companies, either on
short-term or long-term leases. Short-term leases provide a considerable degree
of operational flexibility in allowing a customer to pick up and drop off
containers at various locations worldwide at any time. However, customers pay
for this flexibility in the form of substantially higher lease rates for
short-term leases and drop-off charges for the privilege of returning equipment
to certain locations. Most short-term leases are "master leases," under which a
customer reserves the right to lease a certain number of containers as needed
under a general agreement between the lessor and the lessee. Long-term leases
provide the lessee with advantageous pricing structures, but usually contain an
early termination provision allowing the lessee to return equipment prior to
expiration of the lease only upon payment of an early termination fee. Since
1991, the Company has experienced minimal early returns under its long-term
leases, primarily because of the penalties involved and because customers must
immediately return all containers covered by the particular long-term lease
being terminated, generally totaling several hundred units, and bear substantial
costs related to their repositioning and repair. Frequently, a lessee will
retain long-term leased equipment well beyond the initial lease term. In these
cases, long-term leases will be renewed at the then prevailing market rate,
either for additional one year periods or as part of a short-term agreement. In
some cases, the customer has the right to purchase the equipment at the end of a
long-term lease. The Company's long-term leases generally have five to eight
year terms.

          The Company often enters into long-term "direct finance" leases. Under
a direct finance lease, the customer owns the container at the expiration of the
lease term. Although customers pay a higher per diem rate under a direct finance
lease than under a long-term operating lease, a direct finance lease enables the
Company to provide customers with access to financing on terms generally
comparable to those available from financial institutions which provide this
type of financing. The percentage of the Company's revenues provided by direct
finance leases has increased from 11% in 1991 to 21% in 1997.

          Shipping lines generally spread their business over a number of
leasing companies in order to avoid dependence on a single supplier.

          Unlike the business of container leasing, which is global in scale,
the Company's chassis leasing business is almost exclusively a domestic
business. Many of the customers for the Company's chassis, however, are United
States subsidiaries or branches of international shipping lines.

COMPANY STRATEGY

          The Company emphasizes long-term leases in order to minimize the
impact of economic cycles on the Company's revenues and so as to achieve high
utilization and stable and predictable earnings. The lower rate of turnover
provided by long-term leases enables the Company to concentrate on the expansion
of its asset base through the purchase and lease of new equipment, rather than
on the repeated re-marketing of its existing fleet.

          The result of this strategy has been to establish the Company as one
of the world's leading lessors of dry freight standard containers. The Company
intends to continue its emphasis on acquiring and leasing dry freight standard
containers, rather than investing significantly in special purpose equipment
such as refrigerated or tank containers. Management believes that the Company
currently has one of the youngest container fleets of the world's ten largest
container lessors.

          Trac Lease, with a fleet of approximately 65,000 chassis, is currently
the second largest chassis lessor in the United States, with the largest lessor
having a fleet approximately 100,000 chassis. The Company's chassis leasing
strategy includes an emphasis on long-term leasing of new or re-manufactured
chassis which allows the Company to offer equipment packages to its customers at
the most attractive cost to the Company.

          In order to redeploy chassis that are coming off long-term leases, the
Company operates "chassis pools" for most of the major port authorities and
terminal operators on the Eastern seaboard and the Gulf coast. A chassis pool is
an inventory of chassis available for short-term leasing to customers of the
port or terminal. The principal ports in the United States where the Company
supplies chassis pools are Boston, Baltimore, Norfolk, Charleston, Savannah,
Jacksonville, New Orleans and Houston.

          Like most leasing companies, the Company depends on high utilization
of its equipment in order to run its operations profitably. Because the Company
has most of its container and chassis fleets under long-term leases, the Company
believes that it has generally experienced better utilization in periods of weak
demand than other leasing companies having a smaller proportion of their fleets
under long-term leases. From 1991 through 1994, the annual utilization of the
Company's container fleet and Trac Lease's chassis fleet has averaged at least
90%. From 1995 through 1997, the combined utilization rate of the Company's
container and chassis fleets was approximately 97% and at March 31, 1998 such
rate was approximately 98%.

OPERATIONS

LEASE TERMS

          Lease rentals are typically calculated on a per diem basis, regardless
of the term of the lease. The Company's leases generally provide for monthly or
quarterly billing and require payment by the lessee within 30 to 60 days after
presentation of an invoice. Generally, the lessee is responsible for payment of
all taxes and other charges arising out of use of the equipment and must carry
specified amounts of insurance to cover physical damage to and loss of
equipment, as well as bodily injury and property damage to third parties. In
addition, the Company's leases usually require lessees to repair any damage to
the containers and chassis, although in certain circumstances the Company
relieves lessees of the responsibility of paying repair costs in return for
higher lease payments. Lessees are also required to indemnify the Company
against losses to the Company arising from accidents or similar occurrences
involving the leased equipment. The Company's leases generally provide for
pick-up, drop-off and other charges and set forth a list of locations where
lessees may pick up or return equipment. The Company's long-term leases
generally have five to eight year terms.

EQUIPMENT TRACKING AND BILLING

          The Company uses a computer system with proprietary software for
equipment tracking and billing to provide a central operating data base showing
the Company's container and chassis leasing activities. The system processes
information received electronically from the Company's regional offices. The
system records the movement and status of each container and chassis and links
that information with the complex data comprising the specific lease terms in
order to generate billings to lessees. More than 10,000 movement transactions
per month are routinely processed through the system, which is capable of
tracking revenue on the basis of individual containers and chassis. The system
also generates a wide range of management reports containing information on all
aspects of the Company's leasing activities.

SOURCES OF SUPPLY

          Because of the rising demand for containers and the availability of
relatively inexpensive labor in the Pacific Rim, approximately 50% of world
container production now occurs in China. Containers are also produced in other
countries, such as Korea, Malaysia, Indonesia, Taiwan, and, to a lesser extent,
Thailand, India and in Europe, South America and South Africa. Most chassis used
in the United States are manufactured domestically due to the high cost of
transportation to the United States of chassis manufactured abroad.
Manufacturers of chassis frequently produce over-the-road trailers as well and
can convert some production capability to chassis as needed.

          Upon completion of manufacture, new containers and chassis are
inspected to insure that they conform to applicable standards of the ISO and
other international self-regulatory bodies.

MAINTENANCE, REPAIRS AND REFURBISHMENT

          Maintenance for new containers and chassis has generally been minor in
nature. However, as containers and chassis age, the need for maintenance
increases, and they may eventually require extensive maintenance.

          The Company's customers are generally responsible for maintenance and
repairs of equipment other than normal wear and tear. When normal wear and tear
to equipment is extensive, the equipment may have to be refurbished or
remanufactured. Refurbishing and remanufacturing involve substantial cost,
although chassis can be remanufactured for substantially less than the cost of
purchasing a new chassis. Because facilities for this purpose are not available
at all depots or branches, equipment requiring refurbishment or remanufacture
may have to be repositioned, at additional expense, to the nearest suitable
facility. Alternatively, the Company may elect to sell equipment requiring
refurbishment.

DEPOTS

          The Company operates out of approximately 50 depots throughout the
world. Depots are facilities owned by third parties at which containers and
other items of transportation equipment are stored, maintained and repaired. The
Company retains independent agents at these depots to handle and inspect
equipment delivered to or returned by lessees, store equipment that is not
leased and handle maintenance and repairs of containers and chassis. Some agents
are paid a fixed monthly retainer to defray recurring operating expenses and
some are guaranteed a minimum level of commission income. In addition, the
Company generally reimburses its agents for incidental expenses.

REPOSITIONING AND RELATED EXPENSES

          If lessees in large numbers return equipment to a location which has a
larger supply than demand, the Company may incur expenses in repositioning the
equipment to a better location. Such repositioning expenses generally range
between $50 and $500 per month per item of equipment, depending on geographic
location, distance and other factors, and may not be fully covered by the
drop-off charge collected from the lessee. In connection with necessary
repositioning, the Company may also incur storage costs, which generally range
between $.20 and $2.50 per TEU per day. In addition, the Company bears certain
operating expenses associated with its containers and chassis, such as the costs
of maintenance and repairs not performed by lessees, agent fees, depot expenses
for handling, inspection and storage and any insurance coverage in excess of
that maintained by lessee. The Company's insurance coverage provides protection
against various risks but generally excludes war-related and other political
risks.

DISPOSITION OF CONTAINERS AND CHASSIS AND RESIDUAL VALUES

          From time to time, the Company sells equipment that was previously
leased. The decision whether to sell depends on the equipment's condition,
remaining useful life and suitability for continued leasing or for other uses,
as well as prevailing local market resale prices and an assessment of the
economic benefits of repairing and continuing to lease the equipment compared to
the benefits of selling. Containers are usually sold to shipping or
transportation companies for continued use in the intermodal transportation
industry or to secondary market buyers, such as wholesalers, depot operators,
mini storage operators, construction companies and others, for use as storage
sheds and similar structures. Because old chassis are more easily remanufactured
than old containers, chassis are less likely to be sold than containers.

          At the time of sale, the residual value of a container or chassis will
depend, among other factors, upon mechanical or economic obsolescence, as well
as its physical condition. While there have been no major technological advances
in the short history of containerization that have made active equipment
obsolete, several changes in standards have decreased the demand for older
equipment, such as the increase in the standard height of containers from 8 feet
to 8 1/2 feet in the early 1970's.

MARKETING AND CUSTOMERS

          The Company leases its containers and chassis to over 200 shipping and
transportation companies throughout the world, including nearly all of the
world's 20 largest international container shipping lines. With a network of
offices and agents covering all major ports in the United States, Europe and the
Far East, the Company has been able to supply containers in nearly all locations
requested by its customers. In 1997, the Company's top 25 customers represented
approximately 64% of its consolidated revenues, with no single customer
accounting for more than 7%.

          The customers for the Company's chassis are a large number of domestic
companies, many of which are domestic subsidiaries or branches of international
shipping lines to which the Company also leases containers.

          The Company maintains close relationships with a larger customer base
on which detailed credit records are kept. The Company's credit policy sets
maximum exposure limits for various customers. Credit criteria may include, but
are not limited to, customer trade route, country, social and political climate,
assessments of net worth, asset ownership, bank and trade credit references,
credit bureau reports, and operational history. During the years 1990 through
1997, the Company's losses from defaults by customers have averaged less than 1%
of consolidated revenues.

          The Company seeks to reduce credit risk by maintaining insurance
coverage against defaults and equipment losses. Although there can be no
assurance that such coverage will be available in the future, the Company
currently maintains contingent physical damage, recovery/repatriation and loss
of revenue insurance which provides coverage in the event of a customer's
default. The policy covers the cost of recovering the Company's containers from
the customer, including repositioning costs, the cost of repairing the
containers and the value of containers which cannot be located or are
uneconomical to recover. It also covers a portion of the lease revenues the
Company may lose as a result of the customer's default (i.e., six months of
lease payments following default). The Company has the option to renew the
current policy through December 2001, subject to premium adjustment.

COMPETITION

          There are many companies leasing intermodal transportation equipment
with which the Company competes. Some of the Company's competitors have greater
financial resources than the Company or are subsidiaries or divisions of much
larger companies. Management believes that the Company is currently one of the
world's largest dry freight container leasing companies and the second largest
container chassis leasing company in the United States.

          In addition, the containerized shipping industry which the Company
services, competes with providers of alternative methods of transporting goods,
such as by air, truck and rail. The Company believes that in most instances such
alternative methods are not as cost-effective as shipping of containerized
cargo.

          Because rental rates for containers and chassis are not subject to
regulation by any government authority but are determined principally by the
demand for and supply of equipment in each geographical area, price is one of
the principal methods by which the Company competes. In times of low demand and
excess supply, leasing companies tend to grant price concessions, such as free
days or pick-up credits, in order to keep their equipment on lease and to avoid
storage charges. The Company attempts to design lease packages tailored to the
requirements of individual customers and considers its long-term relationships
with customers to be important to its ability to compete effectively. The
Company also competes on the basis of its ability to deliver equipment in a
timely manner in accordance with customer requirements.

OTHER BUSINESS OPERATIONS

          In addition to its container and chassis leasing operations through
Interpool Limited and Trac Lease, the Company also receives revenues from other
activities. The Company leases approximately 500 freight rail cars to railroad
companies through its Chicago based Railpool division. Microtech Leasing
Corporation, a 75.5% owned subsidiary of the Company, leases microcomputers and
related equipment. The Company also leases intermodal trailers which are
designed to be carried on rail flatcars and pulled by tractor over the highway.
The Company received, in the aggregate, approximately 10% of its consolidated
revenues for the year ended December 31, 1997 from these other business
operations. These operations have been consistently profitable since the
Company's formation.

GRAND ALLIANCE CHASSIS POOL CONTRACT

          During 1997, Trac Lease was awarded a contract by the Grand Alliance
Chassis Pool, an association of four of the world's largest steamship lines, to
administer through the Company's proprietary "Poolstat" computer software
program the movement and utilization by the members of Grand Alliance of a fleet
of up to 42,000 marine shipping container chassis. The contract also provides
for Trac Lease to administer numerous pool locations throughout the United
States where the chassis are based. This arrangement will make Trac Lease one of
the largest administrators of chassis in the world.

<PAGE>

MANAGEMENT

          The following table sets forth certain information with respect to the
executive officers and directors of the Company:

NAME                AGE                    POSITIONS AND OFFICERS

Martin Tuchman      57                Chairman of the Board of Directors
                                      and Chief Executive Officer
Raoul J. Witteveen  43                President, Chief Operating Officer,
                                      Chief Financial Officer and Director
Warren L. Serenbetz 74                Director
Arthur L. Burns     53                Secretary and Director
Peter D. Halstead   56                Director
Joseph J. Whalen    66                Director
Mitchell I. Gordon  53                Director
Ernst Baenziger     61                Senior Vice President and Director of
                                      Interpool Limited
William Geoghan     48                Senior Vice President of Finance and
                                      Controller
Sheldon Landy       66                Vice President, President Railpool
                                      Division

          Martin Tuchman, Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief Executive
Officer of the Company since February 1988, is also Chairman of the Board of
Directors, Chief Executive Officer and a director of Interpool Limited, which he
cofounded in 1968. He also has served as a director of Trac Lease since June
1987, President of Trac Lease for the period including June 1987 through January
1994 and currently serves as its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. He has
also been Chairman of the Board of Directors of Princeton International
Properties, Inc., a family-owned real estate company, which owns and has
interests in properties located in Princeton, New Jersey. Mr. Tuchman was
previously a member of the Society of Automotive Engineers as well as the
American National Standards Institute. Currently, Mr. Tuchman is a member of the
United Nations Business Council, a Council comprised of leading international
executives organized to promote understanding and cooperation between business
and government and a member of the Board of Trustees of the New Jersey Institute
of Technology. In 1995, Mr. Tuchman was honored as General Services Entrepreneur
Of The Year in an awards program founded by Ernst & Young LLP and in 1996 was
named Alumni of the Year by the New Jersey Institute of Technology. During 1997,
Mr. Tuchman was appointed to serve on the Board of Directors of Almedica
International, Inc., a clinical trials materials company which provides services
to the pharmaceutical industry, and on the Board of Governors of The National
Parkinson's Foundation. Mr. Tuchman holds a bachelor's degree in mechanical
engineering from the New Jersey Institute of Technology (Newark College of
Engineering) and a master's degree in business administration from Seton Hall
University.

          Raoul J. Witteveen has been President, Chief Operating Officer, Chief
Financial Officer and a director of the Company since March 1993 and has been
President, Chief Operating Officer, Chief Financial Officer and a director of
Interpool Limited since April 1988. He is a co-founder of Trac Lease and has
been Chief Financial Officer, Vice President and a director of Trac Lease since
June 1987. From 1982 to 1986, Mr. Witteveen served in a variety of management
capacities at Thyssen-Bornemisza N.V., the former parent of Interpool Limited.
In 1997, Mr. Witteveen was appointed to serve on the Board of Directors of
Almedica International, Inc., a clinical trials materials company which provides
services to the pharmaceutical industry. Mr. Witteveen holds a bachelor's degree
in economics and business administration and a master's degree in economics from
the Erasmus University in Rotterdam, The Netherlands.

          Warren L. Serenbetz has been a director of the Company since February
1988 and served as Executive Consultant through January 1995. He has also been a
director of Trac Lease, a subsidiary of the Company, since its founding in
November 1986. After co-founding Interpool Limited, a subsidiary of the Company,
in 1968, Mr. Serenbetz served as Interpool Limited's president and chief
executive officer and as a director until 1975, after which he was director,
chairman of the Executive Committee and chief executive officer until his
retirement in 1986. Mr. Serenbetz rejoined the Board of Directors of Interpool
Limited in 1988. Mr. Serenbetz is currently president of Radcliff Group, Inc. He
has been active in industry affairs, serving as an officer, director and member
of various world trade and shipping associations. Mr. Serenbetz holds a
bachelor's degree in engineering from Columbia University and a master's degree
in industrial engineering from Columbia University.

          Arthur L. Burns, General Counsel, Secretary and a director of the
Company since January 1990, was Senior Vice President of Law and Administration
and Secretary of Interpool Limited from 1986 until June 1996. Since June 1996,
Mr. Burns has acted as the Company's independent General Counsel. Prior to
joining Interpool Limited, Mr. Burns served as assistant general counsel to GATX
Leasing Corp. between 1975 and 1980, and as an associate attorney at the New
York law firm of Cahill, Gordon & Reindel from 1969 to 1975. Mr. Burns holds a
bachelor's degree in economics from Holy Cross College and a law degree from
Fordham University School of Law.

          Peter D. Halstead, a director of the Company since June 1994, has been
with Summit Bank since 1971 and is now an Executive Vice President. Mr. Halstead
serves as a trustee for numerous associations including McCarter Theater and
Cancer Care of New Jersey. Mr. Halstead holds a bachelor's degree from Colgate
University and a master's degree in business administration from Fairleigh
Dickinson University.

          Joseph J. Whalen, a director of the Company since April 1996,
originally joined the accounting firm of Arthur Andersen LLP in 1957 and served
as an audit partner in Andersen's New York and New Jersey office for more than
ten years prior to his retirement in 1994. Mr. Whalen is a member of the
American Institute of Certified Public Accounts and the New Jersey State Society
of Certified Public Accountants where he previously served on the Cooperation
with Credit Grantors Committee and the Technical Standards Section of the
Professional Conduct Committee. Mr. Whalen is a certified public accountant in
New Jersey and New York and holds a bachelor's degree from St. Peter's College.

          Mitchell I. Gordon, a director of the Company since May 1998, has been
President of Atlas Capital Partners, a private equity investment fund, since
February 1998. Prior thereto, he was a Managing Director of Salomon Smith
Barney and co- head of its Transportation Investment Banking Group from July
1993 to January 1998. From 1988 to 1993, Mr. Gordon was Senior Vice President of
Furman Selz Inc., where he ran the firm's Transportation and Automotive
Investment Banking groups. From 1984 to 1988, he was Vice President of Needham &
Company Inc. From 1981 to 1984, he held various executive positions at American
Broadcasting Companies, Inc. Mr. Gordon holds a BSBA degree from Washington
University and a master's degree in business administration from Harvard
Business School.

          Ernst Baenziger has been an employee since 1977, serving as Senior
Vice President and a director of Interpool Limited since 1991. Mr. Baenziger is
responsible for Europe, Far East, Australia and New Zealand operations. He is
also Managing Director of Interpool Limited's Basel, Switzerland branch,
handling sales and operations, and serves as the managing director of CTC
Equipment A.G. Mr. Baenziger holds a bachelor's degree in economics and business
administration from Handelshochschule, St. Gallen.

          William Geoghan, Senior Vice President of Finance and Controller of
the Company since May 1998, is responsible for investor and lender relations.
Mr. Geoghan was Controller of the Company since April 1992 and Vice President
and Controller of Interpool Limited since January 1989. He joined Interpool
Limited in 1981 and served as assistant controller for Interpool Limited 1985 to
1989. Mr. Geoghan is a certified public accountant and holds a bachelor's degree
in commerce from Rider University.

          Sheldon Landy, Vice President of the Company since March 1993, has
been President of the Company's Railpool division since 1979. Mr. Landy is a
member of the Transportation Research Board, a part of the National Research
Council and serves as a committee member studying the intermodal transportation
industry. Mr. Landy holds a bachelor's degree in liberal arts from the
University of Chicago and master's degree in business administration from
Northwestern University.

EMPLOYEES

          As of March 31, 1998 the Company had approximately 124 employees,
approximately 104 of whom are based in the United States. None of the Company's
employees is covered by a collective bargaining agreement. The Company believes
its relations with its employees are good.

<PAGE>

                               THE EXCHANGE OFFER

PURPOSE OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER

          The Private Notes were sold by the Company on February 24, 1998 (the
"Issue Date") to the Initial Purchaser pursuant to the Purchase Agreement. The
Initial Purchaser subsequently sold the Private Notes to (i) "qualified
institutional buyers" ("QIBs"), as defined in Rule 144A under the Securities Act
("Rule 144A"), in reliance on Rule 144A and (ii) to institutional "accredited
investors" within the meaning of subparagraph (a)(1), (2) (3) or (7) of Rule 501
under the Securities Act. As a condition to the sale of the Private Notes, the
Company and the Initial Purchaser entered into the Registration Rights Agreement
on February 24, 1998. Pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement the Company
agreed that, unless the Exchange Offer is not permitted by applicable law or
Commission policy, it would (i) file with the Commission a Registration
Statement under the Securities Act with respect to the Exchange Notes within 120
days after the Issue Date, (ii) use its best efforts to cause such Registration
Statement to become effective under the Securities Act within 150 days after the
Issue Date and (iii) use its best efforts to consummate the Exchange Offer
within 30 days after the Registration Statement has become effective. A copy of
the Registration Rights Agreement has been filed as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement. The Registration Statement is intended to satisfy
certain of the Company's obligations under the Registration Rights Agreement and
the Purchase Agreement.

RESALE OF THE EXCHANGE NOTES

          With respect to the Exchange Notes, based upon an interpretation by
the staff of the Commission set forth in certain no-action letters issued to
third parties, the Company believes that a holder (other than (i) a
broker-dealer who purchased such Exchange Notes directly from the Company to
resell pursuant to Rule 144A or any other available exemption under the
Securities Act, (ii) any such holder that is an "affiliate" of the Company
within the meaning of Rule 405 under the Securities Act or (iii) a broker-dealer
who acquired Private Notes as a result of market making or other trading
activities) who exchanges Private Notes for Exchange Notes in the ordinary
course of business and who is not participating, does not intend to participate,
and has no arrangement with any person to participate, in a distribution of the
Exchange Notes, will be allowed to resell Exchange Notes to the public without
further registration under the Securities Act and without delivering to the
purchasers of the Exchange Notes a prospectus that satisfies the requirements of
Section 10 of the Securities Act. However, if any holder acquires Exchange Notes
in the Exchange Offer for the purpose of distributing or participating in the
distribution of the Exchange Notes or is a broker-dealer, such holder cannot
rely on the position of the staff of the Commission enumerated in certain
no-action letters issued to third parties and must comply with the registration
and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act in connection with
any resale transaction, unless an exemption from registration is otherwise
available. Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account
in exchange for Private Notes, where such Private Notes were acquired by such
broker-dealer as a result of market-making activities or other trading
activities, must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection
with any resale of such Exchange Notes. The Letter of Transmittal states that by
so acknowledging and by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be
deemed to admit that it is an "underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities
Act. This Prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time,
may be used by a broker-dealer in connection with resales of Exchange Notes
received in exchange for Private Notes where such Private Notes were acquired by
such broker-dealer as a result of market-making or other trading activities.
Pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement, the Company has agreed to make
this Prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time,
available to broker-dealers for use in connection with any resale for a period
of one year after the Registration Statement is declared effective or until such
earlier date on which the Exchange Notes are freely tradable. See "Plan of
Distribution."

TERMS OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER

          Upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this
Prospectus and in the Letter of Transmittal, the Company will accept any and all
Private Notes validly tendered and not withdrawn prior to the Expiration Date.
The Company will issue $1,000 principal amount of Exchange Notes in exchange for
each $1,000 principal amount of outstanding Private Notes surrendered pursuant
to the Exchange Offer. Private Notes may be tendered in whole or in part in a
principal amount of not less than $1,000 or any integral multiple of $1,000
principal amount in excess thereof.

          The form and terms of the Exchange Notes are the same as the form and
terms of the Private Notes except that (i) the exchange will be registered under
the Securities Act and, therefore, the Exchange Notes will not bear legends
restricting the transfer thereof, (ii) the Exchange Notes will not contain the
$100,000 minimum principal amount transfer restriction, (iii) the Exchange Notes
will not provide for payment of additional distributions thereon, and (iv)
holders of the Exchange Notes will not be entitled to any of the rights of
holders of Private Notes under the Registration Rights Agreement, which rights
will terminate upon the consummation of the Exchange Offer except under certain
limited circumstances. See "--Termination of Certain Rights." The Exchange Notes
will evidence the same obligations as the Private Notes (which they replace) and
will be issued under, and be entitled to the benefits of, the Indenture, which
also authorized the issuance of the Private Notes, such that both series of
Securities will be treated as a single class of securities under the Indenture.

          As of the date of this Prospectus, $100,000,000 in aggregate principal
amount of the Private Notes are outstanding, all of which are registered in the
name of Cede & Co., as nominee for DTC. Only a registered holder of the Private
Notes (or such holder's legal representative or attorney-in-fact) as reflected
on the records of the Trustee (as defined herein) under the Indenture may
participate in the Exchange Offer. There will be no fixed record date for
determining registered holders of the Private Notes entitled to participate in
the Exchange Offer.

          Holders of the Private Notes do not have any appraisal or dissenters'
rights under the Indenture in connection with the Exchange Offer. The Company
intends to conduct the Exchange Offer in accordance with the provisions of the
Registration Rights Agreement and the applicable requirements of the Securities
Act, the Exchange Act and the rules and regulations of the Commission
thereunder.

          The Company shall be deemed to have accepted validly tendered Private
Notes when, as and if the Company had given oral or written notice thereof to
the Exchange Agent. The Exchange Agent will act as agent for the tendering
holders of Private Notes for the purposes of receiving the Exchange Notes from
the Company.

          Holders who tender Private Notes in the Exchange Offer will not be
required to pay brokerage commissions or fees or, subject to the instructions in
the Letter of Transmittal, transfer taxes with respect to the exchange of
Private Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer. The Company will pay all charges
and expenses, other than certain applicable taxes described below, in connection
with the Exchange Offer. See "--Fees and Expenses."

EXPIRATION DATE; EXTENSIONS; AMENDMENTS

          The term "Expiration Date" shall mean 5:00 p.m., New York City time on
_______________, 1998, unless the Company, in its sole discretion, extends the
Exchange Offer, in which case the term "Expiration Date" shall mean the latest
date and time to which the Exchange Offer is extended.

          In order to extend the Exchange Offer, the Company will (i) notify the
Exchange Agent of any extension by oral or written notice, (ii) mail to the
registered holders an announcement thereof and (iii) issue a press release or
other public announcement, which shall include disclosure of the approximate
number of Private Notes deposited to date, each prior to 9:00 a.m., New York
City time, on the next business day after the previously scheduled Expiration
Date. Without limiting the manner in which the Company may choose to make a
public announcement of any delay, extension, amendment or termination of the
Exchange Offer, the Company shall have no obligation to publish, advertise, or
otherwise communicate any such public announcement, other than by making a
timely release to an appropriate news agency.

          The Company reserves the right, in its reasonable discretion, (i) to
delay accepting any Private Notes, (ii) to extend the Exchange Offer or (iii) if
any conditions set forth below under "--Conditions" shall not have been
satisfied, to terminate the Exchange Offer by giving oral or written notice of
such delay, extension or termination to the Exchange Agent. Any such delay in
acceptance, extension, termination or amendment will be followed as promptly as
practicable by oral or written notice thereof to the registered holders. If the
Exchange Offer is amended in a manner determined by the Company to constitute a
material change, the Company will promptly disclose such amendment by means of a
prospectus supplement that will be distributed to the registered holders, and
the Company will extend the Exchange Offer for a period of five to ten business
days, depending upon the significance of the amendment and the manner of
disclosure to the registered holders, if the Exchange Offer would otherwise
expire during such five to ten business day period.

DISTRIBUTIONS ON EXCHANGE NOTES

          Holders of Private Notes whose Private Notes are accepted for exchange
will not receive Distributions on such Private Notes and will be deemed to have
waived the right to receive any Distributions on such Private Notes accumulated
from and after the Closing Date. Accordingly, holders of Exchange Notes as of
the record date for payment of distributions on September 1, 1998 will be
entitled to receive Distributions accumulated from and after the Closing Date.

PROCEDURES FOR TENDERING

          Only a registered holder of Private Notes may tender such Private
Notes in the Exchange Offer. To tender in the Exchange Offer, a holder of
Private Notes must complete, sign and date the Letter of Transmittal, or a
facsimile thereof, have the signatures thereon guaranteed if required by the
Letter of Transmittal, and mail or otherwise deliver such Letter of Transmittal
or such facsimile to the Exchange Agent at the address set forth below under
"--Exchange Agent" for receipt prior to the Expiration Date. In addition, either
(i) certificates for such Private Notes must be received by the Exchange Agent
along with the Letter of Transmittal, (ii) a timely confirmation of a book-entry
transfer (a "Book-Entry Confirmation") of such Private Notes, if such procedure
is available, into the Exchange Agent's account at the Depositary pursuant to
the procedure for book-entry transfer described below, must be received by the
Exchange Agent prior to the Expiration Date or (iii) the holder must comply with
the guaranteed delivery procedures described below.

          THE TENDER BY A HOLDER THAT IS NOT WITHDRAWN PRIOR TO THE EXPIRATION
DATE WILL CONSTITUTE AN AGREEMENT BETWEEN SUCH HOLDER AND THE COMPANY IN
ACCORDANCE WITH THE TERMS AND SUBJECT TO THE CONDITIONS SET FORTH HEREIN AND IN
THE LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL.

          THE METHOD OF DELIVERY OF PRIVATE NOTES AND THE LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL
AND ALL OTHER REQUIRED DOCUMENTS TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT IS AT THE ELECTION AND
RISK OF THE HOLDER. INSTEAD OF DELIVERY BY MAIL, IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT HOLDERS
USE AN OVERNIGHT OR HAND DELIVERY SERVICE, PROPERLY INSURED. IN ALL CASES,
SUFFICIENT TIME SHOULD BE ALLOWED TO ASSURE DELIVERY TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT
BEFORE THE EXPIRATION DATE. NO LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL OR PRIVATE NOTES SHOULD BE
SENT TO THE COMPANY. HOLDERS MAY REQUEST THEIR RESPECTIVE BROKERS, DEALERS,
COMMERCIAL BANKS, TRUST COMPANIES OR NOMINEES TO EFFECT THE ABOVE TRANSACTIONS
FOR SUCH HOLDERS.

          Any beneficial owner(s) of the Private Notes whose Private Notes are
registered in the name of a broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company or
other nominee and who wishes to tender should contact the registered holder
promptly and instruct such registered holder to tender on such beneficial
owner's behalf. If such beneficial owner wishes to tender on such owner's own
behalf, such owner must, prior to completing and executing the Letter of
Transmittal and delivering such owner's Private Notes, either make appropriate
arrangements to register ownership of the Private Notes in such owner's name or
obtain a properly completed bond power from the registered holder. The transfer
of registered ownership may take considerable time.

          Signatures on a Letter of Transmittal or a notice of withdrawal
described below (see "--Withdrawal of Tenders"), as the case may be, must be
guaranteed by an Eligible Institution (as defined) unless the Private Notes
tendered pursuant thereto are tendered (i) by a registered holder who has not
completed the box titled "Special Delivery Instructions" on the Letter of
Transmittal or (ii) for the account of an Eligible Institution. In the event
that signatures on a Letter of Transmittal or a notice of withdrawal, as the
case may be, are required to be guaranteed, such guarantee must be made by a
member firm of a registered national securities exchange or of the National
Association of Securities Dealers, Inc., a commercial bank or trust company
having an office or correspondent in the United States or an "eligible guarantor
institution" within the meaning of Rule 17Ad-15 under the Exchange Act which is
a member of one of the recognized signature guarantee programs identified in the
Letter of Transmittal (an "Eligible Institution").

          If the Letter of Transmittal is signed by a person other than the
registered holder of any Private Notes listed therein, such Private Notes must
be endorsed or accompanied by a properly completed bond power, signed by such
registered holder as such registered holder's name appears on such Private
Notes.

          If the Letter of Transmittal or any Private Notes or bond powers are
signed by trustees, executors, administrators, guardians, attorneys-in-fact,
officers of corporations or others acting in a fiduciary or representative
capacity, such persons should so indicate when signing, and unless waived by the
Company, evidence satisfactory to the Company of their authority to so act must
be submitted with the Letter of Transmittal.

          All questions as to the validity, form, eligibility (including time of
receipt), acceptance and withdrawal of tendered Private Notes will be determined
by the Company in its reasonable discretion, which determination will be final
and binding. The Company reserve the absolute right to reject any and all
Private Notes not properly tendered or any Private Notes the Company's
acceptance of which would, in the opinion of counsel for the Company, be
unlawful. The Company also reserves the right to waive any defects,
irregularities or conditions of tender as to particular Private Notes. The
Company's interpretation of the terms and conditions of the Exchange Offer
(including the instructions in the Letter of Transmittal) will be final and
binding on all parties. Unless waived, any defects or irregularities in
connection with tenders of Private Notes must be cured within such time as the
Company shall determine. Although the Company intends to notify holders of
defects or irregularities with respect to tenders of Private Notes, neither the
Company, the Exchange Agent nor any other person shall incur any liability for
failure to give such notification. Tenders of Private Notes will not be deemed
to have been made until such defects or irregularities have been cured or
waived.

          While the Company has no present plan to acquire any Private Notes
that are not tendered in the Exchange Offer or to file a registration statement
to permit resales of any Private Notes that are not tendered pursuant to the
Exchange Offer, the Company reserves the right in its sole discretion to
purchase or make offers for any Private Notes that remain outstanding subsequent
to the Expiration Date or, as set forth below under "--Conditions," to terminate
the Exchange Offer and, to the extent permitted by applicable law, purchase
Private Notes in the open market, in privately negotiated transactions or
otherwise. The terms of any such purchases or offers could differ from the terms
of the Exchange Offer.

          By tendering, each holder of Private Notes will represent to the
Company that, among other things, (i) Exchange Notes to be acquired by such
holder of Private Notes in connection with the Exchange Offer are being acquired
by such holder in the ordinary course of business of such holder, (ii) such
holder has no arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in the
distribution of the Exchange Notes, (iii) such holder acknowledges and agrees
that any person who is a broker-dealer registered under the Exchange Act or is
participating in the Exchange Offer for the purposes of distributing the
Exchange Notes must comply with the registration and prospectus delivery
requirements of the Securities Act in connection with a secondary resale
transaction of the Exchange Notes, acquired by such person and cannot rely on
the position of the staff of the Commission set forth in certain no-action
letters, (iv) such holder understands that a secondary resale transaction
described in clause (iii) above and any resales of Exchange Notes obtained by
such holder in exchange for Private Notes acquired by such holder directly from
the Company should be covered by an effective registration statement containing
the selling securityholder information required by Item 507 of the Commission
and (v) such holder is not an "affiliate," as defined in Rule 405 under the
Securities Act, of the Company. If the holder is a broker-dealer that will
receive Exchange Notes for such holder's own account in exchange for Private
Notes that were acquired as a result of market-making activities or other
trading activities, such holder will be required to acknowledge in the Letter of
Transmittal that such holder will deliver a copy of this Prospectus (as it may
be supplemented or amended) in connection with any resale of such Exchange
Notes; however, by so acknowledging and by delivering a prospectus, such holder
will not be deemed to admit that it is an "underwriter" within the meaning of
the Securities Act.

RETURN OF PRIVATE NOTES; ATOP

          If any tendered Private Notes are not accepted for any reason set
forth in the terms and conditions of the Exchange Offer or if Private Notes are
withdrawn or are submitted for a greater principal amount than the holders
desire to exchange, such unaccepted, withdrawn or non-exchanged Private Notes
will be returned without expense to the tendering holder thereof (or, in the
case of Private Notes tendered by book-entry transfer into the Exchange Agent's
account at the Depositary pursuant to the book-entry transfer procedures
described below, such Private Notes will be credited to an account maintained
with the Depositary) as promptly as practicable.

          The Exchange Agent and DTC have confirmed that the Exchange Offer is
eligible for the Book-Entry Facility Automated Tender Offer Program ("ATOP").
Accordingly, DTC participants listed on an official DTC proxy may electronically
transmit their acceptance of the Exchange Offer by causing DTC to transfer Notes
to the Exchange Agent in accordance with DTC's ATOP procedures for transfer. DTC
will then send an Agent's Message to the Exchange Agent.

          The term "Agent's Message" means a message transmitted by DTC,
received by the Exchange Agent and forming part of the confirmation of a
book-entry transfer, which states that DTC has received an express
acknowledgment from the participant in DTC tendering Notes which are the subject
of such book-entry confirmation, that such participant has received and agrees
to be bound by the terms of the Letter of Transmittal and that the Issuer may
enforce such agreement against the participant. In the case of an Agent's
Message relating to guaranteed delivery, the term means a message transmitted by
DTC and received by the Exchange Agent which states that DTC has received an
express acknowledgment from the participant in DTC tendering Notes that such
participant has received and agrees to be bound by the Notice of Guaranteed
Delivery.

          Each DTC participant transmitting an acceptance of the Exchange Offer
through the ATOP procedures will be deemed to have agreed to be bound by the
terms of the Letter of Transmittal. Nevertheless, in order for such acceptance
to constitute a valid tender of the DTC participant's Notes, such participant
must complete and sign a Letter of Transmittal and deliver it to the Exchange
Agent before the Expiration Date.

BOOK-ENTRY TRANSFER

          The Exchange Agent will make a request to establish an account with
respect to the Private Notes at DTC for purposes of the Exchange Offer within
two business days after the date of this Prospectus, and any financial
institution that is a participant in the Depositary's systems may make
book-entry delivery of Private Notes by causing DTC to transfer such Private
Notes into the Exchange Agent's account at DTC in accordance with DTC's
procedures for transfer. However, although delivery of Private Notes may be
effected through book-entry transfer at DTC, the Letter of Transmittal or
facsimile thereof, with any required signature guarantees and any other required
documents, must, in any case, be transmitted to and received by the Exchange
Agent at the address set forth below under "--Exchange Agent" on or prior to the
Expiration Date or pursuant to the guaranteed delivery procedures described
below.

GUARANTEED DELIVERY PROCEDURES

          Holders who wish to tender their Private Notes and (i) whose Private
Notes are not immediately available or (ii) who cannot deliver their Private
Notes, the Letter of Transmittal or any other required documents to the Exchange
Agent prior to the Expiration Date, may effect a tender if:

                   (a) The tender is made through an Eligible Institution;

                   (b) Prior to the Expiration Date, the Exchange Agent receives
               from such Eligible Institution a properly completed and duly
               executed Notice of Guaranteed Delivery substantially in the form
               provided by the Company (by facsimile transmission, mail or hand
               delivery) setting forth the name and address of the holder, the
               certificate number(s) of such Private Notes and the principal
               amount of Private Notes tendered, stating that the tender is
               being made thereby and guaranteeing that, within five New York
               Stock Exchange trading days after the Expiration Date, the Letter
               of Transmittal (or a facsimile thereof), together with the
               certificate(s) representing the Private Notes in proper form for
               transfer or a Book-Entry Confirmation, as the case may be, and
               any other documents required by the Letter of Transmittal, will
               be deposited by the Eligible Institution with the Exchange Agent;
               and

                   (c) Such properly executed Letter of Transmittal (or 
               facsimile thereof), as well as the certificate(s) representing 
               all tendered Private Notes in proper form for transfer and all 
               other documents required by the Letter of Transmittal are 
               received by the Exchange Agent within five New York Stock 
               Exchange trading days after the Expiration Date.

          Upon request to the Exchange Agent, a Notice of Guaranteed Delivery
will be sent to holders who wish to tender their Private Notes according to the
guaranteed delivery procedures set forth above.

WITHDRAWAL OF TENDERS

          Except as otherwise provided herein, tenders of Private Notes may be
withdrawn at any time prior to the Expiration Date.

          To withdraw a tender of Private Notes in the Exchange Offer, a written
or facsimile transmission notice of withdrawal must be received by the Exchange
Agent at its address set forth herein prior to the Expiration Date. Any such
notice of withdrawal must (i) specify the name of the person having deposited
the Private Notes to be withdrawn (the "Depositor"), (ii) identify the Private
Notes to be withdrawn (including the certificate number or numbers and principal
amount of such Private Notes) and (iii) be signed by the holder in the same
manner as the original signature on the Letter of Transmittal by which such
Private Notes were tendered (including any required signature guarantees). All
questions as to the validity, form and eligibility (including time of receipt)
of such notices will be determined by the Company, in its sole discretion, whose
determination shall be final and binding on all parties. Any Private Notes so
withdrawn will be deemed not to have been validly tendered for purposes of the
Exchange Offer and no Exchange Notes will be issued with respect thereto unless
the Private Notes so withdrawn are validly retendered. Properly withdrawn
Private Notes may be retendered by following one of the procedures described
above under "The Exchange Offer--Procedures for Tendering" at any time prior to
the Expiration Date.

CONDITIONS

          Notwithstanding any other term of the Exchange Offer, the Company
shall not be required to accept for exchange, or exchange the Exchange Notes
for, any Private Notes, and may terminate the Exchange Offer as provided herein
before the acceptance of such Private Notes, if the Exchange Offer violates
applicable law, rules or regulations or an applicable interpretation of the
staff of the Commission.

          If the Company determines in its reasonable discretion that any of
these conditions are not satisfied, the Company may (i) refuse to accept any
Private Notes and return all tendered Private Notes to the tendering holders,
(ii) extend the Exchange Offer and retain all Private Notes tendered prior to
the expiration of the Exchange Offer, subject, however, to the rights of holders
to withdraw such Private Notes (see "--Withdrawal of Tenders") or (iii) waive
such unsatisfied conditions with respect to the Exchange Offer and accept all
properly tendered Private Notes that have not been withdrawn. If such waiver
constitutes a material change to the Exchange Offer, the Company will promptly
disclose such waiver by means of a prospectus supplement that will be
distributed to the registered holders of the Private Notes, and the Company will
extend the Exchange Offer for a period of five to ten business days, depending
upon the significance of the waiver and the manner of disclosure to the
registered holders, if the Exchange Offer would otherwise expire during such
five to ten business day period.

TERMINATION OF CERTAIN RIGHTS

          All rights under the Registration Rights Agreement (including
registration rights) of holders of the Private Notes eligible to participate in
the Exchange Offer will terminate upon consummation of the Exchange Offer except
with respect to the Company's continuing obligations (i) to indemnify such
holders (including any broker-dealers) and certain parties related to such
holders against certain liabilities (including liabilities under the Securities
Act), (ii) to provide, upon the request of any holder of a transfer-restricted
Private Note, the information required by Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Securities
Act in order to permit resales of such Private Notes pursuant to Rule 144A,
(iii) to use its best efforts to keep the Registration Statement effective to
the extent necessary to ensure that it is available for resales of Exchange
Notes by broker-dealers for a period of up to one year from the date the
Registration Statement is declared effective or until such earlier date on which
the Exchange Notes are freely tradeable and to provide copies of the latest
version of the Prospectus to such broker-dealers upon their request during such
period and (iv) to file a shelf registration statement as required by the
Registration Rights Agreement if any holder of transfer-restricted Notes
notifies the Company within 20 business days of the consummation of the Exchange
Offer that (A) such holder is prohibited by applicable law or Commission policy
from participating in the Exchange Offer, or (B) such holder may not resell the
Exchange Notes acquired by it in the Exchange Offer to the public without
delivering a prospectus and that this Prospectus is not appropriate or available
for such resales by such holder, or (C) that such holder is a broker-dealer and
holds Private Notes acquired directly from the Company as one of its affiliate
(see "--Liquidated Damages").

LIQUIDATED DAMAGES

          The Registration Rights Agreement provides that (i) the Company will
file the Registration Statement with the Commission on or prior to 120 days
after the issue date of the Private Notes (February 24, 1998), (ii) the Company
will use its best efforts to have the Registration Statement declared effective
by the Commission on or prior to 150 days after the Issue Date, (iii) unless the
Exchange Offer would not be permitted by applicable law or Commission policy,
the Company will commence the Exchange Offer and use its best efforts to issue,
on or prior to 30 days after the date on which the Registration Statement is
declared effective by the Commission, Exchange Notes in exchange for all Private
Notes tendered prior thereto in the Exchange Offer and (iv) if obligated to file
a shelf registration statement pursuant to the terms of the Registration Rights
Agreement (the "Shelf Registration Statement" and, collectively with the
Registration Statement, the "Registration Statements"), the Company will use its
best efforts to file such Shelf Registration Statement with the Commission.

          If the Company fails to comply with the Registration Rights Agreement
or if the Exchange Offer Registration Statement or the Shelf Registration
Statement fails to become effective, then an additional amount ("Liquidated
Damages") shall become payable in respect of the Private Notes as provided in
the Registration Rights Agreement.

          Holders of Private Notes will be required to make certain
representations to the Company (as described in the Registration Rights
Agreement) in order to participate in the Exchange Offer and will be required to
deliver information to be used in connection with the Shelf Registration
Statement and to provide comments on the Shelf Registration Statement within the
time periods set forth in the Registration Rights Agreement in order to have
their Private Notes included in the Shelf Registration Statement and benefit
from the provisions regarding Liquidated Damages set forth above.

FEES AND EXPENSES

          The expenses of soliciting tenders will be borne by the Company. The
principal solicitation is being made by mail; however, additional solicitation
may be made by telegraph, telephone or in person by officers and regular
employees of the Company and its affiliates.

          The Company has not retained any dealer-manager in connection with the
Exchange Offer and will not make any payments to brokers, dealers or others
soliciting acceptances of the Exchange Offer. The Company, however, will pay the
Exchange Agent reasonable and customary fees for its services and will reimburse
it for its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses in connection therewith.

          The cash expenses to be incurred in connection with the Exchange Offer
will be paid by the Company and are estimated in the aggregate to be
approximately $200,000. Such expenses include registration fees, fees and
expenses of the Exchange Agent and the Trustee, accounting and legal fees and
printing costs, among others.

          The Company will pay all transfer taxes, if any, applicable to the
exchange of Private Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer. If, however, a
transfer tax is imposed for any reason other than the exchange of the Private
Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer, then the amount of any such transfer taxes
(whether imposed on the registered holder or any other persons) will be payable
by the tendering holder. If satisfactory evidence of payment of such taxes or
exemption therefrom is not submitted with the Letter of Transmittal, the amount
of such transfer taxes will be billed directly to such tendering holder.

CONSEQUENCE OF FAILURE TO EXCHANGE

          Participation in the Exchange Offer is voluntary. Holders of the
Private Notes are urged to consult their financial and tax advisors in making
their own decisions on what action to take.

          The Private Notes that are not exchanged for the Exchange Notes
pursuant to the Exchange Offer will remain restricted securities. Accordingly,
such Private Notes may be resold only (i) to a person whom the seller reasonably
believes is a QIB in a transaction meeting the requirements of Rule 144A, (ii)
in a transaction meeting the requirements of Rule 144 under the Securities Act,
(iii) outside the United States to a foreign person in a transaction meeting the
requirements of Rule 904 under the Securities Act, (iv) in accordance with
another exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act (and
based upon an opinion of counsel if the Company so requests), (v) to the Company
or (vi) pursuant to an effective registration statement and, in each case, in
accordance with any applicable securities laws of any state of the United States
or any other applicable jurisdiction.

ACCOUNTING TREATMENT

          For accounting purposes, the Company will recognize no gain or loss as
a result of the Exchange Offer. The expenses of the Exchange Offer will be
amortized over the term of the Exchange Notes.

EXCHANGE AGENT

          United States Trust Company of New York has been appointed Exchange
Agent for the Exchange Offer. Delivery of the Letters of Transmittal and any
other required documents, questions, requests for assistance and requests for
additional copies of this Prospectus or of the Letter of Transmittal should be
directed to the Exchange Agent as follows:

By Registered or Certified Mail:        By Hand:        By Overnight Courier:

United States Trust Company     United States Trust      United States Trust 
   of New York                    Company of New York      Company of New York
   P.O. Box 844                   111 Broadway          770 Broadway, 13th Floor
Attn: Corporate Trust Services  Attn: Corporate Trust  New York, New York  10003
   Cooper Station                 Services             Attn: Corporate Trust 
New York, New York  10276-0844  New York, New York           Services 
                                   10006

                              CONFIRM BY TELEPHONE:
                                 1-800-548-6565

                            FACSIMILE TRANSMISSIONS:
                          (ELIGIBLE INSTITUTIONS ONLY)
                     United States Trust Company of New York
                                 (212) 420-6152
                         Attn: Corporate Trust Services

          Delivery to other than the above addresses or facsimile number will
not constitute a valid delivery.

<PAGE>

                          DESCRIPTION OF EXCHANGE NOTES

          The following description of the terms of the Exchange Notes sets
forth certain general terms and provisions of the Exchange Notes. The Exchange
Notes were issued under an indenture dated as of February 24, 1998 (the
"Indenture"), between the Company and United States Trust Company of New York,
as Trustee (the "Trustee"). The terms of the Exchange Notes include those stated
in the Indenture.

          The following description of the Exchange Notes and the Indenture are
summaries of the provisions thereof, and does not purport to be complete and is
qualified in its entirety by reference to the Indenture. Certain capitalized
terms used below but not defined herein have the meanings ascribed to them in
the applicable Indenture.

GENERAL

          The Notes (including the Private Notes and the Exchange Notes) will be
limited to $100,000,000 in aggregate principal amount and will mature on March
1, 2003 (the "Maturity Date"). The Exchange Notes will bear interest from
February 24, 1998 at the rate of 6 5/8% per annum. The Exchange Notes will be
issued in denominations of $1,000 and integral multiples of $1,000. Interest
will be payable semi-annually in arrears on March 1 and September 1 of each
year, commencing September 1, 1998 (each, an "Interest Payment Date"), to the
persons in whose names the Exchange Notes are registered at the close of
business on the preceding February 15 or August 15, respectively, regardless of
whether such day is a Business Day. If any Interest Payment Date or the Maturity
Date falls on a day that is not a Business Day, the required payment shall be
made on the next Business Day as if it were made on the date such payment was
due and no interest shall accrue on the amount so payable for the period from
and after such Interest Payment Date or the Maturity Date, as the case may be.
"Business Day" means any day, other than a Saturday or Sunday, on which banking
institutions in the city of New York, New York are open for business.

          The Exchange Notes will be direct, unsecured obligations of the
Company and will rank equally with all other unsecured and unsubordinated
indebtedness of the Company from time to time. The Exchange Notes will be
effectively subordinated to any secured indebtedness of the Company to the
extent of the value of the assets securing such indebtedness. The Indenture will
permit the Company to incur additional secured and unsecured indebtedness. See
"--Certain Covenants" below.

          The Exchange Notes will not be subject to any mandatory redemption or
annual sinking fund payments.

          Reference is made to the section entitled "--Certain Covenants" herein
for a description of certain covenants applicable to the Exchange Notes.
Compliance with such covenants with respect to the Exchange Notes generally may
not be waived by the Trustee unless the holders of at least a majority in
principal amount of all outstanding Exchange Notes consent to such waiver.

          Except as described herein under "--Certain Covenants" and under
"--Consolidation, Merger, Sale or Conveyance," the Indenture does not contain
any other provisions that would limit the ability of the Company to incur
indebtedness or that would afford holders of the Exchange Notes protection in
the event of (i) a highly leveraged or similar transaction involving the
Company, (ii) a change of control, or (iii) a reorganization, restructuring,
merger or similar transaction involving the Company that may adversely affect
the holders of the Exchange Notes. In addition, subject to the limitations set
forth under "--Consolidation, Merger, Sale or Conveyance," the Company may, in
the future, enter into certain transactions such as the sale of all or
substantially all of its assets or the merger or consolidation of the Company
that would increase the amount of the Company's indebtedness or substantially
reduce or eliminate the Company's assets, which may have an adverse effect on
the Company's ability to service its indebtedness, including the Exchange Notes.
The Company and its management have no present intention of engaging in a highly
leveraged or similar transaction involving the Company.

          The Company conducts certain of its operations through its
subsidiaries. The rights of the Company and its creditors, including the holders
of the Exchange Notes, to participate in the assets of any subsidiary upon the
latter's liquidation or reorganization will be subject to the prior claims of
the subsidiary's creditors except to the extent that the Company may itself be a
creditor with recognized claims against the subsidiary.

OPTIONAL REDEMPTION BY THE COMPANY

          The Company may redeem the Exchange Notes, at any time, in whole or
from time to time in part, at the election of the Company, at a redemption price
equal to the sum of (i) the principal amount of the Exchange Notes being
redeemed plus accrued interest thereon to the redemption date and (ii) the
Make-Whole Amount (as defined below), if any, with respect to such Exchange
Notes (the "Redemption Price").

          From and after notice has been given as provided in the Indenture, if
funds for the redemption of any Exchange Notes called for redemption shall have
been made available on such redemption date, such Exchange Notes will cease to
bear interest on the date fixed for such redemption specified in such notice and
the only right of the holders of the Exchange Notes will be to receive payment
of the Redemption Price.

          Notice of any optional redemption of any Exchange Notes will be given
to holders at their addresses, as shown in the Note register, not more than 60
nor less than 30 days prior to the date fixed for redemption. The notice of
redemption will specify, among other items, the Redemption Price and the
principal amount of the Exchange Notes held by such holder to be redeemed.

          The Company will notify the Trustee at least 45 days prior to the
redemption date (or such shorter period as satisfactory to the Trustee) of the
aggregate principal amount of Exchange Notes to be redeemed and the redemption
date. If less than all the Exchange Notes are to be redeemed at the option of
the Company, the Trustee shall select, pro rata or by lot or by any other method
that the Trustee considers fair and appropriate under the circumstances,
Exchange Notes of such series to be redeemed in whole or in part. Exchange Notes
may be redeemed in part in the minimum authorized denomination for Exchange
Notes or in any integral multiple thereof.

          As used herein,

          "Make-Whole Amount" means, in connection with any optional redemption
of any Exchange Note, the excess, if any of (i) the aggregate present value as
of the date of such redemption of each dollar of principal being redeemed and
the amount of interest (exclusive of any interest accrued to the date of
redemption) that would have been payable in respect of such dollar if such
redemption had not been made, determined by discounting, on a semi-annual basis,
such principal and interest at the Reinvestment Rate (as defined below)
(determined on the third Business Day preceding the date such notice of
redemption is given) from the respective dates on which such principal and
interest would have been payable if such redemption had not been made, over (ii)
the aggregate principal amount of the Exchange Notes being redeemed.

          "Reinvestment Rate" means 0.25% plus the arithmetic mean of the yields
under the respective headings "This Week" and "Last Week" published in the most
recent Statistical Release (as defined below) under the caption "Treasury
Constant Maturities" for the maturity (rounded to the nearest month)
corresponding to the remaining life to maturity, as of the payment date of the
principal being redeemed or paid. If no maturity exactly corresponds to such
maturity, yields for the two published maturities most closely corresponding to
such maturity shall be calculated pursuant to the immediately preceding sentence
and the Reinvestment Rate shall be interpolated or extrapolated from such yields
on a straight-line basis, rounding in each of such relevant periods to the
nearest month. For the purposes of calculating the Reinvestment Rate, the most
recent Statistical Release published prior to the date of determination of the
Make-Whole Amount shall be used.

          "Statistical Release" means the statistical release designated
"H.15(519)" or any successor publication which is published weekly by the
Federal Reserve System and which establishes yields on actively traded United
States government securities adjusted to constant maturities, or, if such
statistical release is not published at the time of any determination under the
Indenture, then such other reasonably comparable index which shall be designated
by the Company.

CERTAIN COVENANTS

LIMITATION ON LIENS

          The Indenture will provide that the Company will not, directly or
indirectly, create, incur or assume any mortgage, pledge, deed of trust,
financing lease (as lessee) or security interest ("Liens") on any of its
properties whether now or hereafter acquired, or any income or profits
therefrom, or assign or convey any right to receive income therefrom (any such
Lien, an "Initial Lien"), unless prior to or simultaneously with the inception
of such Initial Lien, the Company shall have delivered to the Trustee a security
agreement or security agreements and such other documents as the Trustee may
reasonably request, each in form and substance satisfactory to the Trustee,
granting to the Trustee an equal and ratable security interest in such property
subject to such Initial Lien, such security interest to be for the equal and
ratable benefit of the Holders. Any such security interest created in favor of
the Exchange Notes will be automatically and unconditionally released and
discharged upon the release and discharge of the Initial Lien to which it
relates. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the restrictions set forth in this
paragraph shall not apply if at the time of, and immediately after giving PRO
FORMA effect to, the transaction giving rise to such Initial Lien, the
Consolidated Indebtedness-to-Stockholders' Equity Ratio does not exceed 4.0 to
1.0.

          The foregoing restrictions shall not apply to:

               (i) Liens securing obligations outstanding from time to time
          under any revolving credit agreement to which the Company is a party;

               (ii) Liens on assets existing at the time of acquisition thereof
          by the Company, provided that such Liens were in existence prior to
          such acquisition and were not created in contemplation of such
          acquisition;

               (iii) Liens on assets of another Person existing at the time such
          Person is merged into or consolidated with the Company, provided that
          such Liens were in existence prior to such merger or consolidation and
          were not created in contemplation of such merger or consolidation and
          do not extend to any assets of the Company other than those previously
          owned by the Person merged into or consolidated with the Company;

               (iv) Liens securing Purchase Money Indebtedness, but only on
          assets in respect to the purchase of which such Purchase Money
          Indebtedness shall have been incurred;

               (v) Liens on real property;

               (vi) Liens in favor of any subsidiary of the Company;

               (vii) Liens incurred or deposits made in the ordinary course of
          business (1) in connection with workers' compensation, unemployment
          insurance, social security or other like laws, (2) to secure the
          performance of letters of credit, bids, tenders, trade contracts
          (other than for borrowed money), sales contracts, leases, statutory
          obligations, surety, appeal and performance bonds and other similar
          obligations, (3) in connection with the opening of commercial letters
          of credit naming the Company or any of its subsidiaries as an account
          party or (4) for the benefit of any governmental agency or body
          created or approved by law or governmental regulation as a condition
          to the transaction of business or the exercise of any privilege,
          franchise or license;

               (viii) Liens securing Lease Obligations; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that
          no such Lease Obligations shall arise out of the Sale and Leaseback of
          Transportation Equipment unless the Sale and Leaseback in question is
          entered into prior to, at the time of or within 180 days of the
          acquisition of the Transportation Equipment being sold and leased
          back; and PROVIDED, FURTHER, that the leasing of Transportation
          Equipment which has been remanufactured so that it is the substantial
          equivalent of new equipment shall be considered the leasing of new
          equipment and not of the used equipment which was remanufactured and
          subsequently sold and leased back;

               (ix) Liens for taxes, assessments or governmental charges or
          claims that are not yet delinquent or that are being contested in good
          faith by appropriate proceedings, provided that any reserve or other
          appropriate provision as shall be required in conformity with
          generally accepted accounting principles shall have been made
          therefor;

               (x) Liens imposed by law, including but not limited to carriers',
          seamen's, stevedores', wharfinger's, warehousemen's, mechanics',
          suppliers', materialmen's, repairman's or other like Liens, in each
          case for sums not yet due or being contested in good faith by
          appropriate proceedings, or other Liens arising out of judgments or
          awards against the Company or any of its subsidiaries with respect to
          which the Company or such subsidiary shall then be proceeding with an
          appeal or other proceeding for review;

               (xi) Leases, lease agreements and other contracts entered into in
          the ordinary course of business providing for the leasing, sale or
          exchange of Transportation Equipment owned by the Company;

               (xii)  Liens securing hedging obligations;

               (xiii) Liens (x) existing on the date of the Indenture or (y) to
          secure any Refinancing (or successive Refinancings), in whole or in
          part, of any Indebtedness (or commitment for Indebtedness) existing on
          the date of the Indenture, provided, however, that the Indebtedness
          secured by such Lien is not, solely by virtue of such Refinancing,
          increased to an amount greater than the greater of (A) the outstanding
          principal amount of such Indebtedness existing on the date of the
          Indenture that is secured by such Lien, or (B) if such Lien secures
          Indebtedness under a line of credit, the commitment amount of such
          line of credit existing on the date of the Indenture; and

               (xiv)  Liens incurred in the ordinary course of business of the
          Company with respect to obligations that do not exceed $1.0 million at
          any one time outstanding and that (x) are not incurred in connection
          with the borrowing of money or the obtaining of advances or credit
          (other than trade credit in the ordinary course of business) and (y)
          do not in the aggregate materially detract from the value of the
          assets subject to such Lien or materially impair the use thereof in
          the operation of business by the Company.

          "CONSOLIDATED INDEBTEDNESS-TO-STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY RATIO" means at any
date of determination (the "Determination Date"), the ratio of (i) the aggregate
Debt of the Company and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis as at the
Determination Date to (ii) the sum of (w) the stockholders' equity of the
Company and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis calculated in accordance
with generally accepted accounting principles as at the Determination Date, (x)
the amount set forth on the consolidated balance sheet of the Company and its
Subsidiaries under the caption "Company-obligated mandatorily redeemable
preferred securities in subsidiary grantor trusts" or a similar caption, (y) to
the extent not included in clause (w), the aggregate amount of preferred stock
of the Company (as reflected on the consolidated balance sheet of the Company
calculated in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles) which is
not subject to mandatory redemption prior to the maturity date of the Exchange
Notes and (z) the Subordinated Indebtedness of the Company as to which no
principal payments are due until after the maturity date of the Notes (to the
extent such Subordinated Indebtedness was included in the calculation of Debt in
clause (i) above).

          "DEBT" means (a) the principal of all indebtedness (i) for borrowed
money or (ii) for the deferred purchase price of property unless the price
thereof was payable in full within 12 months from the date on which the
obligation was created or (iii) evidenced by notes, bonds or other instruments,
and (b) all Lease Obligations; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that, except for purposes of
the definition of Consolidated Indebtedness-to-Stockholders' Equity Ratio, Debt
shall not include Subordinated Indebtedness as to which no principal payments
are due until after the maturity date of the Exchange Notes.

          "LEASE OBLIGATION" of a Person means all rental obligations under
leases of property (other than electronic data processing and computer equipment
and leases of office space by such Person or its subsidiaries) either (a) which
are Capitalized Leases, or (b) if not Capitalized Leases, which are leases of
equipment which had an initial term of more than three years (including any
renewal term at the option of the lessor). The amount of Lease Obligations shall
be equal to the aggregate value of rentals payable (other than rentals
consisting of taxes, indemnities, maintenance items, replacements and other
similar charges which are in addition to the basic financial rent for the use of
the property) by the lessee thereof during the remaining term thereof, including
periods of renewal at the option of the lessor, discounted to present value
using the lessee's "incremental borrowing rate at the inception of the lease" in
accordance with Financial Accounting Standards No. 13 of the Financial Standards
Board from time to time in effect.

          "PURCHASE MONEY INDEBTEDNESS" of a Person means all Debt (excluding
all Lease Obligations) of such Person which is Secured Indebtedness incurred to
finance the purchase of assets if such Debt (a) shall have been incurred within
180 days of the acquisition of such assets by the Person whose Purchase Money
Indebtedness is being determined and (b) does not exceed in principal amount the
initial cost of such assets and shall include all extensions, renewals and
refinancings of such Debt not in excess of the principal amount thereof
outstanding immediately prior to such extension, renewal or refinancing. The
initial cost of assets may include, in addition to the purchase price thereof
and the purchase price of all accessories and equipment installed thereon, all
freight, delivery and handling charges, excise, sales and use taxes and all
other amounts which may be capitalized and included in the cost of the assets
under generally accepted accounting principles.

          "SALE AND LEASEBACK," with respect to a Person, means any transaction
with a bank, company, lender or investor providing for the leasing by such
Person of any property which has been or is to be sold or transferred by such
Person to such bank, company, lender or investor, or of any Person to whom funds
have been or are to be advanced by such bank, company, lender or investor on the
security of such property.

          "SECURED INDEBTEDNESS" means with respect to a Person all Debt which
is secured by any security interest, mortgage, charge, pledge, deed of trust, or
other similar lien on assets by the owner thereof and includes all Lease
Obligations. Transportation Equipment which is subject to a lease or contract
which is included as a Lease Obligation is deemed to secure the Debt evidenced
thereby.

          "SUBORDINATED INDEBTEDNESS" means Debt of the Company which is
expressly subordinated and subject in right of payment to the prior payment, in
bankruptcy or in the event of a payment default on the Exchange Notes, in full
in money or money's worth in accordance with their terms, of all principal of,
premium, if any, and interest on the Notes.

          "SUBSIDIARY" of a Person means (i) any corporation more than 50% the
outstanding voting power of which is owned or controlled, directly or
indirectly, by such Person or by one or more other subsidiaries of such Person,
or by such Person and one or more other subsidiaries thereof, or (ii) any
limited partnership of which such Person or any subsidiary of such Person is a
general partner, or (iii) any other Person (other than a corporation or limited
partnership) in which such Person and one or more subsidiaries thereof, directly
or indirectly, has more than 60% of the outstanding partnership or similar
interests or has the power, by contract or otherwise, to direct or cause the
direction of the policies, management and affairs thereof.

          "TRANSPORTATION EQUIPMENT" means domestic and marine containers,
trucks, tractors, trailers, chassis, cranes, portable ramps, lifting equipment,
railroad locomotives, railroad rolling stock, modular office units, mobile
office and storage trailers and all other transportation equipment, and includes
all accessories and attachments thereto.

CONSOLIDATION, MERGER, SALE OR CONVEYANCE

          The Indenture provides that the Company may merge or consolidate with,
or sell or convey all or substantially all of its assets to, any other
corporation, provided that (i) either the Company shall be the continuing
entity, or the successor entity (if other than the Company) shall be any entity
organized and existing under the laws of the United States or a state thereof or
the District of Columbia and such entity shall expressly assume by supplemental
indenture all of the obligations of the Company under the Notes and the
Indenture, (ii) immediately after giving effect to such transactions no Default
or Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, and (iii) the Company
shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officer's Certificate and opinion of
counsel, stating that the transaction and supplemental indenture comply with the
Indenture.

MODIFICATION OF THE INDENTURE

          Under the Indenture, with certain exceptions, the rights and
obligations of the Company with respect to the Exchange Notes and the rights of
holders of the Exchange Notes may only be modified by the Company and the
Trustee with the consent of the holders of at least a majority in principal
amount of the outstanding Exchange Notes. However, without the consent of each
holder of Exchange Notes affected, an amendment, waiver or supplement may not
(i) reduce the principal of, or rate of interest on, any Exchange Notes; (ii)
change the stated maturity date of the principal of, or any installment of
interest on, any Exchange Notes; (iii) waive a default in the payment of the
principal amount of, or the interest on, or any premium payable on redemption
of, any Exchange Notes; (iv) change the currency for payment of the principal
of, or premium or interest on, any Exchange Notes; (v) impair the right to
institute suit for the enforcement of any such payment when due; (vi) reduce the
amount of outstanding Exchange Notes necessary to consent to an amendment,
supplement or waiver provided for in the Indenture; or (vii) modify any
provisions of the Indenture relating to the modification and amendment of the
Indenture or waivers of past defaults, except as otherwise specified.

DISCHARGE, DEFEASANCE AND COVENANT DEFEASANCE

          The Company is permitted under the Indenture to discharge certain
obligations to holders of the Exchange Notes issued thereunder that have not
already been delivered to the Trustee for cancellation and that either have
become due and payable or will become due and payable within one year (or
scheduled for redemption within one year) by irrevocably depositing with the
Trustee, in trust, funds in such currency in which the Exchange Notes are
payable in an amount sufficient to pay the entire indebtedness on the Exchange
Notes in respect of principal (and premium, if any) and interest to the date of
such deposit (if the Exchange Notes have become due and payable) or to the
stated maturity and redemption date, as the case may be.

          The Indenture provides that the Company may elect either (a) to
defease and be discharged from any and all obligations with respect to the
Exchange Notes (except for the obligation to pay additional amounts, if any,
upon the occurrence of certain events of tax, assessment or governmental charge
with respect to payments on such Exchange Notes and the obligations to register
the transfer or exchange of such Exchange Notes, to replace temporary or
mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Exchange Notes, to maintain an office or
agency in respect of such Exchange Notes and to hold moneys for payment in
trust) ("defeasance"), or (b) to be released from its obligations with respect
to such Exchange Notes under the restrictions described under "--Certain
Covenants" or its obligations with respect to any other covenant, and any
omission to comply with such obligations will not constitute an Event of Default
with respect to such Exchange Notes ("covenant defeasance"), in either case upon
the irrevocable deposit by the Company with the Trustee, in trust, of an amount,
in cash in United States dollars, or Government Obligations, or both, applicable
to such Exchange Notes which through the scheduled payment of principal and
interest in accordance with their terms will provide money in an amount
sufficient to pay the principal of (and premium, if any) and interest on such
Exchange Notes on the scheduled due dates therefor.

          Such a trust will only be permitted to be established if, among other
things, the Company has delivered to the Trustee an opinion of counsel to the
effect that the holders of such Exchange Notes will not recognize income, gain
or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes as a result of such defeasance or
covenant defeasance and will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on the same
amounts, in the same manner and at the same times as would have been the case if
such defeasance or covenant defeasance had not occurred, and such opinion of
counsel, in the case of defeasance, will be required to refer to and be based
upon a ruling of the Internal Revenue Service or a change in applicable United
States federal income tax law occurring after the date of the Indenture.

          If the Company effects covenant defeasance with respect to the
Exchange Notes and such Exchange Notes are declared due and payable because of
an Event of Default, the amount in cash in United States dollars and Government
Obligations on deposit with the Trustee, will be sufficient to pay amounts due
on such Exchange Notes at the time of their stated maturity but may not be
sufficient to pay amounts due on such Exchange Notes at the time of the
acceleration resulting from such Event of Default. However, the Company would
remain liable to make payment of such amounts due at the time of acceleration.

          "GOVERNMENT OBLIGATIONS" means securities which are (a) direct
obligations of the United States of America, for the payment of which its full
faith and credit is pledged, or (b) obligations of a person controlled or
supervised by and acting as an agency or instrumentality of the United States of
America, the payment of which is unconditionally guaranteed as a full faith and
credit obligation by the United States of America which are not callable or
redeemable at the option of the issuer thereof, and will also include a
depository receipt issued by a bank or trust as custodian with respect to any
such Government Obligation or a specific payment of interest on or principal of
any such Government Obligation held by such custodian for the account of the
holder of a depositary receipt, provided that (except as required by law) such
custodian is not authorized to make any deduction from the amount payable to the
holder of such depository receipt from any amount received by the custodian in
respect of the Government Obligation or the specific payment of interest on or
principal of the Government Obligation evidenced by such depository receipt.

EVENTS OF DEFAULT, NOTICE AND WAIVER

          The following are Events of Default under the Indenture: (i) default
in the payment of interest on the Exchange Notes when due and payable, which
continues for 30 days; (ii) default in the payment of principal of the Exchange
Notes when due and payable at maturity; (iii) failure to perform any other
covenant of the Company contained in the Indenture or the Exchange Notes which
continues for 60 days after written notice as provided in the Indenture; (iv)
default under any bond, debenture or other Indebtedness of the Company or any
subsidiary if (a) either (x) such event of default results from the failure to
pay any such Indebtedness at maturity or (y) as a result of such event of
default, the maturity of such Indebtedness has been accelerated prior to its
expressed maturity and such acceleration shall not be rescinded or annulled or
the accelerated amount paid within 10 days after notice to the Company of such
acceleration, or such Indebtedness having been discharged, and (b) the principal
amount of such Indebtedness, together with the principal amount of any other
such Indebtedness in default for failure to pay principal or interest thereon,
or the maturity of which has been so accelerated, aggregates $10,000,000 or
more; and (v) certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization
relating to the Company.

          If an Event of Default occurs and is continuing with respect to the
Exchange Notes, either the Trustee or the holders of a majority in aggregate
principal amount of the outstanding Exchange Notes may declare the Exchange
Notes due and payable immediately.

          The Company will not declare or pay any dividends or make any
distribution to holders of its capital stock (other than dividends or
distributions payable in capital stock of the Company) if at the time of any of
the aforementioned actions an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or
would exist immediately after giving effect to such action, except for the
payment of any dividend within 60 days after the date of declaration when the
payment would have complied with the foregoing provisions on the date of
declaration.

          The Indenture provides that the Trustee will, within 90 days after the
occurrence of any Default or Event of Default with respect to the Notes, give to
the holders of the Exchange Notes notice of all uncured Defaults and Events of
Default known to it, but the Trustee will be protected in withholding such
notice if it in good faith determines that the withholding of such notice is in
the interest of such holders, except in the case of a default in the payment of
the principal of (or premium, if any) or interest on any of the Notes.

          The Indenture provides that the holders of a majority in aggregate
principal amount of the Exchange Notes then outstanding may direct the time,
method and place of conducting any proceedings for any remedy available to the
Trustee or exercising any trust or power conferred on the Trustee with respect
to the Exchange Notes. The right of a holder to institute a proceeding with
respect to the Indenture is subject to certain conditions precedent including
notice and indemnity to the Trustee, but the holder has an absolute right to
receipt of principal of (and premium, if any) and interest on such holder's
Exchange Notes on or after the respective due dates expressed in the Exchange
Notes, and to institute suit for the enforcement of any such payments.

          The holders of a majority in principal amount of the Exchange Notes
then outstanding may on behalf of the holders of all Exchange Notes waive
certain past defaults, except a default in payment of the principal of (or
premium, if any) or interest on any Exchange Notes or in respect of certain
provisions of the Indenture which cannot be modified or amended without the
consent of the holder of each Exchange Note affected thereby.

          The Company will be required to furnish to the Trustee annually a
statement of certain officers of the Company stating whether or not they know of
any Default or Events of Default and, if they have knowledge of a Default or
Event of Default, a description of the efforts to remedy the same.

GOVERNING LAW

          The Exchange Notes and the Indenture will be governed by and construed
in accordance with the laws of the State of New York, without giving effect to
its conflicts of law rules.

FORM, DENOMINATION, BOOK-ENTRY PROCEDURES AND TRANSFER

          The Exchange Notes initially will be represented by one or more Notes
in registered, global form (collectively, the "Global Exchange Notes"). The
Global Exchange Notes will be deposited upon issuance with the Trustee as
custodian for DTC in New York, New York, and registered in the name of DTC or
its nominee, in each case for credit to an account of a direct or indirect
participant in DTC as described below.

          Except as set forth below, the Global Exchange Notes may be
transferred, in whole and not in part, only to another nominee of DTC or to a
successor of DTC or its nominee. Beneficial interests in the Global Exchange
Notes may not be exchanged for Exchange Notes in certificated form except in the
limited circumstances described under "--Exchange of Book-Entry Exchange Notes
for Certificated Exchange Notes" below.

          Other Exchange Notes will be issued only in registered, certificated
(I.E., non-global) form. Other Exchange Notes may not be exchanged for
beneficial interests in any Global Exchange Notes except in the limited
circumstances described below. See "--Exchange of Certificated Exchange Notes
for Book-Entry Exchange Notes."

DEPOSITARY PROCEDURES

          DTC has advised the Company that DTC is a limited-purpose trust
company created to hold securities for its participating organizations
(collectively, the "Participants") and to facilitate the clearance and
settlement of transactions in those securities between Participants through
electronic book-entry changes in accounts of its Participants. The Participants
include securities brokers and dealers (including the Initial Purchaser), banks,
trust companies, clearing corporations and certain other organizations. Access
to DTC's system is also available to other entities such as banks, brokers,
dealers and trust companies that clear through or maintain a custodial
relationship with a Participant, either directly or indirectly (collectively,
the "Indirect Participants"). Persons who are not Participants may beneficially
own securities held by or on behalf of DTC only through the Participants or the
Indirect Participants. The ownership interest and transfer of ownership interest
of each actual purchaser of each security held by or on behalf of DTC are
recorded on the records of the Participants and Indirect Participants.

          DTC has also advised the Company that, pursuant to procedures
established by it, (i) upon deposit of the Global Exchange Notes, DTC will
credit the accounts of Participants designated by the Initial Purchaser with
portions of the principal amount of the Global Exchange Notes and (ii) ownership
of such interests in the Global Exchange Notes will be shown on, and the
transfer of ownership thereof will be effected only through, records maintained
by DTC (with respect to the Participants) or by the Participants and the
Indirect Participants (with respect to other owners of beneficial interests in
the Global Exchange Notes).

          Investors in the Global Exchange Notes may hold their interests
therein directly through DTC if they are Participants in such system or
indirectly through organizations which are Participants in such system. All
interests in a Global Exchange Note will be subject to the procedures and
requirements of DTC. The laws of some states require that certain persons take
physical delivery in certificated form of securities that they own.
Consequently, the ability to transfer beneficial interests in a Global Exchange
Note to such persons will be limited to that extent. Because DTC can act only on
behalf of Participants, which in turn act on behalf of Indirect Participants and
certain banks, the ability of a person having beneficial interests in a Global
Exchange Note to pledge such interests to persons or entities that do not
participate in the DTC system, or otherwise take actions in respect of such
interests, may be affected by the lack of a physical certificate evidencing such
interests. For certain other restrictions on the transferability of the Notes,
see "--Exchange of Book-Entry Notes for Certificated Notes" and "--Exchange of
Certificated Notes for Book-Entry Notes" below.

          Except as described below, owners of interests in the Global Exchange
Notes will not have Notes registered in their name, will not receive physical
delivery of Notes in certificated form and will not be considered the registered
owners or holders thereof under the Indenture for any purpose.

          Payments in respect of the Global Exchange Note registered in the name
of DTC or its nominee will be payable by the Trustee to DTC in its capacity as
the registered holder under the Indenture. Under the terms of the Indenture, the
Trustee will treat the persons in whose names the Notes, including the Global
Exchange Notes, are registered as the owners thereof for the purpose of
receiving such payments and for any and all other purposes whatsoever.
Consequently, neither the Trustee nor any agent thereof has or will have any
responsibility or liability for (i) any aspect of DTC's records or any
Participant's or Indirect Participant's records relating to or payments made on
account of beneficial ownership interests in the Global Exchange Notes, or for
maintaining, supervising or reviewing any of DTC's records or any Participant's
or Indirect Participant's records relating to the beneficial ownership interests
in the Global Exchange Notes or (ii) any other matter relating to the actions
and practices of DTC or any of its Participants or Indirect Participants. DTC
has advised the Company that its current practice, upon receipt of any payment
in respect of securities such as the Notes, is to credit the accounts of the
relevant Participants with the payment on the payment date, in amounts
proportionate to their respective holdings in principal amount of beneficial
interests in the relevant security as shown on the records of DTC unless DTC has
reason to believe it will not receive payment on such payment date. Payments by
the Participants and the Indirect Participants to the beneficial owners of Notes
will be governed by standing instructions and customary practices and will be
the responsibility of the Participants or the Indirect Participants and will not
be the responsibility of DTC, the Trustee or the Company. Neither the Company
nor the Trustee will be liable for any delay by DTC or any of its Participants
in identifying the beneficial owners of the Notes, and the Company and the
Trustee may conclusively rely on and will be protected in relying on
instructions from DTC or its nominee for all purposes.

          Interests in the Global Exchange Notes will trade in DTC's Same-Day
Funds Settlement System and secondary market trading activity in such interests
will therefore settle in immediately available funds, subject in all cases to
the rules and procedures of DTC and its Participants and Indirect Participants.
Transfers among Participants and Indirect Participants in DTC will be effected
in accordance with DTC's procedures, and will be settled in same-day funds.

          DTC has advised the Company that it will take any action permitted to
be taken by a holder of Notes only at the direction of one or more Participants
to whose account with DTC interests in the Global Exchange Notes are credited
and only in respect of such portion of the principal amount of the Notes as to
which such Participant or Participants has or have given such direction.
However, if there is an Event of Default under the Indenture, DTC reserves the
right to exchange the Global Exchange Notes for legended Notes in certificated
form and to distribute such Notes to its Participants.

          The information in this section concerning DTC and its book-entry
system has been obtained from sources that the Company believe to be reliable,
but the Company does not take responsibility for the accuracy thereof.

          Although DTC has agreed to the foregoing procedures to facilitate
transfers of interest in the Global Exchange Notes among Participants in DTC, it
is under no obligation to perform or to continue to perform such procedures, and
such procedures may be discontinued at any time. Neither the Company nor the
Trustee will have any responsibility for the performance by DTC or its
Participants or Indirect Participants of their respective obligations under the
rules and procedures governing DTC's operations.

EXCHANGE OF BOOK-ENTRY EXCHANGE NOTES FOR CERTIFICATED EXCHANGE NOTES

          A Global Exchange Note is exchangeable for Notes in registered
certificated form if (i) DTC (x) notifies the Company that it is unwilling or
unable to continue as Depositary for the Global Exchange Note and the Company
thereupon fails to appoint a successor Depositary within 90 days or (y) has
ceased to be a clearing agency registered under the Exchange Act, (ii) the
Company in its sole discretion elects to cause the issuance of the Notes in
certificated form or (iii) there shall have occurred and be continuing an Event
of Default or any event which after notice or lapse of time or both would be an
Event of Default under the Indenture. In addition, beneficial interests in a
Global Exchange Note may be exchanged for certificated Notes upon request but
only upon at least 20 days prior written notice given to the Trustee by or on
behalf of DTC in accordance with customary procedures. In all cases,
certificated Notes delivered in exchange for any Global Exchange Note or
beneficial interests therein will be registered in the names, and issued in any
approved denominations, requested by or on behalf of the Depositary (in
accordance with its customary procedures) and will bear the legend referred to
in "Notice to Investors," unless the Trustee determines otherwise in compliance
with applicable law.

EXCHANGE OF CERTIFICATED NOTES FOR BOOK-ENTRY NOTES

          Other Notes, which will be issued in certificated form, may not be
exchanged for beneficial interests in any Global Exchange Note unless such
exchange occurs in connection with a transfer of such Other Notes and the
transferor first delivers to the Trustee a written certificate (in the form
provided in the Indenture) to the effect that such transfer will comply with the
appropriate transfer restrictions applicable to such Notes.

PAYMENT AND PAYING AGENT

          Payments in respect of the Global Notes held in global form shall be
made to the Depositary, which shall credit the relevant accounts at the
Depositary on the applicable payment dates. In respect of the Notes that are not
held by the Depositary, such payments shall be made by check mailed to the
address of the holder entitled thereto as such address shall appear on the
register. The paying agent (the "Paying Agent") shall initially be the Trustee
and any co-paying agent chosen by the Trustee and acceptable to the Company. The
Paying Agent shall be permitted to resign as Paying Agent upon 30 days' written
notice to the Trustee and the Company. In the event that the Trustee shall no
longer be the Paying Agent, the Company shall appoint a successor (which shall
be a bank or trust company) to act as Paying Agent.

          Any moneys deposited with the Trustee or any Paying Agent, or then
held by the Company in trust, for the payment of the principal of (and premium,
if any) or interest on any Exchange Notes and remaining unclaimed for two years
after such principal or interest has become due and payable shall, at the
request of the Company, be repaid to the Company and the holder of such Exchange
Notes shall thereafter look, as a general unsecured creditor, only to the
Company for payment thereof.

INFORMATION CONCERNING THE TRUSTEE

          The Trustee under the Indenture is United States Trust Company of New
York.

          The Trustee will act as registrar and transfer agent for the Exchange
Notes. Registration of transfers of the Exchange Notes will be effected without
charge by or on behalf of the Company, but upon payment of any tax or other
governmental charges that may be imposed in connections with any transfer or
exchange.

          The Trustee is subject to all the duties and responsibilities
specified with respect to an indenture trustee under the Trust Indenture Act.
Subject to such provisions, the Trustee is under no obligation to exercise any
of the powers vested in it by the Indenture at the request of any holder of
Exchange Notes, unless offered reasonable indemnity by such holder against the
costs, expenses and liabilities which might be incurred thereby. The Trustee is
not required to expend or risk its own funds or otherwise incur personal
financial liability in the performance of its duties if the Trustee reasonably
believes that repayment or adequate indemnity is not reasonably assured to it.

                          DESCRIPTION OF PRIVATE NOTES

          The terms of the Private Notes are identical in all material respects
to the Exchange Notes, except that (i) the Private Notes have not been
registered under the Securities Act, are subject to certain restrictions on
transfer and are entitled to certain rights under the applicable Registration
Rights Agreement (which rights will terminate upon consummation of the Exchange
Offer, except under limited circumstances), (ii) the Exchange Notes will not
contain other restrictions on transfer applicable to Private Notes, and (iii)
the Exchange Notes will not provide for payment of additional distributions
thereon. The Private Notes provide that, in the event that the Exchange Offer is
not consummated within 30 days after the date notice of the Exchange Offer has
been mailed to holders of the Private Notes or, in certain limited
circumstances, in the event a shelf registration statement (the "Shelf
Registration Statement") with respect to the resale of the Private Notes is not
declared effective within 150 days of February 24, 1998, then liquidated damages
will accrue (in addition to the stated interest rate on the Private Notes) at
the rate of 0.25% per annum on the principal amount of the Private Notes and
additional Distributions will accrue (in addition to the stated Distribution
rate on the Private Notes) at the rate of 0.25% per annum on the principal
amount of the Private Notes, for the period from the occurrence of such event
until such time as such required Exchange Offer is consummated or any required
Shelf Registration Statement is effective. The Exchange Notes are not, and upon
consummation of the Exchange Offer the Private Notes will not be, entitled to
any such liquidated damages or additional Distributions. Accordingly, holders of
Private Notes should review the information set forth under "Risk
Factors--Certain Consequences of a Failure to Exchange Private Notes" and
"Description of Exchange Notes."

                    CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS

          The exchange of the Private Notes for Exchange Notes should not be a
taxable event to holders of Notes for United States federal income tax purposes.
The exchange of Private Notes for Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer
should not be treated as an "exchange" for United States federal income tax
purposes because the Exchange Notes should not be considered to differ
materially in kind or extent from the Private Notes and because the exchange
will occur by operation of the terms of the Private Notes. If, however, the
exchange of the Private Notes for the Exchange Notes were treated as an exchange
for United States federal income tax purposes, such exchange should constitute a
non-taxable recapitalization for United States federal income tax purposes.
Accordingly, the Exchange Notes should have the same issue price as the Private
Notes, and a holder should have the same adjusted tax basis and holding period
in the Exchange Notes as the holder had in the Private Notes immediately before
the exchange.

                              ERISA CONSIDERATIONS

          Each of the Company and its affiliates and the Trustee may be
considered a "party in interest" (within the meaning of the Employee Retirement
Income Security Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA")) or a "disqualified person"
(within the meaning of Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as
amended (the "Code")) with respect to many employee benefit plans ("Plans") that
are subject to ERISA. Any purchaser proposing to acquire Exchange Notes with
assets of any Plan should consult with its counsel. The purchase and/or holding
of Exchange Notes by a Plan that is subject to the fiduciary responsibility
provisions of ERISA or the prohibited transaction provisions of Section 4975 of
the Code (including individual retirement arrangements and other plans described
in Section 4975(e)(1) of the Code) and with respect to which the Company, the
Trustee or any affiliate is a service provider (or otherwise is a party in
interest or a disqualified person) may constitute or result in a prohibited
transaction under ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code, unless such Exchange Notes
are acquired pursuant to and in accordance with an applicable exemption, such as
Prohibited Transaction Class Exemption ("PTCE") 84-14 (an exemption for certain
transactions determined by an independent qualified professional asset manager),
PTCE 91-38 (an exemption for certain transactions involving bank collective
investment funds), PTCE 90-1 (an exemption for certain transactions involving
insurance company pooled separate accounts), PTCE 95-60 (an exemption for
transactions involving certain insurance company general accounts), or PTCE
95-23 (an exemption for certain transactions determined by an in-house asset
manager).

                              PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

          Based on an interpretation by the staff of the Commission set forth in
no-action letters issued to third parties, the Company believes that the
Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer in exchange for Private
Notes may be offered for resale, resold and otherwise transferred by a holder
thereof (other than (i) an "affiliate" of the Company within the meaning of Rule
405 under the Securities Act, (ii) a broker-dealer who acquired Private Notes
directly from the Company to resell pursuant to Rule 144A or any other available
exemption under the Securities Act or (iii) a broker-dealer who acquired Private
Notes as a result of market making or other trading activities), without
compliance with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the
Securities Act; PROVIDED that the holder is acquiring Exchange Notes in the
ordinary course of its business and is not participating, and has no arrangement
or understanding with any person to participate, in the distribution of the
Exchange Notes. Holders of Private Notes wishing to accept the Exchange Offer
must represent to the Company, as required by the Registration Rights Agreement,
that such conditions have been met. The Company believes that none of the
registered holders of the Private Notes is an affiliate (as such term is defined
in Rule 405 under the Securities Act) of the Company.

          Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account in
exchange for Private Notes must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in
connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes. The Letter of Transmittal
states that by so acknowledging and by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer
will not be deemed to admit that it is an "underwriter" within the meaning of
the Securities Act. This Prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from
time to time, may be used by a broker-dealer in connection with resales of
Exchange Notes received in exchange for Private Notes, where such Private Notes
were acquired by such broker-dealer as a result of market-making activities or
other trading activities. The Company has agreed to make this Prospectus (as it
may be amended or supplemented) available to any broker-dealer, upon request,
for use in connection with any such resale, for a period of one year after the
Registration Statement is declared effective by the Commission or until such
earlier date on which all the Exchange Notes are freely tradeable. However, any
broker-dealer who acquired the Notes directly from the Company may not fulfill
its prospectus delivery requirements with this Prospectus, but must comply with
the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act.

          The Company will not receive any proceeds from any sale of the
Exchange Notes by broker-dealers or any other persons. Exchange Notes received
by broker-dealers for their own accounts pursuant to the Exchange Offer may be
sold for time to time in one or more transactions in the over-the-counter
market, in negotiated transactions, through the writing of options on the
Exchange Notes or a combination of such methods of resale, at market prices
prevailing at the time of such resale, at prices related to such prevailing
market prices or at negotiated prices. Any such resale may be made directly to
purchasers or to or through brokers or dealers who may receive compensation in
the form of commissions or concessions from any such broker-dealer and/or
purchasers of any such Exchange Notes. Any broker-dealer that resells Exchange
Notes that were received by it for its own account pursuant to the Exchange
Offer and any broker or dealer that participates in the distribution of such
Exchange Notes may be deemed to be an "underwriter" within the meaning of the
Securities Act and any profit on any such resale of Exchange Notes and any
commissions or concessions received by any such persons may be deemed to be
underwriting compensation under the Securities Act. The Letter of Transmittal
states that by acknowledging that it will deliver and by delivering a
prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit that it is an
"underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act.

          By acceptance of this Exchange Offer, each broker-dealer that receives
Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer agrees that, upon receipt of
notice from the Company of the happening of any event which makes any statement
in the Prospectus untrue in any material respect or which requires the making of
any changes in the Prospectus in order to make the statements therein not
misleading (which notice the Company agrees to deliver promptly to such
broker-dealer), such broker-dealer will suspend use of the Prospectus until the
Company has amended or supplemented the Prospectus to correct such misstatement
or omission and has furnished copies of the amended or supplemented Prospectus
to such broker-dealer. If the Company shall give any such notice to suspend the
use of the Prospectus, it shall extend the one-year period referred to above by
the number of days during the period from and including the date of the giving
of such notice to and including the date when the broker-dealers shall have
received copies of the supplemented or amended Prospectus necessary to permit
resales of the Exchange Notes.

          The Company has agreed to pay all expenses incident to the Company's
performance of, or compliance with, the Registration Rights Agreement and will
indemnify the holders (including any broker-dealers) and certain parties related
to the holders against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the
Securities Act.

                                  LEGAL MATTERS

          The legality of the Exchange Notes will be passed upon on behalf of
the Company by Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP, New York, New York.

                                     EXPERTS

          The consolidated financial statements of the Company included in the
Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K incorporated by reference into this
Prospectus have been audited by Arthur Andersen LLP, independent public
accountants, as indicated in their reports with respect thereto, and are
incorporated herein by reference in reliance upon the authority of said firm as
experts in giving said reports.

<PAGE>

                                     PART II

                     INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

ITEM 20.  INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS.

          Section 145 of the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware
(the "DGCL") provides, in summary, that directors and officers of Delaware
corporations are entitled, under certain circumstances, to be indemnified
against all expenses and liabilities (including attorneys' fees) incurred by
them as a result of suits brought against them in their capacity as a director
or officer, if they acted in good faith and in a manner they reasonably believed
to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation, and, with
respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe
their conduct was unlawful; provided, that no indemnification may be made
against expenses in respect of any claim, issue or matter as to which they shall
have been adjudged to be liable to the corporation, unless and only to the
extent that the court in which such action or suit was brought shall determine
upon application that, despite the adjudication of liability but in view of all
the circumstances of the case, they are fairly and reasonably entitled to
indemnity for such expenses which such court shall deem proper. Any such
indemnification may be made by the corporation only as authorized in each
specific case upon a determination by the stockholders or disinterested
directors that indemnification is proper because the indemnitee has met the
applicable standard of conduct. Article Ninth of the Company's Certificate of
Incorporation entitles officers, directors and controlling persons of the
Company to indemnification to the full extent permitted by Section 145 of the
DGCL, as the same may be supplemented or amended from time to time.

          Article Ninth of the Company's Certificate of Incorporation provides
that no director shall have any personal liability to the Company or its
stockholders for any monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a
director, provided that such provision does not limit or eliminate the liability
of any director (i) for breach of such director's duty or loyalty to the Company
or its stockholders, (ii) for acts or omissions not in good faith or which
involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of law, (iii) under
Section 174 of the DGCL (involving certain unlawful dividends or stock
repurchases) or (iv) for any transaction from which such director derived an
improper personal benefit. The provisions of such article do not limit or
eliminate the liability of any director for any act or omission occurring prior
to the effective time of such amendment.

          Reference is made to Section 4 of the Registration Rights Agreement
included in Exhibit 4.3 hereto which provides certain indemnification rights to
the directors and officers of the Company.

ITEM 21.  EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES.

EXHIBIT
   NO.                             DESCRIPTION
- -------                            -----------

4.1                Indenture between Interpool, Inc. and United States Trust
                   Company of New York, as trustee, relating to the Notes, dated
                   February 24, 1998.*

4.2                Form of Exchange Note (included in Exhibit 4.1 hereto).*

4.3                Registration Rights Agreement between Interpool, Inc. and
                   Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation, as
                   initial purchaser, dated February 24, 1998.*

5.1                Opinion of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP as to the legality
                   of the Exchange Notes.*

23.1               Consent of Arthur Andersen LLP.*

23.2               Consent of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP (included in
                   Exhibit 5.1).*

24                 Power of Attorney of certain officers and directors of
                   Interpool, Inc. (Included on page II-5 of this Registration
                   Statement).*

25.1               Form T-1 Statement of Eligibility of United States Trust
                   Company of New York to act as trustee under the Indenture.*

99.1               Form of Letter of Transmittal.*

99.2               Form of Notice of Guaranteed Delivery.*

99.3               Form of Letter to Nominees.*

99.4               Form of Letter to Clients.*

99.5               Form of Guidelines for Certification of Taxpayer
                   Identification Number on Substitute Form W-9.*

- ---------------

*   Filed herewith

ITEM 22.  UNDERTAKINGS.

               (a) The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes that, for
          purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act, each
          filing of the Registrant's annual report pursuant to Section 13(a) or
          15(d) of the Exchange Act (and, where applicable, each filing of an
          employee benefit plan's annual report pursuant to Section 15(d) of the
          Exchange Act) that is incorporated by reference in the registration
          statement shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating
          to the securities offered therein and the offering of such securities
          at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering
          thereof.

               (b) The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes that:

                    (1) For purposes of determining any liability under the
               Securities Act, the information omitted from the form of
               prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in
               reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus
               filed by the Registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or
               497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of
               this registration statement as of the time it was declared
               effective.

                    (2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the
               Securities Act, each post-effective amendment that contains a
               form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration
               statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the
               offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be
               the initial bona fide offering thereof.

               (c) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that insofar as
          indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may
          be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the
          Registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the
          Registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and
          Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as
          expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In
          the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities
          (other than the payment by the Registrant of expenses incurred or paid
          by a director, officer or controlling person of the Registrant in the
          successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by
          such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the
          securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless in the
          opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling
          precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question
          whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as
          expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final
          adjudication of such issue.

               (d) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to respond to
          requests for information that is incorporated by reference into the
          prospectus pursuant to Item 4, 10(b), 11 or 13 of this form, within
          one business day of receipt of such request, and to send the
          incorporated documents by first class mail or other equally prompt
          means. This includes information contained in documents filed
          subsequent to the effective date of the registration statement through
          the date of responding to the request.

               (e) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to supply by
          means of a post-effective amendment all information concerning a
          transaction, and the company being acquired involved therein, that was
          not the subject of and included in the registration statement when it
          became effective.

<PAGE>

                                   SIGNATURES

          Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act, the Registrant has
duly caused this Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the
undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Princeton, State of New
Jersey, on June 4, 1998.

                                  INTERPOOL, INC.


                                  By:  /S/ MARTIN TUCHMAN
                                       ---------------------------------
                                       Martin Tuchman
                                       CHAIRMAN AND CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER

<PAGE>

                                POWER OF ATTORNEY

          KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature
appears below constitutes and appoints Martin Tuchman, Raoul J. Witteveen and
William Geoghan, and each of them, his true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and
agents with full power of substitution and resubstitution for him and in his
name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments
(including post-effective amendments) of and supplements to this Registration
Statement and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto, and other documents
in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting
unto such attorneys-in-fact and agents and each of them full power and authority
to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be
done in and about the premises, to all intents and purposes and as fully as they
might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that such
attorneys-in-fact and agents, or their substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to
be done by virtue hereof.

          Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this
Registration Statement has been signed below by the following persons in the
capacities and on the dates indicated.

    SIGNATURE                    TITLE                                DATE

/s/ MARTIN TUCHMAN          Chairman of the Board                 June 4, 1998
- -------------------         and Chief Executive Officer
Martin Tuchman              

/s/ RAOUL J. WITTEVEEN      President, Chief Operating            June 4, 1998
- -----------------------     Officer, Chief Financial
Raoul J. Witteveen          Officer and Director
                            (Principal Financial Officer)

- -----------------------     Director, Secretary and 
Arthur L. Burns             General Counsel

/s/ WILLIAM GEOGHAN         Senior Vice President of Finance      June 4, 1998
- -----------------------     and Controller (Principal
William Geoghan             Accounting Officer)

/s/ WARREN L. SERENBETZ     Director                              June 4, 1998
- ------------------------
Warren L. Serenbetz

- ------------------------    Director 
Peter D. Halstead

- ------------------------    Director
Joseph J. Whalen

/s/ MITCHELL I. GORDON      Director                              June 4, 1998
- ------------------------
Mitchell I. Gordon

<PAGE>

                                  EXHIBIT INDEX

EXHIBIT
  NO.                              DESCRIPTION
- -------                           -----------------

4.1                Indenture between Interpool, Inc. and United States Trust
                   Company of New York, as trustee, relating to the Notes, dated
                   February 24, 1998 *

4.2                Form of Exchange Note (included in Exhibit 4.1 hereto) *

4.3                Registration Rights Agreement between Interpool, Inc., and
                   Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation, as
                   initial purchaser, dated February 24, 1998 *

5.1                Opinion of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP as to the legality
                   of the Exchange Notes *

23.1               Consent of Arthur Andersen LLP *

23.2               Consent of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP (included in
                   Exhibit 5.1) *

24                 Power of Attorney of certain officers and directors of
                   Interpool, Inc. (Included on page II-5 of this Registration
                   Statement) *

25.1               Form T-1 Statement of Eligibility of United States Trust
                   Company of New York to act as trustee under the Indenture *

99.1               Form of Letter of Transmittal *

99.2               Form of Notice of Guaranteed Delivery *

99.3               Form of Letter to Nominees *

99.4               Form of Letter to Clients *

99.5               Form of Guidelines for Certification of Taxpayer
                   Identification Number on Substitute Form W-9 *

- -----------------

*  Filed herewith


 ------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                                              Exhibit 4.1

                                 INTERPOOL, INC.

                                     Issuer,


                                       and


                     UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY OF NEW YORK

                                     Trustee


                               -------------------


                                    INDENTURE


                          Dated as of February 24, 1998


                               -------------------

                                  $100,000,000

                              6-5/8% Notes due 2003


- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<PAGE>

                              CROSS-REFERENCE TABLE
                                 INTERPOOL, INC.

Trust Indenture
  ACT SECTION                                              INDENTURE
- ---------------                                            ---------

Section 310(a)(1)                                            7.10
         (a)(2)                                              7.10
         (a)(3)                                              Not Applicable
         (a)(4)                                              Not Applicable
         (a)(5)                                              7.8
         (b)                                                 7.8; 7.10
         (c)                                                 Not Applicable
Section 311(a)                                               7.11
         (b)                                                 7.11
         (c)                                                 Not Applicable
Section 312(a)                                               2.15
         (b)                                                 11.3
         (c)                                                 11.3
Section 313(a)                                               7.6
         (b)(1)                                              Not Applicable
         (b)(2)                                              7.6
         (c)                                                 7.6; 11.2
         (d)                                                 7.6
Section 314(a)                                               4.2; 11.2
         (b)                                                 Not Applicable
         (c)(1)                                              11.4
         (c)(2)                                              11.4
         (c)(3)                                              Not Applicable
         (d)                                                 Not Applicable
         (e)                                                 11.5
         (f)                                                 Not Applicable
Section 315(a)                                               7.1(b)
         (b)                                                 7.5; 11.2
         (c)                                                 7.1(a)
         (d)                                                 7.1(c)
         (e)                                                 6.10
Section 316(a)(last sentence)                                11.6
         (a)(1)(A)                                           6.5
         (a)(1)(B)                                           6.4
         (a)(2)                                              Not Applicable
         (b)                                                 6.6
Section 317(a)(1)                                            6.7
         (a)(2)                                              6.8
         (b)                                                 2.5
Section 318(a)                                               11.1

- ----------
Note:  This Cross-Reference Table shall not, for any purpose, be deemed to be
       a part of the Indenture.

<PAGE>

                                TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                                                        PAGE

                                    ARTICLE 1

                   DEFINITIONS AND INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE

SECTION 1.1    Definitions..................................................1
SECTION 1.2    Other Definitions............................................9
SECTION 1.3    Incorporation by Reference to Trust Indenture Act............9
SECTION 1.4    Rules of Construction.......................................10

                                    ARTICLE 2

                                 THE SECURITIES

SECTION 2.1    Form Generally.............................................10
SECTION 2.2    Execution and Authentication...............................11
SECTION 2.3    Form and Payment...........................................12
SECTION 2.4    Registrar and Agents.......................................12
SECTION 2.5    Paying Agent to Hold Money in Trust........................12
SECTION 2.6    Legends....................................................13
SECTION 2.7    Global Security............................................14
SECTION 2.8    Interest...................................................15
SECTION 2.9.   Transfer and Exchange......................................16
SECTION 2.10.  Replacement Securities.....................................23
SECTION 2.11.  Outstanding Securities.....................................24
SECTION 2.12.  Temporary Securities.......................................24
SECTION 2.13.  Cancellation...............................................25
SECTION 2.14.  Defaulted Interest.........................................25
SECTION 2.15.  Securityholder Lists.......................................25
SECTION 2.16.  Persons Deemed Owners......................................26
SECTION 2.17.  CUSIP Number...............................................26

                                    ARTICLE 3

                                   REDEMPTION

SECTION 3.1.   Right of Redemption........................................26
SECTION 3.2.   Selection of Securities to be Redeemed.....................27
SECTION 3.3.   Notice of Redemption by the Company........................27
SECTION 3.4.   Effect of Notice of Redemption.............................28
SECTION 3.5.   Deposit of Redemption Price................................28
SECTION 3.6.   Securities Redeemed in Part................................29

                                    ARTICLE 4

                                    COVENANTS

SECTION 4.1.   Payment of the Securities..................................29
SECTION 4.2.   Commission Reports.........................................29
SECTION 4.3.   Waiver of Stay, Extension or Usury Laws....................30
SECTION 4.4.   Notice of Default..........................................30
SECTION 4.5.   Compliance Certificates....................................30
SECTION 4.6.   Limitation on Dividends and Other Distributions............31
SECTION 4.7.   Maintenance of Office or Agency............................31
SECTION 4.8.   Existence..................................................32
SECTION 4.9.   Payment of Taxes and Other Claims..........................32
SECTION 4.10.  Maintenance of Properties..................................33
SECTION 4.11.  Insurance..................................................33
SECTION 4.12.  Limitation on Liens........................................33

                                   ARTICLE 5

                              SUCCESSOR CORPORATION

SECTION 5.1.   When Company May Merge, etc................................36
SECTION 5.2.   Successor Corporation or Trust Substituted.................36

                                    ARTICLE 6

                              DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES

SECTION 6.1.   Events of Default..........................................37
SECTION 6.2.   Acceleration...............................................39
SECTION 6.3.   Other Remedies.............................................39
SECTION 6.4.   Waiver of Defaults and Events of Default...................40
SECTION 6.5.   Control by Majority........................................40
SECTION 6.6.   Rights of Holders to Receive Payment.......................40
SECTION 6.7.   Collection Suit by Trustee.................................40
SECTION 6.8.   Trustee May File Proofs of Claim...........................41
SECTION 6.9.   Priorities.................................................41
SECTION 6.10.  Undertaking for Costs......................................42
SECTION 6.11.  Limitations on Suits.......................................42
SECTION 6.12.  Restoration of Rights and Remedies.........................43

                                    ARTICLE 7

                                     TRUSTEE

SECTION 7.1.   Duties of Trustee..........................................43
SECTION 7.2.   Rights of Trustee..........................................45
SECTION 7.3.   Individual Rights of Trustee...............................45
SECTION 7.4.   Trustee's Disclaimer.......................................46
SECTION 7.5.   Notice of Defaults.........................................46
SECTION 7.6.   Reports by Trustee to Holders..............................46
SECTION 7.7.   Compensation and Indemnity.................................47
SECTION 7.8.   Replacement of Trustee.....................................48
SECTION 7.9.   Successor Trustee by Merger, etc...........................49
SECTION 7.10.  Eligibility; Disqualification..............................49
SECTION 7.11.  Preferential Collection of Claims Against Company..........49

                                    ARTICLE 8

                       DEFEASANCE AND COVENANT DEFEASANCE

SECTION 8.1.   Option to Effect Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance.........50
SECTION 8.2.   Defeasance and Discharge...................................50
SECTION 8.3.   Covenant Defeasance........................................51
SECTION 8.4.   Conditions to Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance............51
SECTION 8.5.   Deposited Money and U.S. Government Obligations to Be
               Held in Trust; Other Miscellaneous Provisions..............53

                                    ARTICLE 9

                           SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE

SECTION 9.1.   Satisfaction and Discharge of Indenture....................54
SECTION 9.2.   Application of Trust Funds.................................55

                                   ARTICLE 10

                             SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURES

SECTION 10.1.  Supplemental Indentures Without Consent of Holders.........56
SECTION 10.2.  Supplemental Indentures with Consent of Holders............56
SECTION 10.3.  Compliance with Trust Indenture Act........................58
SECTION 10.4.  Revocation and Effect of Consents..........................58
SECTION 10.5.  Notation on or Exchange of Securities......................58
SECTION 10.6.  Effect of Supplemental Indentures..........................59

                                   ARTICLE 11

                                  MISCELLANEOUS

SECTION 11.1.  Trust Indenture Act Controls...............................59
SECTION 11.2.  Notices....................................................59
SECTION 11.3.  Communications by Holders with Other Holders...............60
SECTION 11.4.  Certificate and Opinion as to Conditions Precedent.........60
SECTION 11.5.  Statements Required in Certificate and Opinion.............61
SECTION 11.6.  Rules by Trustee and Agents................................61
SECTION 11.7.  Record Date................................................61
SECTION 11.8.  Business Days..............................................62
SECTION 11.9.  Governing Law..............................................62
SECTION 11.10. No Adverse Interpretation of Other Agreements..............62
SECTION 11.11. No Recourse Against Others.................................62
SECTION 11.12. Successors.................................................62
SECTION 11.13. Multiple Counterparts......................................63
SECTION 11.14. Table of Contents, Headings, etc...........................63
SECTION 11.15. Severability...............................................63

Signatures............................................................... 73

<PAGE>

          INDENTURE dated as of February 24, 1998 between Interpool, Inc., a
Delaware corporation (the "Company"), and United States Trust Company of New
York, a New York banking corporation (the "Trustee").

          The Company and the Trustee agree as follows for the benefit of each
other and for the equal and ratable benefit of all Holders of the Securities:


                                    ARTICLE 1

                   DEFINITIONS AND INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE

SECTION 1.1  DEFINITIONS

          "Affiliate" means any Person directly or indirectly controlling or
controlled by or under direct or indirect common control with the Company. For
the purposes of this definition, "control" (including, with correlative
meanings, the terms "controlled by" and "under common control with"), as used
with respect to any Person, shall mean the possession, directly or indirectly,
of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management or policies of
such Person, whether through the ownership of voting securities or by agreement
or otherwise.

          "Agent" means any Registrar, Paying Agent or agent for service of
notices and demands.

          "Bankruptcy Law" means Title 11 of the U.S. Code or any similar
Federal or State law for the relief of debtors.

          "Board of Directors of the Company" means the Board of Directors of
the Company or any committee of the Board.

          "Board Resolution" means a resolution certified by the Secretary or an
Assistant Secretary of the Company to have been duly adopted by the Board of
Directors of the Company and to be in full force and effect on the date of such
certification, and delivered to the Trustee.

          "Business Day" means each day, other than a Saturday or Sunday, which
is not a day on which banking institutions in the City of New York are
authorized or obligated by law or executive order to close.

          "Capitalized Leases" of any Person means, at the time any
determination thereof is to be made, capital leases for property leased by such
Person that would at such time be required to be capitalized on the balance
sheet of such Person in accordance with generally accepted accounting
principles.

          "Capital Stock" means any and all shares or other equivalents (however
designated) of capital stock, including all common stock and all preferred
stock.

          "Company" means the party named as such in this Indenture until a
successor replaces it pursuant to the Indenture and thereafter means the
successor.

          "Company Order" means a written order of the Company signed by two
Officers of the Company.

          "Consolidated Indebtedness-to-Stockholders' Equity Ratio" means at any
date of determination (the "Determination Date"), the ratio of (i) the aggregate
Debt of the Company and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis as at the
Determination Date to (ii) the sum of (w) the stockholder's equity of the
Company and its Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis calculated in accordance
with generally accepted accounting principles as at the Determination Date, (x)
the amount set forth on the consolidated balance sheet of the Company and its
Subsidiaries under the caption "Company-obligated mandatorily redeemable
preferred securities in subsidiary grantor trusts" or a similar caption, (y) to
the extent not included in clause (w), the aggregate amount of preferred stock
of the Company (as reflected on the consolidated balance sheet of the Company
calculated in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles) which is
not subject to mandatory redemption prior to the maturity date of the
Securities, and (z) the Subordinated Indebtedness of the Company as to which no
principal payments are due until after the maturity date of the Securities (to
the extent such Subordinated Indebtedness was included in the calculation of
Debt in clause (i) above).

          "Corporate Trust Office" means the office of the Trustee at which at
any particular time its corporate trust business shall be principally
administered, which office at the date of execution of this Indenture is located
at 114 West 47th Street, New York, New York 10036, Attn: Corporate Trust
Division.

          "Custodian" means any receiver, trustee, liquidator or similar
official under any Bankruptcy Law.

          "Debt" means (a) the principal of all indebtedness (i) for borrowed
money or (ii) for the deferred purchase price of property unless the price
thereof was payable in full within 12 months from the date on which the
obligation was created or (iii) evidenced by notes, bonds or other instruments
and (b) all Lease Obligations; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that, except for purposes of
the definition of Consolidated Indebtedness-to-Stockholders' Equity Ratio, Debt
shall not include Subordinated Indebtedness as to which no scheduled principal
payments are due until after the maturity date of the Securities.

          "Default" means any event which is, or after notice or passage of time
or both would be, an Event of Default.

          "Definitive Securities" means those securities issued in fully
registered certificated form not otherwise in global form.

          "Depositary" means, with respect to Securities the Company determines
will be issued as a Global Security, The Depository Trust Company, New York, New
York, another clearing agency, or any successor registered as a clearing agency
under the Exchange Act or other applicable statute or regulation, which, in each
case, shall be designated by the Company pursuant to Section 2.7(c).

          "Dollar" or "$" means the lawful money of the United States of
America.

          "Exchange Offer" means the offer that may be made pursuant to the
Registration Rights Agreement by the Company to exchange Exchange Securities for
Original Securities.

          "Exchange Securities" means the 6-5/8% Notes due 2003, as
authenticated and issued under this Indenture in exchange for an Original
Security or Original Securities pursuant to the offer to be made pursuant to the
Registration Rights Agreement to exchange Exchange Securities for Original
Securities.

          "Global Security" means, with respect to the Securities, a Security
executed by the Company and delivered by the Trustee to the Depositary or
pursuant to the Depositary's instruction, all in accordance with the Indenture,
which shall be registered in the name of the Depositary or its nominee.

          "Holder" or "Securityholder" means the Person in whose name a Security
is registered on the Registrar's books.

          "Indebtedness," as applied to any Person, means, without duplication
(i) all indebtedness for borrowed money whether or not evidenced by a promissory
note, draft or similar instrument, (ii) that portion of obligations with respect
to leases that is properly classified as a liability on a balance sheet in
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, (iii) notes payable
and drafts accepted representing extensions of credit, (iv) any balance owed for
all or any part of the deferred purchase price of property or services, which
purchase price is due more than six months from the date of incurrence of the
obligation in respect thereof (except any such balance that constitutes (a) a
trade payable or an accrued liability arising in the ordinary course of business
or (b) a trade draft or note payable issued in the ordinary course of business
in connection with the purchase of goods or services), if and to the extent such
debt would appear as a liability upon a balance sheet of such Person prepared in
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and (v) any deferral,
amendment, renewal, extension, supplement or refunding of any of the foregoing
indebtedness; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that, in computing the "Indebtedness" of any
Person, there shall be excluded any particular indebtedness if, upon or prior to
the maturity thereof and at the time of determination of such indebtedness,
there shall have been deposited with a depository in trust money (or evidences
of indebtedness if permitted by the instrument creating such indebtedness) in
the necessary amount to pay, redeem or satisfy such indebtedness as it becomes
due, and the amount so deposited shall not be included in any computation of the
assets of such Person.

          "Indenture" means this Indenture as originally executed or, if amended
or supplemented as provided in Article 10, as amended or supplemented from time
to time.

          "Interest Payment Date" shall have the meaning set forth in Section
2.8.

          "Issue Date" means February 24, 1998.

          "Lease Obligation" of a Person means all rental obligations under
leases of property (other than electronic data processing and computer equipment
and leases of office space by such Person or its Subsidiaries) either (a) which
are Capitalized Leases, or (b) if not Capitalized Leases, which are leases of
equipment which had an initial term of more than three years (including any
renewal term at the option of the lessor). The amount of Lease Obligations shall
be equal to the aggregate value of rentals payable (other than rentals
consisting of taxes, indemnities, maintenance items, replacements and other
similar charges which are in addition to the basic financial rent for the use of
the property) by the lessee thereof during the remaining term thereof, including
periods of renewal at the option of the lessor, discounted to present value
using the lessee's "incremental borrowing rate at the inception of the lease" in
accordance with Financial Accounting Standards No. 13 of the Financial Standards
Board from time to time in effect.

          "Make-Whole Amount" means, in connection with any optional redemption
of any Security, the excess, if any, of (i) the aggregate present value as of
the date of such redemption of each dollar of principal being redeemed and the
amount of interest (exclusive of any interest accrued to the date of redemption)
that would have been payable in respect of such dollar if such redemption has
not been made, determined by discounting, on a semi-annual basis, such principal
and interest at the Reinvestment Rate (which rate shall be determined as of the
third Business Day preceding the date such notice of redemption is given) from
the respective dates on which such principal and interest would have been
payable if such redemption had not been made, over (ii) the aggregate principal
amount of the Securities being redeemed.

          "Officer" means the Chairman of the Board, the President, any Vice
President, the Treasurer or Assistant Treasurer, the Secretary or Assistant
Secretary or the Controller or Assistant Controller of the Company.

          "Officers' Certificate" means a certificate signed by two Officers of
the Company and otherwise complying with the requirements of Sections 11.4 and
11.5, and delivered to the Trustee or an Agent, as applicable.

          "Opinion of Counsel" means a written opinion from Stroock & Stroock &
Lavan LLP or any other legal counsel who is reasonably acceptable to the Trustee
(which may include an employee of or counsel to the Company or the Trustee),
complying with the requirements of Sections 11.4 and 11.5, and delivered to the
Trustee or an Agent, as applicable.

          "Original Securities" means the 6-5/8% Notes due 2003, as
authenticated and issued under this Indenture on the Issue Date.

          "Person" means any individual, corporation, partnership, joint
venture, association, joint-stock company, trust, limited liability company,
unincorporated organization or government or any agency or political subdivision
thereof.

          "Predecessor Security" of any particular Security means every previous
Security evidencing all or a portion of the same debt as that evidenced by such
particular Security; and, for the purposes of this definition, any Security
authenticated and delivered under Section 2.10 in lieu of a lost, destroyed or
stolen Security shall be deemed to evidence the same debt as the lost, destroyed
or stolen Security.

          "Principal" of a Security means the principal of the Security plus,
when appropriate, the premium, if any, on the Security.

          "Purchase Money Indebtedness" of a Person means all Debt (excluding
all Lease Obligations) of such Person which is Secured Indebtedness incurred to
finance the purchase of assets if such Debt (a) shall have been incurred within
180 days of the acquisition of such assets by the Person whose Purchase Money
Indebtedness is being determined and (b) does not exceed in principal amount the
initial cost of such assets and shall include all extensions, renewals and
refinancings of such Debt not in excess of the principal amount thereof
outstanding immediately prior to such extension, renewal or refinancing. The
initial cost of assets may include, in addition to the purchase price thereof
and the purchase price of all accessories and equipment installed thereon, all
freight, delivery and handling charges, excise, sales and use taxes and all
other amounts which may be capitalized and included in the cost of the assets
under generally accepted accounting principles.

          "Redemption Date" when used with respect to any Security to be
redeemed, means the date fixed for such redemption pursuant to this Indenture.

          "Redemption Price", when used with respect to any Security to be
redeemed, means the price fixed for such redemption pursuant to this Indenture
as specified in such Security.

          "Registration Rights Agreement" means the Registration Rights
Agreement, dated as of the Issue Date, by and among the Company and the Initial
Purchaser named therein as such agreement may be amended, modified or
supplemented from time to time.

          "Reinvestment Rate" means 0.25% plus the arithmetic mean of the yields
under the respective headings "This Week" and "Last Week" published in the most
recent Statistical Release under the caption "Treasury Constant Maturities:" for
the maturity (rounded to the nearest month) corresponding to the remaining life
to maturity, as of the payment date of the principal being redeemed or paid. If
no maturity exactly corresponds to such maturity, yields for the two published
maturities most closely corresponding to such maturity shall be calculated
pursuant to the immediately preceding sentence and the Reinvestment Rate shall
be interpolated or extrapolated from such yields on a straight-line basis,
rounding in each of such relevant periods to the nearest month. For the purposes
of calculating the Reinvestment Rate, the most recent Statistical Release
published prior to the date of determination of the Make-Whole Amount shall be
used.

          "Restricted Security" means any Security that is subject to the
transfer restrictions set forth in Section 2.9(a).

          "Sale and Leaseback", with respect to a Person, means any transaction
with a bank, company, lender or investor providing for the leasing by such
Person of any property which has been or is to be sold or transferred by such
Person to such bank, company, lender or investor, or of any Person to whom funds
have been or are to be advanced by such bank, company, lender or investor on the
security of such property.

          "Secured Indebtedness" means with respect to a Person all Debt which
is secured by any security interest, mortgage, charge, pledge, deed of trust, or
other similar lien on assets by the owner thereof and includes all Lease
Obligations. Transportation Equipment which is subject to a lease or contract
which is included as a Lease Obligation is deemed to secure the Debt evidenced
thereby.

          "Securities" means, collectively, the Original Securities and the
Exchange Securities.

          "Security Register" means the list of holders provided to the Trustee
pursuant to Section 2.15 or any security register maintained by the Registrar.

          "Significant Subsidiary" means any Subsidiary of the Company that
would be a "significant subsidiary" as defined in Rule 1-02 of Regulation S-X
under the Securities Act, as such Rule is in effect on the date of this
Indenture.

          "Statistical Release" means the statistical release designated
"H.15(519)" or any successor publication which is published weekly by the
Federal Reserve System and which established yields on actively traded United
States government securities adjusted to constant maturities, or, if such
statistical release is not published at the time of any determination under the
Indenture, then such other reasonably comparable index which shall be designated
by the Company.

          "Subordinated Indebtedness" means Debt of the Company which is
expressly subordinated and subject in right of payment to the prior payment, in
bankruptcy or in the event of a payment default on the Securities, in full in
money or money's worth in accordance with their terms, of all principal of,
premium, if any, and interest on the Securities.

          "Subsidiary" of a Person means (i) any corporation more than 50% of
the outstanding voting power of the Voting Stock of which is owned or
controlled, directly or indirectly, by such Person or by one or more other
Subsidiaries of such Person, or by such Person and one or more other
Subsidiaries thereof, or (ii) any limited partnership of which such Person or
any Subsidiary of such Person is a general partner, or (iii) any other Person
(other than a corporation or limited partnership) in which such Person, or one
or more other Subsidiaries of such Person, or such Person and one or more other
Subsidiaries thereof, directly or indirectly, has more than 60% of the
outstanding partnership or similar interests or has the power, by contract or
otherwise, to direct or cause the direction of the policies, management and
affairs thereof.

          "Transportation Equipment" means domestic and marine containers,
trucks, tractors, trailers, chassis, cranes, portable ramps, lifting equipment,
railroad locomotives, railroad rolling stock, modular office units, mobile
office and storage trailers and all other transportation equipment, and includes
all accessories and attachments thereto.

          "Trust Officer", when used with respect to the Trustee, means the
chairman or any vice-chairman of the board of directors, the chairman or any
vice-chairman of the executive committee of the board of directors, the chairman
of the trust committee, the president, any vice-president, the secretary, any
assistant secretary, the treasurer, any assistant treasurer, the cashier, any
assistant cashier, any trust officer or assistant trust officer, the controller
or any assistant controller or any other officer of the Trustee customarily
performing functions similar to those performed by any of the above designated
officers and also means, with respect to a particular corporate trust matter,
any other officer of the Trustee to whom such matter is referred because of his
knowledge of and familiarity with the particular subject.

          "United States" means the United States of America.

          "U.S. Government Obligations" means securities which are (a) direct
obligations of the United States, for the payment of which its full faith and
credit is pledged, or (b) obligations of a Person controlled or supervised by
and acting as an agency or instrumentality of the United States, the payment of
which is unconditionally guaranteed as a full faith and credit obligation by the
United States, which, in either case, are not callable or redeemable at the
option of the issuer thereof, and shall also include a depository receipt issued
by a bank or trust as custodian with respect to any such U.S. Government
Obligation or a specific payment of interest on or principal of any such U.S.
Government Obligation held by such custodian for the account of the holder of a
depository receipt, PROVIDED that (except as required by law) such custodian is
not authorized to make any deduction from the amount payable to the holder of
such depository receipt from any amount received by the custodian in respect of
the U.S. Government Obligation or the specific payment of interest on or
principal of the U.S. Government Obligation evidenced by such depository
receipt.

          "Voting Stock" of a Person means Capital Stock of such Person of the
class or classes pursuant to which the holders thereof have the general voting
power under ordinary circumstances to elect at least a majority of the board of
directors, managers or trustees of such Person (irrespective of whether or not
at the time the stock of any other class or classes shall have or might have
voting power by reason of the happening of any contingency).

SECTION 1.2  OTHER DEFINITIONS

         TERM                                          DEFINED IN SECTION
         ----                                          ------------------
         "Covenant Defeasance"                               8.3
         "Defeasance"                                        8.2
         "Event of Default"                                  6.1
         "Initial Lien"                                      4.12
         "Lien"                                              4.12
         "Paying Agent"                                      2.4
         "Refinancing"                                       4.12
         "Registrar"                                         2.4
         "Required Filing Dates"                             4.2

SECTION 1.3  INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE TO TRUST INDENTURE ACT.
             -------------------------------------------------

          Whenever this Indenture refers to a provision of the Trust Indenture
Act of 1939 (the "TIA"), the provision is incorporated by reference in and made
a part of this Indenture. The following TIA terms used in this Indenture have
the following meanings:

          "Commission" means the Securities and Exchange Commission.

          "indenture securities" means the Securities.

          "indenture security holder" means a Securityholder.

          "indenture to be qualified" means this Indenture.

          "indenture trustee" or "institutional trustee" means the Trustee.

          "obligor" on the indenture securities means the Company or any other
          obligor on the indenture securities.

          All other terms used in this Indenture that are defined by the TIA,
defined by TIA reference to another statute or defined by Commission rules have
the meanings assigned to them therein.

SECTION 1.4  RULES OF CONSTRUCTION.

          Unless the context otherwise requires:

          (1) a term has the meaning assigned to it;

          (2) an accounting term not otherwise defined has the meaning assigned
to it in accordance with United States generally accepted accounting principles
in effect as of the time as to which such accounting principles are to be
applied;

          (3) "or" is not exclusive;

          (4) words in the singular include the plural, and in the plural
include the singular; and

          (5) references to Sections or Articles means reference to such Section
or Article in this Indenture, unless stated otherwise; and

          (6) "including" or "included" means included but not limited to.


                                    ARTICLE 2

                                 THE SECURITIES

SECTION 2.1  FORM GENERALLY

          The Original Securities and related Trustee's certificate of
authentication shall be substantially in the form of Exhibit A and the Exchange
Securities and related Trustee's certificate of authentication shall be
substantially in the form of Exhibit B, the terms of each of which are
incorporated in and made a part of this Indenture. The Securities may have
notations, legends or endorsements required by law, stock exchange rule,
agreements to which the Company is subject or usage. Each Security shall be
dated the date of its authentication. The Securities shall be issued in
denominations of $1,000 and integral multiples thereof. Notwithstanding the
foregoing, Definitive Securities issued to any "institutional accredited
investor" within the meaning of Rule 502 (A) (1), (2), (3) or (7) under the
Securities Act shall be issued only in minimum denominations of $100,000 and any
amount in excess thereof that is an integral multiple of $1,000.

SECTION 2.2  EXECUTION AND AUTHENTICATION.

          Two Officers shall sign the Securities for the Company by manual or
facsimile signature in the manner set forth in Exhibits A and B. The Company's
seal shall be impressed, affixed, imprinted or reproduced on the Securities and
may be in facsimile form.

          If an Officer whose signature is on a Security no longer holds that
office at the time the Trustee authenticates the Security, the Security shall
nevertheless be valid.

          A Security shall not be valid until authenticated by the manual
signature of an authorized officer of the Trustee. The signature of the Trustee
shall be conclusive evidence that the Security has been authenticated under this
Indenture. The form of Trustee's certificate of authentication to be borne by
the Securities shall be substantially as set forth in Exhibits A and B hereto.

          The Trustee shall, upon a Company Order, authenticate for original
issue up to, and the aggregate principal amount of Securities outstanding at any
time may not exceed the sum of, $100,000,000 principal amount of the Securities,
except as provided in Sections 2.9, 2.10 and 2.12. The series of Securities to
be initially issued hereunder shall be the Original Securities.

          The Trustee may appoint an authenticating agent to authenticate
Securities. An authenticating agent may authenticate Securities whenever the
Trustee may do so. Each reference in this Indenture to authentication by the
Trustee includes authentication by such agent. An authenticating agent has the
same rights as an Agent to deal with the Company or an Affiliate.

SECTION 2.3  FORM AND PAYMENT

          Except as provided in Section 2.7, the Securities shall be issued in
fully registered certificated form without interest coupons. Principal of and
interest on the Securities issued in certificated form will be payable, the
transfer of such Securities will be registrable and such Securities will be
exchangeable for Securities bearing identical terms and provisions at the office
or agency of the Company maintained for such purpose under Section 2.4;
PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that payment of interest with respect to the Securities may
be made at the option of the Company (i) by check mailed to the holder at such
address as shall appear in the Security Register or (ii) by transfer to an
account maintained by the Person entitled thereto, provided that proper transfer
instructions have been received in writing by the relevant record date.

SECTION 2.4  REGISTRAR AND AGENTS

          The Company shall maintain an office or agency where Securities may be
presented for registration of transfer or for exchange ("Registrar"), an office
or agency where Securities may be presented for payment ("Paying Agent") and an
office or agency where notices and demands to or upon the Company in respect of
the Securities and this Indenture may be served. The Registrar shall keep a
register of the Securities and of their transfer and exchange. The Company may
have one or more co-registrars and one or more additional Paying Agents. The
Company or any Subsidiary thereof may act as Paying Agent. The term "Registrar"
includes any co-Registrar and the term "Paying Agent" includes any additional
paying agent.

          Any Paying Agent or Registrar may resign as Paying Agent or Registrar
upon thirty (30) days' prior written notice to the Company and the Trustee. The
Company may change any Paying Agent or Registrar on sixty (60) days' prior
written notice to the Trustee. The Company shall notify the Trustee in writing
of the name and address of any such Agent. If the Company fails to maintain a
Registrar, Paying Agent, or agent for service of notices and demands, or fails
to give the foregoing notice, the Trustee shall act as such.

          The Company initially appoints the Trustee as Registrar, Paying Agent
and agent for service of notices and demands.

SECTION 2.5  PAYING AGENT TO HOLD MONEY IN TRUST

          Prior to each due date of the principal of, premium if any, and
interest on the Securities, the Company shall deposit with each Paying Agent a
sum sufficient to pay such principal, premium, if any, and interest so becoming
due. The Company shall require each Paying Agent other than the Trustee to agree
in writing that it will hold in trust for the benefit of Holder of Securities or
the Trustee all money held by the Paying Agent for the payment of principal of,
premium if any, or interest on the Securities and to notify the Trustee
immediately in writing of any default by the Company (or any other obligor on
the Securities) in making any such payment. If the Company or a Subsidiary
thereof acts as Paying Agent, it shall on or before each due date of the
principal of, premium, if any, or interest on any Securities segregate the money
and hold it as a separate trust fund. The Company at any time may require a
Paying Agent to pay all money held by it to the Trustee and the Trustee may at
any time during the continuance of any payment default, upon written request to
a Paying Agent, require such Paying Agent to forthwith pay to the Trustee all
sums so held in trust by such Paying Agent and account for any funds disbursed.
Upon doing so, the Paying Agent (other than the Company or a Subsidiary thereof)
shall have no further liability for the money.

          Any money deposited with the Trustee or any Paying Agent, or then held
by the Company, in trust for payment of the principal of, premium, if any, or
interest on any Security and remaining unclaimed for two years after such
principal, and premium, if any, or interest has become due and payable shall,
subject to the requirements of applicable law, be paid to the Company upon its
request; and the Holder of such Security shall thereafter look only to the
Company for payment thereof, and all liability of the Trustee or such Paying
Agent with respect to such trust money shall thereupon cease.

SECTION 2.6  LEGENDS.

          (a) Except as permitted by subsection (b) of this Section 2.6 or as
otherwise determined by the Company in accordance with applicable law, each
Security shall bear the applicable legends relating to restrictions on transfer
pursuant to the securities laws in substantially the form set forth in Section
2.9(g)(1).

          (b) The Company shall issue and the Trustee shall authenticate
Exchange Securities in exchange for Original Securities accepted for exchange in
the Exchange Offer, which Exchange Securities shall not bear the legends
required by subsection (a) above. Pursuant to the terms of the Exchange Offer as
set forth in the Registration Rights Agreement, certain Persons are not eligible
to tender their Original Securities in the Exchange Offer. Accordingly, a holder
of Original Securities who is either (A) a broker-dealer who purchased such
Original Securities directly from the Company for resale pursuant to Rule 144A
or any other available exemption under the Securities Act, (B) a Person
participating in the distribution of the Original Securities or (C) a Person who
is an affiliate (as defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act) of the Company
shall, pursuant to the terms of the Registration Rights Agreement, only receive
Exchange Securities other than in connection with the Exchange Offer, which
Exchange Securities, notwithstanding anything else herein to the contrary, shall
bear the legends required by subsection (a) above and shall not be represented
by a Global Security.

SECTION 2.7  GLOBAL SECURITY.

          (a) The Global Securities shall represent the aggregate amount of
outstanding Securities from time to time endorsed thereon; PROVIDED, that the
aggregate amount of outstanding Securities represented thereby may from time to
time be reduced or increased, as appropriate, to reflect exchanges and
redemptions. At such time as all beneficial interests in a Global Security have
either been exchanged for Definitive Securities, redeemed, repurchased or
cancelled, such Global Security shall be returned to or retained and cancelled
by the Trustee. Any endorsement of a Global Security to reflect the amount of
any increase or decrease in the amount of outstanding Securities represented
thereby shall be made by the Trustee, in accordance with instructions given by
the Company as required by this Section 2.7.

          (b) The Global Securities may be transferred, in whole but not in
part, only to the Depositary, another nominee of the Depositary, or to a
successor Depositary selected or approved by the Company or to a nominee of such
successor Depositary.

          (c) If at any time the Depositary notifies the Company that it is
unwilling or unable to continue as Depositary or the Depositary has ceased to be
a clearing agency registered under the Exchange Act, and a successor Depositary
is not appointed by the Company within 90 days after the Company receives such
notice or becomes aware of such condition, as the case may be, the Company will
execute, and the Trustee, upon receipt of a Company Order, will authenticate and
make available for delivery the Definitive Securities, in authorized
denominations, and in an aggregate principal amount equal to the principal
amount of the Global Security in exchange for such Global Security. If there is
an Event of Default, the Depositary shall have the right to exchange the Global
Securities for Definitive Securities. In addition, the Company may at any time
determine that the Securities shall no longer be represented by a Global
Security. In the event of such an Event of Default or such a determination, the
Company shall execute, and subject to Section 2.9, the Trustee, upon receipt of
an Officers' Certificate evidencing such determination by the Company, will
authenticate and make available for delivery the Definitive Securities, in
authorized denominations, and in an aggregate principal amount equal to the
principal amount of the Global Security, in exchange for such Global Security.
Upon the exchange of the Global Security for such Definitive Securities, in
authorized denominations, the Global Security shall be cancelled by the Trustee.
Such Definitive Securities issued in exchange for the Global Security shall be
registered in such names and in such authorized denominations as the Depositary,
pursuant to instructions from its direct or indirect participants or otherwise,
shall instruct the Trustee. The Trustee shall deliver such Definitive Securities
to the Depositary for delivery to the Persons in whose names such Definitive
Securities are so registered.

SECTION 2.8  INTEREST.

          (a) Each Security will bear interest at the rate of 6-5/8% per annum.
Each Security will bear interest from the most recent date to which interest has
been paid or duly provided for or, if no interest has been paid or duly provided
for, from the Issue Date, until the principal thereof becomes due and payable,
and at the rate provided in the first sentence of this Section 2.8 on any
overdue principal and (to the extent that payment of such interest is
enforceable under applicable law) on any overdue installment of interest,
compounded semi-annually, payable semi-annually in arrears on March 1 and
September 1 of each year (each, an "Interest Payment Date") commencing on
September 1, 1998 to the Person in whose name such Security or any Predecessor
Security is registered, at the close of business on the preceding February 15 or
August 15, respectively, regardless of whether such day is a Business Day.

          (b) Interest will be computed on the basis of a 360day year consisting
of twelve 30-day months and, for any period of less than a full calendar month,
the number of days lapsed in such month. In the event that any Interest Payment
Date falls on a day that is not a Business Day, then payment of interest payable
on such date will be made on the next succeeding day which is a Business Day
(and without any interest or other payment in respect of any such delay), with
the same force and effect as if made on such date.

          (c) The Company will not be responsible for, and will not be required
to compensate holders of or investors in the Securities for, any withholding
taxes that are imposed on interest payments on the Securities.

SECTION 2.9  TRANSFER AND EXCHANGE.

          (a) TRANSFER RESTRICTIONS. The Original Securities, and those Exchange
Securities with respect to which any Person described in Section 2.6(b)(A), (B)
or (C) is the beneficial owner, may not be transferred except in compliance with
the legend contained in Exhibit A unless otherwise determined by the Company in
accordance with applicable law.

          (b) GENERAL PROVISIONS RELATING TO TRANSFERS AND EXCHANGES. When a
Security is presented to the Registrar with a request to register the transfer,
the Registrar shall register the transfer as requested and when Securities are
presented to the Registrar with a request to exchange them for a like aggregate
principal amount of Securities in other authorized denominations, the Registrar
shall make the exchange as requested, provided that every Security presented or
surrendered for registration or transfer or exchange shall be duly endorsed, or
be accompanied by a written instrument of transfer into a form satisfactory to
the Company and the Registrar duly executed by the Holder thereof or his
attorney-in-fact duly authorized in writing. To permit registrations of
transfers and exchanges, the Company shall issue and the Trustee or any
authenticating agent shall authenticate Securities at the Registrar's written
request. No service charge shall be made for any registration of transfer or
exchange of Securities but the Company may require payment of a sum sufficient
to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in relation
thereto, but this provision shall not apply to any exchange pursuant to Section
2.12, 3.6 or 10.5 not involving any transfer.

          All Definitive Securities and Global Securities issued upon any
registration of transfer or exchange of Definitive Securities or Global
Securities shall be the valid obligations of the Company, evidencing the same
debt, and entitled to the same benefits under this Indenture, as the Definitive
Securities or Global Securities surrendered upon such registration of transfer
or exchange.

          Prior to due presentment for registration or transfer of any Security,
the Trustee and the Company may deem and treat the Person in whose name the
Security is registered as the absolute owner of such Security, and neither the
Trustee nor the Company shall be affected by notice to the contrary.

          The Registrar shall not be required (i) to issue, register the
transfer of, or exchange Securities during a period beginning at the opening of
business 15 days before the day of any selection of Securities for redemption
under Section 3.2 and ending at the close of business on the day of selection,
(ii) to register the transfer or exchange of any Security so selected for
redemption in whole or in part, except the unredeemed portion of any Security
being redeemed in part, or (iii) to issue, register the transfer of, or exchange
Securities during the period between a record date and the next succeeding
Interest Payment Date.

          (c) TRANSFER AND EXCHANGE OF DEFINITIVE SECURITIES. When Definitive
Securities are presented to the Registrar with a request:

               (y) to register the transfer of such Definitive Securities; or

               (z) to exchange such Definitive Securities for an equal principal
amount of Definitive Securities of other authorized denominations,

the Registrar shall register the transfer or make the exchange as requested if
its reasonable requirements for such transaction are met; PROVIDED, HOWEVER,
that the Definitive Securities surrendered for registration of transfer or
exchange:

               (1) shall be duly endorsed or accompanied by a written instrument
of transfer in form reasonably satisfactory to the Company and the Registrar
duly executed by the Securityholder or such Holder's attorney duly authorized in
writing; and

               (2) in the case of Definitive Securities that are Restricted
Securities, such request shall be accompanied by the following additional
information and documents, as applicable:

                    (A) if such Restricted Securities are being delivered to the
          Registrar by a Securityholder for registration in the name of such
          Securityholder, without transfer, a certification from such
          Securityholder to that effect (in substantially the form set forth on
          the reverse of the Security); or

                    (B) if such Restricted Security is being transferred to a
          "qualified institutional buyer" (as defined in Rule 144A) in
          accordance with Rule 144A a certification to that effect (in
          substantially the form set forth on the reverse of the Security); or

                    (C) if such Restricted Security is being transferred (i)
          pursuant to an exemption from registration in accordance with Rule 144
          or Regulation S under the Securities Act or (ii) pursuant to an
          effective registration statement under the Securities Act, or (iii) in
          a minimum principal amount of $100,000 to an "institutional accredited
          investor" within the meaning of Rule 501(A)(1), (2), (3) or (7) under
          the Securities Act that is acquiring the security for its own account,
          or for the account of such an institutional accredited investor, not
          with a view to or for offer or sale in connection with any
          distribution in violation of the Securities Act, or (iv) in reliance
          on another exemption from the registration requirements of the
          Securities Act, a certification to that effect (in substantially the
          form set forth on the reverse of the Security) and in the case of (i),
          (iii) and (iv) above, if the Company or the Registrar so request, a
          customary opinion of counsel reasonably acceptable to the Company and
          to the Registrar to the effect that such transfer is in compliance
          with the Securities Act.

          (d) RESTRICTIONS ON TRANSFER OF A DEFINITIVE SECURITY FOR A BENEFICIAL
INTEREST IN A GLOBAL SECURITY.

          A Definitive Security may not be exchanged for a beneficial interest
in a Global Security except upon satisfaction of the requirements set forth
below. Upon receipt by the Registrar of a Definitive Security, duly endorsed or
accompanied by appropriate instruments of transfer, in form satisfactory to the
Registrar, together with:

               (1) if such Definitive Security is a Restricted Security,
certification, substantially in the form set forth on the reverse of the
Security, that such Definitive Security is being transferred to a "qualified
institutional buyer" (as defined in Rule 144A) in accordance with Rule 144A; and

               (2) whether or not such Definitive Security is a Restricted
Security, written instructions of the Securityholder directing the Registrar to
make, or to direct the Trustee to make, an endorsement on the Global Security to
reflect an increase in the aggregate principal amount of the Securities
represented by the Global Security,

then the Registrar shall cancel such Definitive Security and cause, or direct
the Trustee to cause, in accordance with the standing instructions and
procedures existing between the Depositary and the Trustee, the aggregate
principal amount of Securities represented by the Global Security to be
increased accordingly. If no Global Securities are then outstanding, the Company
shall issue and the Trustee shall authenticate a new Global Security in the
appropriate principal amount.

          (e) TRANSFER AND EXCHANGE OF GLOBAL SECURITIES.

          The transfer and exchange of Global Securities or beneficial interests
therein shall be effected through the Depositary, in accordance with this
Indenture (including applicable restrictions on transfer set forth herein, if
any) and the procedures of the Depositary therefor which shall include
restrictions on transfer comparable to those set forth herein to the extent
required by the Securities Act.

          (f) TRANSFER OF A BENEFICIAL INTEREST IN A GLOBAL SECURITY FOR A
DEFINITIVE SECURITY.

               (1) Any Person having a beneficial interest in a Global Security
may upon request exchange such beneficial interest for a Definitive Security.
Upon receipt by the Registrar of written instructions or such other form of
instructions as is customary for the Depositary from the Depositary or its
nominee on behalf of any Person having a beneficial interest in a Global
Security and upon receipt by the Registrar of a written order or such other form
of instructions as is customary for the Depositary or the Person designated by
the Depositary as having such a beneficial interest in a Restricted Security
only, the following additional information and documents (all of which may be
submitted by facsimile):

                    (A) if such beneficial interest is being transferred to the
          Person designated by the Depositary as being the beneficial owner, a
          certification from such person to that effect (in substantially the
          form set forth on the reverse of the Security); or

                    (B) if such beneficial interest is being transferred to a
          "qualified institutional buyer" (as defined in Rule 144A) in
          accordance with Rule 144A a certification to that effect from the
          transferor (in substantially the form set forth on the reverse of the
          Security); or

                    (C) if such beneficial interest is being transferred (i)
          pursuant to an exemption from registration in accordance with Rule 144
          or Regulation S under the Securities Act or (ii) pursuant to an
          effective registration statement under the Securities Act, or (iii) in
          a minimum principal amount of $100,000 to an "institutional accredited
          investor" within the meaning of Rule 501(A)(1), (2), (3) or (7) under
          the Securities Act that is acquiring the security for its own account,
          or for the account of such an institutional accredited investor, not
          with any distribution in violation of the Securities Act, or (iv) in
          reliance on another exemption from the registration requirements of
          the Securities Act, a certification to that effect from the transferee
          or transferor (in substantially the form set forth on the reverse of
          the Security) and in the case of (i), (iii) and (iv) above, if the
          Company or the Registrar so requests, a customary opinion of counsel
          from the transferee or transferor reasonably acceptable to the Company
          and to the Registrar to the effect that such transfer is in compliance
          with the Securities Act;

then the Registrar, or the Trustee, will cause, in accordance with the standing
instructions and procedures existing between the Depositary and the Trustee, the
aggregate principal amount of the Global Security to be reduced and, following
such reduction, the Company will execute and, upon receipt of an authentication
order in the form of an Officers' Certificate, the Trustee or the Trustee's
authenticating agent will authenticate and deliver to the transferee a
Definitive Security.

               (2) Definitive Securities issued in exchange for a beneficial
interest in a Global Security pursuant to this Section 2.9(f) shall be
registered in such names and in such authorized denominations as the Depositary,
pursuant to instructions from its direct or indirect participants or otherwise,
shall instruct the Registrar. The Registrar shall deliver such Definitive
Securities to the persons in whose names such Securities are so registered.

          (g)  LEGENDS.

               (1) Except as permitted by the following paragraph (2), each
Security certificate evidencing the Global Securities and the Definitive
Securities (and all securities issued in exchange therefor or substitution
thereof, but not including Exchange Securities as defined herein) shall bear
legends in substantially the following form:

          THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED HEREBY HAVE NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE
          SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE "SECURITIES ACT"), OR ANY
          STATE SECURITIES LAWS OR ANY OTHER APPLICABLE SECURITIES LAW. NEITHER
          THIS SECURITY NOR ANY INTEREST OR PARTICIPATION HEREIN MAY BE
          REOFFERED, SOLD, ASSIGNED, TRANSFERRED, PLEDGED, ENCUMBERED OR
          OTHERWISE DISPOSED OF IN THE ABSENCE OF SUCH REGISTRATION OR UNLESS
          SUCH TRANSACTION IS EXEMPT FROM, OR NOT SUBJECT TO, REGISTRATION.

          THE HOLDER OF THIS SECURITY BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF AGREES TO OFFER,
          SELL OR OTHERWISE TRANSFER THIS SECURITY, PRIOR TO THE DATE (THE
          "RESALE RESTRICTION TERMINATION DATE") WHICH IS TWO YEARS AFTER THE
          LATER OF THE ORIGINAL ISSUANCE DATE HEREOF AND THE LAST DATE ON WHICH
          THE COMPANY OR ANY "AFFILIATE" OF THE COMPANY WAS THE OWNER OF THIS
          SECURITY (OR ANY PREDECESSOR OF THIS SECURITY) ONLY (A) TO THE
          COMPANY, (B) PURSUANT TO A REGISTRATION STATEMENT WHICH HAS BEEN
          DECLARED EFFECTIVE UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, (C) SO LONG AS THIS
          SECURITY IS ELIGIBLE FOR RESALE PURSUANT TO RULE 144A UNDER THE
          SECURITIES ACT ("RULE 144A"), TO A PERSON IT REASONABLY BELIEVES IS A
          "QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER" (AS DEFINED IN RULE 144A) THAT
          PURCHASES FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF A QUALIFIED
          INSTITUTIONAL BUYER TO WHOM NOTICE IS GIVEN THAT THE TRANSFER IS BEING
          MADE IN RELIANCE ON RULE 144A, (D) PURSUANT TO OFFERS AND SALES TO
          NON-U.S. PERSONS THAT OCCUR OUTSIDE THE UNITED STATES WITHIN THE
          MEANING OF REGULATION S UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, (E) IN A MINIMUM
          PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF $100,000 TO AN INSTITUTIONAL "ACCREDITED INVESTOR"
          WITHIN THE MEANING OF SUBPARAGRAPH (A)(1), (2), (3) OR (7) OF RULE 501
          UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT THAT IS ACQUIRING THIS SECURITY FOR ITS OWN
          ACCOUNT, OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF SUCH AN INSTITUTIONAL ACCREDITED
          INVESTOR, FOR INVESTMENT PURPOSES AND NOT WITH A VIEW TO, OR FOR OFFER
          OR SALE IN CONNECTION WITH, ANY DISTRIBUTION IN VIOLATION OF THE
          SECURITIES ACT, OR (F) PURSUANT TO ANY OTHER AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM
          THE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, SUBJECT TO THE
          RIGHT OF THE COMPANY PRIOR TO ANY SUCH OFFER, SALE OR TRANSFER (i)
          PURSUANT TO CLAUSE (D), (E) OR (F) TO REQUIRE THE DELIVERY OF AN
          OPINION OF COUNSEL, CERTIFICATIONS AND/OR OTHER INFORMATION
          SATISFACTORY TO THE COMPANY, AND (ii) PURSUANT TO CLAUSE (E), TO
          REQUIRE THAT THE TRANSFEROR DELIVER TO THE COMPANY A LETTER FROM THE
          TRANSFEREE SUBSTANTIALLY IN THE FORM OF ANNEX A TO THE OFFERING
          MEMORANDUM DATED FEBRUARY 19, 1998. SUCH HOLDER FURTHER AGREES THAT IT
          WILL DELIVER TO EACH PERSON TO WHOM THIS SECURITY IS TRANSFERRED A
          NOTICE SUBSTANTIALLY TO THE EFFECT OF THIS LEGEND.

               (2) Upon any sale or transfer of a Restricted Security (including
any Restricted Security represented by a Global Security) pursuant to Rule 144
under the Securities Act or an effective registration statement under the
Securities Act:

                    (A) in the case of any Restricted Security that is a
          Definitive Security, the Registrar shall permit the Securityholder to
          exchange such Restricted Security for a Definitive Security that does
          not bear the legend set forth above and rescind any restriction on the
          transfer of such Restricted Security in the case of a sale or transfer
          pursuant to Rule 144 under the Securities Act, after the Resale
          Restriction Termination Date (as defined in clause (g)(1) above) or
          delivery of a customary opinion of counsel reasonably satisfactory to
          the Registrar; and

                    (B) any such Restricted Security represented by a Global
          Security shall not be subject to the provisions set forth in (1) above
          (such sales or transfers being subject only to the provisions of
          Section 2.9(e) hereof); PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that with respect to any
          request for an exchange of a Restricted Security that is represented
          by a Global Security for a Definitive Security that does not bear a
          legend, which request is made in reliance upon Rule 144 under the
          Securities Act, the Securityholder shall certify in writing to the
          Registrar (to be accompanied by a customary opinion of counsel
          reasonably satisfactory to the Registrar) that such request is being
          made pursuant to Rule 144 under the Securities Act (such certification
          to be substantially in the form set forth on the reverse of the
          Security).

          (h) EXCHANGE OF ORIGINAL SECURITIES FOR EXCHANGE SECURITIES.

          The Original Securities may be exchanged for Exchange Securities
pursuant to the terms of the Exchange Offer and in accordance with the
provisions set forth in this Section 2.9, as may be applicable. The Trustee
shall make the exchange as follows:

          The Company shall present the Trustee with an Officers' Certificate
certifying the following:

               (A) upon issuance of the Exchange Securities, the transactions
contemplated by the Exchange Offer have been consummated; and

               (B) the principal amount of Original Securities properly tendered
in the Exchange Offer that are represented by a Global Security and the
principal amount of Original Securities properly tendered in the Exchange Offer
that are represented by Definitive Securities, the name of each holder of such
Definitive Securities, the principal amount properly tendered in the Exchange
Offer by each such holder and the name and address to which Definitive
Securities representing Exchange Securities shall be registered and sent for
each such holder.

          The Trustee, upon receipt of (i) such Officers' Certificate, (ii) an
Opinion of Counsel (x) to the effect that the Exchange Securities have been
registered under Section 5 of the Securities Act and the Indenture has been
qualified under the Trust Indenture Act and (y) with respect to the matters set
forth in Section 3(p) of the Registration Rights Agreement and (iii) a Company
Order, shall authenticate (A) a Global Security representing Exchange Securities
in an aggregate principal amount equal to the aggregate principal amount of
Original Securities represented by a Global Security indicated in such Officers'
Certificate as having been properly tendered and (B) Definitive Securities
representing Exchange Securities registered in the names of, and in the
principal amounts indicated in, such Officers' Certificate.

          If the principal amount of the Global Security representing Exchange
Securities is less than the principal amount of the Global Security representing
Original Securities, the Trustee shall make an endorsement on such Global
Security representing Original Securities indicating a reduction in the
principal amount represented thereby.

          The Trustee shall deliver such Definitive Securities representing
Exchange Securities to the holders thereof as indicated in such Officers'
Certificate.

SECTION 2.10  REPLACEMENT SECURITIES.

          If a mutilated Security is surrendered to the Trustee or if the Holder
of a Security presents evidence to the satisfaction of the Company and the
Trustee that the Security has been lost, destroyed or wrongfully taken, the
Company shall issue and the Trustee shall authenticate a replacement Security if
the requirements of the Trustee and the Company are met. An indemnity bond may
be required by the Company or the Trustee that is sufficient in the judgment of
the Company to protect the Company and is sufficient in the judgment of the
Trustee to protect the Trustee or any Agent from any loss which it may suffer if
a Security is replaced. The Company and the Trustee may each charge for its
expenses in replacing a Security.

          Every replacement Security is an obligation of the Company and shall
be entitled to all of the benefits of this Indenture equally and proportionately
with all other Securities duly issued hereunder.

SECTION 2.11  OUTSTANDING SECURITIES.

          Securities outstanding at any time are all Securities authenticated by
the Trustee except for those cancelled by it, those delivered to it for
cancellation and those described in this Section 2.11 as not outstanding.

          If a Security is replaced pursuant to Section 2.10, it ceases to be
outstanding until the Trustee receives proof satisfactory to it that the
replaced Security is held by a bona fide purchaser.

          If the Paying Agent (other than the Company or any of its
Subsidiaries) holds on a Redemption Date or maturity date money deposited with
it by or on behalf of the Company sufficient to pay the principal of and accrued
interest on the Securities payable on that date, then on and after that date
such Securities cease to be outstanding and interest on them ceases to accrue.

          A Security does not cease to be outstanding because the Company or an
Affiliate holds the Security; PROVIDED, however, in determining whether the
holders of the requisite aggregate principal amount of Securities have concurred
in any direction, consent or waiver under this Indenture, Securities which are
owned by the Company or any other obligor on the Securities or by any person
directly or indirectly controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect
common control with the Company or any other obligor on the Securities shall be
disregarded and deemed not to be outstanding for the purpose of any such
determination; PROVIDED, THAT for the purposes of determining whether the
Trustee shall be protected in relying on any such direction, consent or waiver,
only Securities which the Trustee actually knows are so owned shall be so
disregarded.

SECTION 2.12  TEMPORARY SECURITIES.

          Until Definitive Securities are ready for delivery, the Company may
prepare and the Trustee shall authenticate temporary Securities. Temporary
Securities shall be substantially in the form of Definitive Securities but may
have non-material variations that the Company considers appropriate for
temporary Securities. Without unreasonable delay, the Company shall prepare and
the Trustee shall authenticate Definitive Securities in exchange for temporary
Securities upon written order of the Company signed by two Officers. Until so
exchanged, temporary Securities represent the same rights as Definitive
Securities. Upon request of the Trustee, the Company shall provide a certificate
to the effect that the temporary Securities meet the requirement of the second
sentence of this Section 2.12.

SECTION 2.13  CANCELLATION.

          The Company at any time may deliver Securities to the Trustee for
cancellation. The Registrar and the Paying Agent shall forward to the Trustee
any Securities surrendered to them for transfer, exchange or payment. The
Trustee shall cancel all Securities surrendered for transfer, exchange or
payment and destroy cancelled Securities in accordance with its customary
destruction procedures and deliver a certificate of such destruction to the
Company unless the company directs the Trustee in writing prior to such
destruction to deliver cancelled Securities to the Company. Subject to Sections
2.10 and 3.6, the company may not issue Securities to replace Securities that it
has previously paid or delivered to the Trustee for cancellation.

SECTION 2.14  DEFAULTED INTEREST.

          If the Company defaults in a payment of interest on Securities, it
shall pay the defaulted interest to the Persons who are Holders of the
Securities on a subsequent special record date. After the deposit by the Company
with the Trustee of money sufficient to pay such defaulted interest, the Trustee
shall fix the record date and payment date. Each such special record date shall
be not less than 10 days prior to such payment date. Each such payment date
shall be not more than 60 days after the deposit by the Company of money to pay
the defaulted interest. At least 15 days before the special record date, the
Company shall mail to each Holder of a Security a notice that states the special
record date, the payment date, and the amount of defaulted interest to be paid.
The Company may pay defaulted interest in any other lawful manner if, after
prior notice to the Trustee, such payment shall be deemed operationally
practicable by the Trustee.

SECTION 2.15  SECURITYHOLDER LISTS.

          The Trustee shall preserve in as current a form as is reasonably
practicable the most recent list available to it of the names and addresses of
Holders of Securities. If the Trustee is not the Registrar, the Company or other
obligor, if any, shall furnish to the Trustee at least seven Business Days prior
to each semiannual interest payment date and at such other times as the Trustee
may request in writing a list in such form and as of such date as the Trustee
may reasonably require of the names and addresses of Holders of Securities upon
which the Trustee may conclusively rely. The Trustee may destroy any such list
upon receipt of a replacement list. The Paying Agent will solicit from each
Securityholder a certification of social security number or taxpayer
identification number in accordance with its customary practice and as required
by law, unless the Paying Agent is in possession of such certification. Each
Paying Agent is authorized to impose back-up withholding with respect to
payments to be made to Securityholders to the extent required by law.

SECTION 2.16  PERSONS DEEMED OWNERS.

          Prior to presentment of a Security for registration of transfer, the
Company, the Trustee and any agent of the Company or the Trustee may treat the
Person in whose name such Security is registered as the owner of such Security
and neither the Company, the Trustee nor any agent of the Company or the Trustee
shall be affected by notice to the contrary.

SECTION 2.17  CUSIP NUMBER.

          The Company may use a "CUSIP" number when issuing Securities, and if
so, the Trustee may use the CUSIP number in notices of redemption or exchange as
a convenience to Holders of Securities; provided that any such notice may state
that no representation is made as to the correctness or accuracy of the CUSIP
number printed in the notice or on the Securities, and that reliance may be
placed only on the other identification numbers printed on the Securities.


                                    ARTICLE 3

                                   REDEMPTION

SECTION 3.1  RIGHT OF REDEMPTION.

          The Company may redeem the Securities, at any time, in whole or from
time to time in part, at the election of the Company, at a Redemption Price
equal to the sum of (i) the principal amount of the Securities being redeemed
plus accrued interest thereon to the Redemption Date and (ii) the Make-Whole
Amount, if any, with respect to such Securities. The election of the Company to
redeem any Securities pursuant to this Section shall be evidenced by a Board
Resolution. The Company shall, at least 45 but not more than 90 days prior to
the Redemption Date fixed by the Company (or such other period as the Company
and the Trustee may agree), notify the Trustee of such Redemption Date (such
notification to include the Company's calculation of the Make-Whole Amount,
which calculation the Trustee is authorized to rely on for purposes of the
Indenture) and, in the case of any redemption at the election of the Company of
less than all the Securities, of the principal amount of Securities to be
redeemed. The notice shall be in writing and accompanied by an Officers'
Certificate stating that the redemption complies with the provisions of this
Indenture and the provisions of the applicable Board Resolution, if any.

SECTION 3.2  SELECTION OF SECURITIES TO BE REDEEMED.

          If less than all of the Securities are to be redeemed, the Trustee
shall select the Securities to be redeemed pro rata or by lot or by any other
method that the Trustee considers fair and appropriate under the circumstances
or otherwise required by any exchange upon which the Securities are listed. The
Trustee shall promptly notify the Company of the Securities to be so called for
redemption. The Trustee shall make the selection from the Securities outstanding
and not previously called for redemption. The Trustee may select for redemption
portions of the principal of Securities that have denominations larger than
$1,000 principal amount. Securities and portions of Securities selected by the
Trustee shall be in principal amounts of $1,000 or multiples thereof. Provisions
of this Indenture that apply to Securities called for redemption also apply to
portions of Securities called for redemption. The Trustee's selection of
Securities for redemption by any method authorized by this Section 3.2 shall be
conclusively deemed reasonable.

SECTION 3.3  NOTICE OF REDEMPTION BY THE COMPANY.

          At least 30 days but not more than 60 days before a Redemption Date,
the Company shall mail a notice of redemption by first-class mail to each Holder
of Securities to be redeemed.

The notice shall identify the Securities to be redeemed and shall state:

          (1)  the Redemption Date;

          (2)  the Redemption Price;

          (3)  the name and address of the Paying Agent;

          (4)  that Securities called for redemption must be surrendered to the
               Paying Agent to collect the Redemption Price;

          (5)  that interest on Securities called for redemption ceases to
               accrue on and after the Redemption Date;

          (6)  if any Security is being redeemed in part, the portion of the
               principal amount of such Security to be redeemed and that, after
               the Redemption Date, upon surrender of such Security, a new
               Security or Securities in principal amount equal to the
               unredeemed portion thereof will be issued;

          (7)  the CUSIP number, if any.

          Upon its receipt of a Company Order, the Trustee shall give the notice
of redemption in the Company's name and at the Company's expense. If a CUSIP
number is listed in such notice or printed on the Security, the notice shall
state that no representation is made as to the correctness or accuracy of such
CUSIP number.

SECTION 3.4  EFFECT OF NOTICE OF REDEMPTION.

          Once notice of redemption is mailed, Securities called for redemption
become due and payable on the applicable Redemption Date and at the applicable
Redemption Price and shall cease to bear interest from and after the Redemption
Date (unless the Company shall default in payment of the Redemption Price or
accrued interest). Upon surrender to the Paying Agent, such Securities shall be
paid at the Redemption Price, plus accrued interest to the Redemption Date.

SECTION 3.5  DEPOSIT OF REDEMPTION PRICE.

          On or before 10 a.m. on the Redemption Date, the Company shall deposit
with the Paying Agent (or if the Company or a Subsidiary thereof is the Paying
Agent, shall segregate and hold in trust or cause such Subsidiary to segregate
and hold in trust) in immediately available funds money sufficient to pay the
Redemption Price of and accrued interest on all Securities to be redeemed on
that date.

SECTION 3.6  SECURITIES REDEEMED IN PART.

          Upon surrender of a Security that is redeemed in part, the Trustee
shall authenticate for the Holder, at the expense of the Company, a new Security
equal in principal amount to the unredeemed portion of the Security surrendered.


                                    ARTICLE 4

                                    COVENANTS

SECTION 4.1  PAYMENT OF THE SECURITIES.

          The Company shall duly and punctually pay the principal of, premium if
any, and interest on the Securities on the dates and in the manner provided in
the Securities and this Indenture. An installment of principal, premium, if any,
or interest shall be considered paid on the date it is due if the Trustee or
Paying Agent (other than the Company or any of its Subsidiaries) holds on that
date money designated for and sufficient to pay the installment. The Company
shall pay interest on overdue principal and premium, if any, at the rate borne
by the Security; it shall pay interest, including post-petition interest in the
event of a proceeding under the Bankruptcy Laws, on overdue installments of
interest at the same rate to the extent lawful.

SECTION 4.2  COMMISSION REPORTS.

          Whether or not the Company is then subject to Section 13(a) or 15(d)
of the Exchange Act, the Company will file with the Commission (unless such
filing is not permitted under the Exchange Act), so long as the Securities are
outstanding, the annual reports, quarterly reports and other periodic reports
(including financial statements and reports) which the Company would have been
required to file with the Commission pursuant to such Section 13(a) or 15(d) if
the Company were so subject, and such documents shall be filed with the
Commission on or prior to the respective dates (the "Required Filing Dates") by
which the Company would have been required so to file such documents if the
Company were so subject. The Company will also in any event (i) within 15 days
of each Required Filing Date, (a) transmit or cause to be transmitted by mail to
all Holders of Securities, as their names and addresses appear in the Security
Register, without cost to such Holders, and (b) file with the Trustee copies of
the annual reports, quarterly reports and other periodic reports which the
Company would have been required to file with the Commission pursuant to Section
13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act if the Company were subject to such Sections
and (ii) if filing such documents by the Company with the Commission is
prohibited under the Exchange Act, promptly upon written request and payment of
the reasonable cost of duplication and delivery, supply copies of such documents
to any prospective Holder at the Company's cost. The Company also shall comply
with the provisions of TIA ' 314(a).

SECTION 4.3  WAIVER OF STAY, EXTENSION OR USURY LAWS.

          The Company expressly waives (to the extent that it may lawfully do
so) any stay or extension law or any usury law or other law that would prohibit
or forgive the Company from paying all or any portion of the principal of
(premium, if any) or interest on the Securities as contemplated herein, wherever
enacted, now or at any time hereafter in force, or that may affect the covenants
or the performance of this Indenture.

SECTION 4.4  NOTICE OF DEFAULT.

          The Company will, so long as any Securities are outstanding, deliver
to the Trustee, within 10 days of becoming aware of any Default or Event of
Default in the performance of any covenant, agreement or condition in this
Indenture, an Officers' Certificate specifying such Default or Event of Default
and what action the Company is taking or proposes to take with respect thereto.

SECTION 4.5  COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATES.

          The Company will deliver to the Trustee, within 120 days after the end
of each fiscal year of the Company beginning with the fiscal year ending in 1998
(which as of the date hereof is December 31), a written statement signed by the
President or a Vice President and by the Treasurer, an Assistant Treasurer, the
Controller or an Assistant Controller of the Company, stating, as to each signer
thereof, that:

          (1) a review of the activities of the Company during such year and of
performance under this Indenture has been made under such signer's supervision
and

          (2) to the best of such signer's knowledge, based on such review, the
Company has kept, observed, performed and fulfilled in all material respects
each and every condition and covenant contained in this Indenture throughout
such year, or, if there has been a default in the fulfillment of any such
condition or covenant, specifying each such default known to such signer and the
nature and status thereof and what action the Company is taking or proposes to
take with respect thereto.

          The Company will give the Trustee written notice of a change in the
fiscal year of the Company, within a reasonable time after such change is
effected.

SECTION 4.6  LIMITATION ON DIVIDENDS AND OTHER DISTRIBUTIONS.

          The Company will not declare or pay any dividends or make any
distribution to holders of its Capital Stock (other than dividends or
distributions payable in Capital Stock of the Company), or purchase, redeem or
otherwise acquire or retire for value any of its Capital Stock or permit any
Subsidiary to purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire or retire for value any of
the Company's Capital Stock if at the time of any of the aforementioned actions
an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or would exist immediately
after giving effect to such action.

          Notwithstanding the foregoing, the provisions of this Section 4.6 will
not prevent the payment of any dividend within 60 days after the date of
declaration when the payment would have complied with the foregoing provisions
on the date of declaration.

SECTION 4.7  MAINTENANCE OF OFFICE OR AGENCY.

          The Company will maintain in The City of New York, an office or agency
where Securities may be presented or surrendered for payment, where Securities
may be surrendered for registration of transfer or exchange and where notices
and demands to or upon the Company in respect of the Securities, if any, and
this Indenture may be served. The office of the Trustee shall be such office or
agency of the Company, unless the Company shall designate and maintain some
other office or agency for one or more of such purposes. The Company will give
prompt written notice to the Trustee of any change in the location of any such
office or agency. If at any time the Company shall fail to maintain any such
required office or agency or shall fail to furnish the Trustee with the address
thereof, such presentations, surrenders, notices and demands may be made or
served at the Corporate Trust Office, and the Company hereby appoints the
Trustee as its agent to receive all such presentations, surrenders, notices and
demands.

          The Company may also from time to time designate one or more other
offices or agencies (in or outside of The City of New York) where the Securities
may be presented or surrendered for any or all such purposes, and may from time
to time rescind such designation; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that no such designation or
rescission shall in any manner relieve the Company of its obligation to maintain
an office or agency in the Borough of Manhattan in The City of New York for such
purposes. The Company will give prompt written notice to the Trustee of any such
designation or rescission and any change in the location of any such other
office or agency.

SECTION 4.8  EXISTENCE.

          Subject to Article Five, the Company will do or cause to be done all
things necessary to, and will cause each of its Significant Subsidiaries to,
preserve and keep in full force and effect its corporate existence and the
corporate existence of each of the Significant Subsidiaries, and the rights
(charter and statutory), licenses and franchises of the Company and each of the
Significant Subsidiaries, as applicable, PROVIDED, however, that the Company
shall not be required to, or cause any such Significant Subsidiary to, preserve
or keep in force or effect any such right, license or franchise, or any such
Significant Subsidiary's corporate existence, if its Board of Directors shall
determine that the preservation thereof is no longer desirable in the conduct of
the business of the Company and its Subsidiaries as a whole and that the loss
thereof would not materially adversely affect the Company's ability to perform
its obligations under the Indenture and the Securities.

SECTION 4.9  PAYMENT OF TAXES AND OTHER CLAIMS.

          The Company shall pay or discharge or cause to be paid or discharged,
before the same shall become delinquent and a penalty accrues from such
delinquency, () all material taxes, assessments and governmental charges levied
or imposed (i) upon the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or (ii) upon the
income, profits or property of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries and () all
material lawful claims for labor, materials and supplies, which, if unpaid,
would by law become a Lien (as defined herein) upon the property of the Company
or any of its Subsidiaries (other than any Lien permitted by this Indenture);
PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that the Company shall not be required to pay or discharge or
cause to be paid or discharged any such tax, assessment, charge or claim whose
amount, applicability or validity is being contested in good faith by
appropriate proceedings properly instituted and diligently conducted, or where
the failure to effect such payment or discharge would not materially adversely
affect the Company's ability to perform its obligations under the Indenture and
the Securities.

SECTION 4.10  MAINTENANCE OF PROPERTIES.

          The Company shall, and shall cause each of its Significant
Subsidiaries to, cause all material properties owned by the Company or the
Significant Subsidiaries or used in the conduct of its business or the
businesses of the Significant Subsidiaries to be maintained and kept in good
condition, repair and working order (reasonable wear and tear excepted) and
supplied with all necessary equipment, and cause to be made all repairs,
renewals, replacements, betterments and improvements thereof, all as shall be
reasonably necessary so that the business carried on in connection therewith may
be conducted at all times in the ordinary course; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that
nothing in this Section 4.10 shall prevent the Company or any of its
Subsidiaries from discontinuing the operation and maintenance of any of such
properties if (x) such discontinuance is, in the judgement of the Company or the
Subsidiary, desirable in the conduct of its businesses or (y) if such
discontinuance or disposal is not materially adverse to the Company and its
Subsidiaries taken as a whole or the ability of the Company to otherwise satisfy
its obligations hereunder.

SECTION 4.11  INSURANCE.

          The Company will at all times keep all of its and its Subsidiaries'
properties which are of an insurable nature insured with insurers, believed by
the Company in good faith to be financially sound and responsible, against loss
or damage to the extent that property of similar character is usually so insured
by corporations similarly situated and owning like properties (which may include
self-insurance, if reasonable and in comparable form to that maintained by
companies similarly situated).

SECTION 4.12  LIMITATION ON LIENS.

          The Company will not, directly or indirectly, create, incur or assume
any mortgage, pledge, deed of trust, financing lease (as lessee) or security
interest ("Liens") on any of its properties whether now or hereafter acquired,
or any income or profits therefrom, or assign or convey any right to receive
income therefrom (any such Lien, an "Initial Lien"), unless prior to or
simultaneously with the inception of such Initial Lien, the Company shall have
delivered to the Trustee a security agreement or security agreements and such
other documents as the Trustee may reasonably request, each in form and
substance satisfactory to the Trustee, granting to the Trustee an equal and
ratable security interest in such property subject to such Initial Lien, such
security interest to be for the equal and ratable benefit of the Holders. Any
such security interest created in favor of the Securities will be automatically
and unconditionally released and discharged upon the release and discharge of
the Initial Lien to which it relates. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the
restrictions set forth in this paragraph shall not apply if at the time of, and
immediately after giving PRO FORMA effect to, the transaction giving rise to
such Initial Lien, the Consolidated Indebtedness-to-Stockholders' Equity Ratio
does not exceed 4.0 to 1.0.

          The foregoing restrictions shall not apply to:

          (i) Liens securing obligations outstanding from time to time under any
revolving credit agreement to which the Company is a party;

          (ii) Liens on assets existing at the time of acquisition thereof by
the Company, PROVIDED that such Liens were in existence prior to such
acquisition and were not created in contemplation of such acquisition;

          (iii) Liens on assets of another Person existing at the time such
Person is merged into or consolidated with the Company, PROVIDED that such Liens
were in existence prior to such merger or consolidation and were not created in
contemplation of such merger or consolidation and do not extend to any assets of
the Company other than those previously owned by the Person merged into or
consolidated with the Company;

          (iv) Liens securing Purchase Money Indebtedness, but only on assets in
respect to the purchase of which such Purchase Money Indebtedness shall have
been incurred;

          (v) Liens on real property;

          (vi) Liens in favor of any Subsidiary of the Company;

          (vii) Liens incurred or deposits made in the ordinary course of
business (w) in connection with workers' compensation, unemployment insurance,
social security or other like laws, (x) to secure the performance of letters of
credit, bids, tenders, trade contracts (other than for borrowed money), sales
contracts, leases, statutory obligations, surety, appeal and performance bonds
and other similar obligations, (y) in connection with the opening of commercial
letters of credit naming the Company or any of its Subsidiaries as an account
party, or (z) for the benefit of any governmental agency or body created or
approved by law or governmental regulation as a condition to the transaction of
business or the exercise of any privilege, franchise or license;

          (viii) Liens securing Lease Obligations; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that no
such Lease Obligations shall arise out of the Sale and Leaseback of
Transportation Equipment unless the Sale and Leaseback in question is entered
into prior to, at the time of or within 180 days of the acquisition of the
Transportation Equipment being sold and leased back; and PROVIDED, FURTHER, that
the leasing of Transportation Equipment which has been remanufactured so that it
is the substantial equivalent of new equipment shall be considered the leasing
of new equipment and not of the used equipment which was remanufactured and
subsequently sold and leased back;

          (ix) Liens for taxes, assessments or governmental charges or claims
that are not yet delinquent or that are being contested in good faith by
appropriate proceedings, PROVIDED that any reserve or other appropriate
provision as shall be required in conformity with generally accepted accounting
principles shall have been made therefor;

          (x) Liens imposed by law, including but not limited to carriers',
seamen's, stevedores', wharfinger's, warehousemen's, mechanics', suppliers',
materialmen's, repairman's or other like Liens, in each case for sums not yet
due or being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings, or other Liens
arising out of judgments or awards against the Company or any of its
Subsidiaries with respect to which the Company or such Subsidiary shall then be
proceeding with an appeal or other proceeding for review;

          (xi) Leases, lease agreements and other contracts entered into in the
ordinary course of business providing for the leasing, sale or exchange of
Transportation Equipment owned by the Company;

          (xii) Liens securing hedging obligations;

          (xiii) Liens (x) existing on the date of the Indenture or (y) to
secure any renewal, extension, substitution, refunding, defeasance, refinancing,
repayment or replacement (a "Refinancing") (or successive Refinancings), in
whole or in part, of any Indebtedness (or commitment for Indebtedness) existing
on the date of this Indenture, PROVIDED, however, that the Indebtedness secured
by such Lien is not, solely by virtue of such Refinancing, increased to an
amount greater than the greater of (A) the outstanding principal amount of such
Indebtedness existing on the date of the Indenture that is secured by such Lien
or (B) if such Lien secures Indebtedness under a line of credit, the commitment
amount of such line of credit existing on the date of this Indenture; and

          (xiii) Liens incurred in the ordinary course of business of the
Company with respect to obligations that do not exceed $1.0 million at any one
time outstanding and that (x) are not incurred in connection with the borrowing
of money or the obtaining of advances or credit (other than trade credit in the
ordinary course of business) and (y) do not in the aggregate materially detract
from the value of the assets subject to such Lien or materially impair the use
thereof in the operation of business by the Company.


                                    ARTICLE 5

                              SUCCESSOR CORPORATION

SECTION 5.1  WHEN COMPANY MAY MERGE, ETC.

          The Company shall not consolidate with or merge into, or transfer all
or substantially all of its assets to, another Person in any transaction in
which the Company is not the continuing or surviving entity unless (i) the
resulting, surviving or transferee Person is a corporation which expressly
assumes by supplemental indenture all the obligations of the Company under the
Securities and this Indenture; (ii) such corporation is organized and existing
under the laws of the United States, a State thereof or the District of
Columbia; (iii) immediately after giving effect to such transaction no Default
or Event of Default shall have happened and be continuing, and the Officers'
Certificate referred to in the following clause reflects that such Officers are
not aware of any such Default or Event of Default that shall have happened and
be continuing, and (iv) the Company shall have delivered to the Trustee an
Officers' Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, each stating that such
consolidation, merger or transfer and such supplemental indenture comply with
this Indenture.

SECTION 5.2  SUCCESSOR CORPORATION OR TRUST SUBSTITUTED.

          Upon any consolidation or merger, or any transfer of all or
substantially all of the assets of the Company in accordance with Section 5.1,
the successor corporation formed by such consolidation or into which the Company
is merged or to which such transfer is made shall succeed to, and be substituted
for, and may exercise every right and power of, the Company under this Indenture
with the same effect as if such successor corporation has been named as the
Company herein, and thereafter all obligations of the Company shall terminate.


                                    ARTICLE 6

                              DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES

SECTION 6.1  EVENTS OF DEFAULT.

          An "Event of Default" occurs if, with respect to the Securities:

          (1) the Company defaults in the payment of interest on the Securities
when the same becomes due and payable and the default continues for a period of
30 days;

          (2) the Company defaults in the payment of the principal of (and
premium, if any, on) the Securities when the same becomes due and payable at
maturity, upon redemption or otherwise;

          (3) the Company fails to comply with any of its other agreements in
the Securities or this Indenture and the default continues for the period and
after the notice specified in the last paragraph of this Section 6.1;

          (4) there shall be a default under any bond, debenture, note or other
evidence of Indebtedness or under any mortgage, indenture or other instrument
under which there may be issued or by which there may be secured or evidenced
any Indebtedness of the Company or any Significant Subsidiary, whether any such
Indebtedness now exists or shall hereafter be created, if (a) either (i) such
event of default results from the failure to pay any such Indebtedness at
maturity or (ii) as a result of such event of default, the maturity of such
Indebtedness has been accelerated prior to its expressed maturity, provided that
any such failure to pay shall not be cured and any such acceleration shall not
be rescinded or annulled or the accelerated amount paid within ten days after
notice to the Company of such failure to pay or acceleration, or such
Indebtedness having been discharged and (b) the principal amount of such
Indebtedness, together with the principal amount of any other such Indebtedness
in default for failure to pay principal or interest thereon, or the maturity of
which has been so accelerated, aggregates $10,000,000 or more;

          (5) the Company or any Significant Subsidiary pursuant to or within
the meaning of any Bankruptcy Law:

               (A)  commences a voluntary case or proceeding,

               (B)  consents to the entry of an order for relief against it in
                    an involuntary case or proceeding,

               (C)  consents to the appointment of a Custodian of it or for all
                    or substantially all of its property, or

               (D)  makes a general assignment for the benefit of its creditors;
                    or

          (6) a court of competent jurisdiction enters an order or decree under
any Bankruptcy Law that:

               (A)  is for relief against the Company or any Significant
                    Subsidiary in an involuntary case or proceeding,

               (B)  appoints a Custodian of the Company or any Significant
                    Subsidiary or for all or substantially all of their
                    respective property, or

               (C)  orders the liquidation of the Company or any Significant
                    Subsidiary,

and the order or decree remains unstayed and in effect for 90 days.

          A default under clause (3) is not an Event of Default with respect to
the Securities until the Trustee notifies the Company, or the Holders of a
majority in principal amount of the Securities then outstanding notify the
Company and the Trustee in writing, of the default and the Company does not cure
the default within 60 days after receipt of such notice. The notice must specify
the default, demand that it be remedied and state that the notice is a "Notice
of Default." Such notice by the Trustee shall not be deemed to be a
certification by the Trustee as to whether an Event of Default has occurred.
Failure of the Trustee to give such notice does not constitute a waiver of any
of its rights hereunder.

SECTION 6.2  ACCELERATION.

          If an Event of Default occurs and is continuing with respect to the
Securities, the Trustee by notice to the Company, or the Holders of a majority
in principal amount of the Securities then outstanding by written notice to the
Company and the Trustee, may declare to be due and payable immediately the
principal amount of the Securities plus accrued interest to the date of
acceleration. Upon any such declaration, such amount shall be due and payable
immediately, and upon payment of such amount all of the Company's obligations
with respect to the Securities, other than obligations under Section 7.7, shall
terminate. The Holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding
Securities by written notice to the Trustee may rescind an acceleration and its
consequences if (x) all existing Events of Default with respect to the
Securities, other than the non-payment of the principal of the Securities, which
have become due solely by such declaration of acceleration, have been cured or
waived, (y) to the extent that payment of such interest is lawful, interest on
overdue installments of interest and overdue principal which has become due
otherwise than by such declaration of acceleration, has been paid, and (z) the
rescission would not conflict with any judgment or decree of a court of
competent jurisdiction. The Trustee may rely upon such notice of rescission
without any independent investigation as to the satisfaction of conditions (x),
(y) and (z).

SECTION 6.3  OTHER REMEDIES.

          If an Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Trustee may
pursue any available remedy by proceeding at law or in equity to collect the
payment of principal (and premium, if any) or interest on the Securities or to
enforce the performance of any provision of the Securities or this Indenture.

          The Trustee may maintain a proceeding even if it does not possess any
of the Securities or does not produce any of them in the proceeding. A delay or
omission by the Trustee or any Securityholder in exercising any right or remedy
accruing upon an Event of Default shall not impair the right or remedy or
constitute a waiver of or acquiescence in the Event of Default. No remedy is
exclusive of any other remedy. All available remedies are cumulative.

SECTION 6.4  WAIVER OF DEFAULTS AND EVENTS OF DEFAULT.

          Subject to Section 10.2, the Holders of a majority in principal amount
of the Securities then outstanding, on behalf of the Holders of the Securities,
by written notice to the Trustee may waive a Default or Event of Default with
respect to the Securities and its consequences. When a Default is waived with
respect to the Securities it is cured and ceases to exist and any Event of
Default arising therefrom shall be deemed to have been cured for every purpose
of this Indenture.

SECTION 6.5  CONTROL BY MAJORITY.

          The Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Securities then
outstanding may direct in writing the time, method and place of conducting any
proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee, or exercising any trust or
power conferred on it with respect to the Securities. The Trustee, however, may
refuse to follow any direction (i) that conflicts with law or this Indenture,
(ii) that the Trustee, in its reasonable discretion, determines may be unduly
prejudicial to the rights of other Securityholders or that may involve the
Trustee in personal liability or (iii) for which the Trustee determines, in its
reasonable discretion, that it does not have adequate indemnification pursuant
to Section 7.1(e); PROVIDED, that the Trustee may take any other action deemed
proper by the Trustee which is not inconsistent with such direction.

SECTION 6.6  RIGHTS OF HOLDERS TO RECEIVE PAYMENT.

          Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Indenture, the right of
any Holder of a Security to receive payment of principal of, premium, if any,
and interest on such Security, on or after the respective due dates expressed in
such Security, or to bring suit for the enforcement of any such payment on or
after such respective dates, is absolute and unconditional and shall not be
impaired or affected without the consent of the Holder.

SECTION 6.7  COLLECTION SUIT BY TRUSTEE.

          If an Event of Default with respect to the Securities in payment of
interest or principal (and premium, if any) specified in Section 6.1(1) or (2)
occurs and is continuing, the Trustee may recover judgment in its own name and
as trustee of an express trust against the Company or any other obligor on the
Securities for the whole amount of unpaid principal (and premium, if any) and
accrued interest remaining unpaid on the Securities, together with interest on
overdue principal (and premium, if any) and to the extent that payment of such
interest is lawful, interest on overdue installments of interest, in each case
at the rate borne by the Securities and such further amount as shall be
sufficient to cover the costs and expenses of collection, including the
reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee,
its agents and counsel.

SECTION 6.8  TRUSTEE MAY FILE PROOFS OF CLAIM.

          The Trustee may file such proofs of claim and other papers or
documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to have the claims of the
Trustee (including any claim for the reasonable compensation, expenses,
disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel) and the
Holders of Securities allowed in any judicial proceedings relative to the
Company (or any other obligor upon the Securities), its creditors or its
property and shall be entitled and empowered to collect and receive any monies
or other property payable or deliverable on any such claims and to distribute
the same. Any Custodian in any such judicial proceeding is hereby authorized by
each Securityholder to make such payments to the Trustee, and in the event that
the Trustee shall consent to the making of such payments directly to the Holders
of Securities to pay to the Trustee any amount due to it for the reasonable
compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents
and counsel, and any other amounts due the Trustee under Section 7.7.

          Nothing herein contained shall be deemed to authorize the Trustee to
authorize or consent to or accept or adopt on behalf of any Securityholder any
plan or reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or composition affecting the
Securities or the rights of any Holder thereof, or to authorize the Trustee to
vote in respect of the claim of any Securityholder in any such proceeding.

SECTION 6.9  PRIORITIES.

          If the Trustee collects any money pursuant to this Article 6 with
respect to the Securities, it shall pay out the money in the following order:

          FIRST: to the Trustee for amounts due under Section 7.7, including
          payment of all compensation, expenses and liabilities incurred, and
          all advances made by the Trustee and the costs and expenses of
          collection;

          SECOND: to Holders of Securities for amounts due and unpaid on the
          Securities for principal of (and premium, if any) and interest,
          ratably, without preference or priority of any kind, according to the
          amounts due and payable on the Securities for principal (and premium,
          if any) and interest, respectively;

          THIRD: to the Company or to such party as a court of competent
          jurisdiction shall direct.

          The Trustee may fix a record date and payment date for any payment to
Holders of Securities pursuant to this Section 6.9.

SECTION 6.10  UNDERTAKING FOR COSTS.

          In any suit for the enforcement of any right or remedy under this
Indenture or in any suit against the Trustee for any action taken or omitted by
it as Trustee, a court in its discretion may require the filing by any party
litigant in the suit of an undertaking to pay the costs of the suit, and the
court in its discretion may assess reasonable costs, including reasonable
attorney's fees, against any party litigant in the suit, having due regard to
the merits and good faith of the claims or defenses made by the party litigant.
This Section 6.10 does not apply to a suit by the Trustee, a suit by a Holder
pursuant to section 6.6 or a suit by Holders of more than 10% in principal
amount of the Securities then outstanding.

SECTION 6.11  LIMITATIONS ON SUITS.

          Subject to Section 6.6, a Holder of Securities may not pursue any
remedy with respect to this Indenture or the Securities unless:

          (1) the Holder has given the Trustee written notice of a continuing
Event of Default;

          (2) the Holders of at least 25% in principal amount of Securities make
a written request to the Trustee to pursue the remedy;

          (3) such Holder or Holders offer to the Trustee indemnity satisfactory
to the Trustee against any loss, liability or expenses;

          (4) the Trustee does not comply with the request within 60 days after
receipt of the notice, request and offer of indemnity; and

          (5) no direction inconsistent with such written request has been given
to the Trustee during such 60 day period by the Holders of a majority in
principal amount then outstanding.

          A Holder of any Security may not use this Indenture to prejudice the
rights of another Securityholder or to obtain a preference or priority over
another Securityholder.

SECTION 6.12  RESTORATION OF RIGHTS AND REMEDIES.

          If the Trustee or any Holder has instituted any proceeding to enforce
any right or remedy under this Indenture and such proceeding has been
discontinued or abandoned for any reason, or has been determined adversely to
the Trustee or to such Holder, then and in every case, subject to any
determination in such proceeding, the Company, the Trustee and the Holders shall
be restored severally and respectively to their former positions hereunder and
thereafter all rights and remedies of the Trustee and the Holders shall continue
as though no such proceeding had been instituted.


                                    ARTICLE 7

                                     TRUSTEE

SECTION 7.1  DUTIES OF TRUSTEE.

          (a) If an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the Trustee
shall exercise the rights and powers vested in it by this Indenture and use the
same degree of care and skill in their exercise as a prudent Person would
exercise or use under the circumstances in the conduct of his own affairs.

          (b) Except during the continuance of an Event of Default:

               (1) The Trustee need perform only those duties that are
          specifically set forth in this Indenture and no others, and no implied
          covenants or obligation shall be read into this Indenture against the
          Trustee.

               (2) In the absence of bad faith on its part, the Trustee may
          conclusively rely, as to the truth of the statements and the
          correctness of the opinions expressed therein, upon certificates or
          opinions furnished to the Trustee and conforming to the requirements
          of this Indenture. The Trustee, however, shall examine the
          certificates and opinions to determinate whether or not they conform
          to the requirements of this Indenture.

          (c) The Trustee may not be relieved from liability for its own
negligent action, its own negligent failure to act, or its own willful
misconduct, except that:

               (1) This paragraph does not limit the effect of paragraph (b) of
          this Section 7.1.

               (2) The Trustee shall not be liable for any error in judgment
          made in good faith by a Trust Officer, unless it is proved that the
          Trustee was negligent in ascertaining the pertinent facts.

               (3) The Trustee shall not be liable with respect to any action it
          takes or omits to take in good faith in accordance with a direction
          received by it pursuant to Section 6.5.

               (4) No provision of this Indenture shall require the Trustee to
          expend or risk its own funds or otherwise incur any financial
          liability in the performance of any of its duties hereunder or in the
          exercise of any of its rights or powers, if it shall have reasonable
          grounds for believing that repayment of such funds or adequate
          indemnity against such risk or liability is not reasonably assured to
          it.

          (d) Every provision of this Indenture that in any way relates to the
Trustee is subject to paragraphs (a), (b) and (c) of this Section 7.1.

          (e) Subject to subsection (c), the Trustee may refuse to perform any
duty or exercise any right or power unless, subject to the provisions of the
TIA, it receives indemnity satisfactory to it against any loss, liability,
expense or fee.

          (f) The Trustee shall not be liable for interest on any money received
by it except as the Trustee may agree in writing with the Company. Money held in
trust by the Trustee need not be segregated from other funds except to the
extent required by law.

SECTION 7.2  RIGHTS OF TRUSTEE.

          (a) The Trustee may conclusively rely on and shall be protected in
acting or refraining from acting upon any document believed by it to be genuine
and to have been signed or presented by the proper Person. The Trustee need not
investigate any fact or matter stated in the document.

          (b) Before the Trustee acts or refrains from acting, it may require an
Officers' Certificate or an Opinion of Counsel, or both, which shall conform to
Section 11.5 hereof. The Trustee shall not be liable for any action it takes or
omits to take in good faith in reliance on such Officers' Certificate or Opinion
of Counsel.

          (c) The Trustee may act through agents and shall not be responsible
for the misconduct or negligence of any agent appointed with due care.

          (d) The Trustee shall not be liable for any action it takes or omits
to take in good faith which it believes to be authorized or within its rights or
powers.

          (e) The Trustee may consult with counsel, and the written advice of
such counsel or any Opinion of Counsel shall be full and complete authorization
and protection in respect of any action taken, suffered or omitted by the
Trustee hereunder in good faith and reliance thereon.

          (f) The Trustee shall be under no obligation to exercise any of the
rights or powers vested in it by this Indenture at the request or direction of
any of the Holders of the Securities or the Company unless such Holders or the
Company shall have offered to the Trustee reasonable security or indemnify
against the costs, expenses and liabilities which might be incurred by it in
compliance with such request or direction.

SECTION 7.3  INDIVIDUAL RIGHTS OF TRUSTEE.

          The Trustee in its individual or any other capacity may become the
owner or pledgee of Securities and may otherwise deal with the Company or its
Affiliates with the same rights it would have if it were not Trustee. Any Agent
may do the same with like rights. The Trustee, however, is subject to Sections
7.10 and 7.11.

SECTION 7.4  TRUSTEE'S DISCLAIMER.

          The Trustee makes no representation as to the validity or adequacy of
this Indenture or the Securities, it shall not be accountable for the Company's
use of the proceeds from the Securities or any money paid to the Company or upon
the Company's direction under any provision of this Indenture, it shall not be
responsible for the use or application of any money received by any Paying Agent
other than the Trustee, and it shall not be responsible for any statement of the
Company in the Indenture or any statement in the Securities other than its
certificate of authentication or in any document used in the sale of the
Securities other than any statement in writing provided by the Trustee expressly
for use in such document.

SECTION 7.5  NOTICE OF DEFAULTS.

          If a Default or Event of Default occurs and is continuing and if it is
known to the Trustee with respect to the Securities, the Trustee shall mail to
each Holder of Securities notice of the Default or Event of Default within 90
days after it occurs. Except in the case of a default in payment of principal
of, premium, if any, or interest on any Security, the Trustee may withhold the
notice if and so long as a committee of its Trust Officers in good faith
determines that withholding the notice is in the interests of Holders of
Securities. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary expressed in this
Indenture, the Trustee shall not be deemed to have knowledge of any Event of
Default hereunder unless and until a Trust Officer shall have actual knowledge
thereof, or shall have received written notice thereof from the Company at its
principal corporate trust office in New York, New York. The Trustee shall not be
deemed to have actual knowledge of an Event of Default hereunder, except in the
case of an Event of Default under Sections 6.1(1) or 6.1(2) (provided that the
Trustee is the Paying Agent) until a Trust Officer receives written notice
thereof from the Company or any Securityholder that such an Event of Default has
occurred.

SECTION 7.6  REPORTS BY TRUSTEE TO HOLDERS.

          Within 60 days after each May 15, beginning with May 15, 1998, the
Trustee, if required by the provisions of TIA ' 313(a), shall mail to each
Securityholder a brief report dated as of May 15 of such year that complies with
TIA ' 313(a). The Trustee also shall comply with TIA '(b) and ' 313(c).

          A copy of each report at the time of its mailing to Securityholders
shall be filed with the Commission and each stock exchange on which the
Securities are listed. The Company agrees to notify the Trustee in writing
whenever the Securities become listed or delisted on or from any stock exchange.

SECTION 7.7  COMPENSATION AND INDEMNITY.

          The Company shall pay to the Trustee from time to time reasonable
compensation for its services (which compensation shall not be limited by any
provision of law in regard to the compensation of a trustee of an express
trust). The Company shall reimburse the Trustee upon request for all reasonable
disbursements, expenses and advances incurred or made by it in addition to the
compensation for its services. Such expenses may include the reasonable
compensation, disbursements and expenses of the Trustee's agents, accountants,
experts and counsel.

          The Company shall indemnify the Trustee for, and hold it harmless
against, any loss or liability incurred by it in connection with the acceptance
or administration of this trust or its actions taken hereunder in whatever
capacity the Trustee is so acting, including the costs and expenses of defending
itself against any claim or liability in connection with the Securities or the
exercise or performance of any of its powers or duties hereunder, including
attorneys' fees and expenses. The Trustee shall notify the Company as soon as
practicable after the Trustee becomes aware of any claim asserted against the
Trustee for which it intends to seek indemnity (though failure by the Trustee to
so notify the Company shall not relieve the Company of its obligations hereunder
unless the Company is prejudiced thereby) and the Company may elect by written
notice to the Trustee to assume the defense of any such claim at the Company's
expense with counsel reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee, PROVIDED, HOWEVER,
that in the case where there is a conflict between the Company and the Trustee,
the Company shall pay the reasonable fees and expenses of counsel retained by
the Trustee.

          The Company need not reimburse the Trustee for any expense or
indemnify it against any loss or liability incurred by it through the Trustee's
negligence, bad faith or willful misconduct. The Company shall not be liable for
any settlement of any claim or action effected without the Company's consent,
which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld.

          The Company hereby grants the Trustee a security interest in all of
the funds and assets of the Company held by the Trustee pursuant to this
Indenture to secure the performance of the Company's obligations to the Trustee
hereunder.

          The obligations of the Company under this Section 7.7 shall survive
the resignation or removal of the Trustee and/or the satisfaction or discharge
of this Indenture.

SECTION 7.8  REPLACEMENT OF TRUSTEE.

          A resignation or removal of the Trustee and appointment of a successor
Trustee shall become effective only upon the successor Trustee's acceptance of
appointment as provided in this Section 7.8.

          The Trustee may resign by so notifying the Company. The Holders of a
majority in principal amount of the Securities then outstanding may remove the
Trustee by so notifying the Trustee in writing and may appoint a successor
Trustee with the Company's written consent. The Company may remove the Trustee
if:

          (1) the Trustee fails to comply with Section 7.10;

          (2) the Trustee is adjudged a bankrupt or an insolvent;

          (3) a receiver or other public officer takes charge of the Trustee or
its property; or

          (4) the Trustee otherwise becomes incapable of acting.

          If the Trustee resigns or is removed or if a vacancy exists in the
office of Trustee for any reason, the Company shall promptly appoint a successor
Trustee.

          If a successor Trustee does not take office within 45 days after the
retiring Trustee resigns or is removed, the retiring Trustee, the Company or the
Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Securities then outstanding may
petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of a successor
Trustee.

          If the Trustee fails to comply with Section 7.10, any Securityholder
may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the removal of the Trustee
and the appointment of a successor Trustee.

          A successor Trustee shall deliver a written acceptance of its
appointment to the retiring Trustee and to the Company. Immediately after that,
the retiring Trustee shall, upon payment of its charges, transfer all property
held by it as Trustee to the successor Trustee, the resignation or removal of
the retiring Trustee shall become effective, and the successor Trustee shall
have all the rights, powers and duties of the Trustee under this Indenture.
Notwithstanding the replacement of the Trustee pursuant to this Section 7.8, the
Company's obligations under Section 7.7 shall continue for the benefit of the
retiring Trustee with respect to expenses and liabilities incurred by it and
compensation earned by it prior to such replacement or otherwise with respect to
the Securities or the Indenture. A successor Trustee shall mail notice of its
succession to each Holder of Securities.

SECTION 7.9  SUCCESSOR TRUSTEE BY MERGER, ETC.

          If the Trustee consolidates with, merges or converts into, or
transfers all or substantially all of its corporate trust assets to, another
corporation, the successor corporation without any further act shall be the
successor Trustee.

SECTION 7.10  ELIGIBILITY; DISQUALIFICATION.

          This Indenture shall always have a Trustee who satisfies the
requirements of TIA ' 310(a)(1). The Trustee shall have a combined capital and
surplus of at least $50,000,000 as set forth in its most recent published annual
report of condition. The Trustee shall comply with TIA ' 310(b), including the
optional provision permitted by the second sentence of TIA ' 310(b)(9).

SECTION 7.11  PREFERENTIAL COLLECTION OF CLAIMS AGAINST COMPANY.
 
          The Trustee is subject to TIA Section 311(a), excluding any creditor
relationship listed in TIA Section 311(b). A Trustee who has resigned or been
removed shall be subject to TIA Section 311(a) to the extent indicated therein.


                                    ARTICLE 8

                       DEFEASANCE AND COVENANT DEFEASANCE

SECTION 8.1  OPTION TO EFFECT DEFEASANCE OR COVENANT DEFEASANCE.
 
          The Company may, at its option and at any time, elect to have Section
8.2 or Section 8.3 be applied to all outstanding Securities upon compliance with
the conditions set forth below in this Article 8.

SECTION 8.2  DEFEASANCE AND DISCHARGE.
 
          Upon the Company's exercise of the above option applicable to this
Section the Company shall be deemed to have been discharged from its obligations
with respect to the outstanding Securities on the date the conditions set forth
in Section 8.4 are satisfied ("Defeasance"). For this purpose, such Defeasance
means that the Company shall be deemed to have paid and discharged the entire
indebtedness represented by the outstanding Securities, which shall thereafter
be deemed to be "outstanding" only for the purposes of Section 8.5 and the other
Sections of this Indenture referred to in Paragraphs (a) and (b) below, and to
have satisfied all of its other obligations under such Securities and this
Indenture insofar as such Securities are concerned (and the Trustee, at the
expense of the Company, shall execute proper instruments acknowledging the same
following delivery by the Company to the Trustee of an Officer's Certificate and
Opinion of Counsel stating that all such conditions have been satisfied), except
for the following which shall survive until otherwise terminated or discharged
hereunder:

          (a) the rights of Holders to receive, solely from the trust fund
described in Section 8.4 and as more fully set forth in such Section, payments
in respect of the principal of (and premium, if any) and interest on such
Securities when such payments are due,

          (b) the Company's obligations with respect to such Securities under
Sections 2.4, 2.5, 2.9, 2.10, 2.12 and 4.7.

          (c) the rights, powers, trusts, duties and immunities of the Trustee
hereunder, and

          (d) this Article 8.

Subject to compliance with this Article 8, the Company may exercise its option
under this Section 8.2 notwithstanding the prior exercise of its option under
Section 8.3 with respect to such Securities.

SECTION 8.3  COVENANT DEFEASANCE.

          Upon the Company's exercise of the above option applicable to this
Section 8.3, the Company shall be released from its obligations under Sections
4.9, 4.10, 4.11 and 4.12 with respect to the outstanding Securities on and after
the date the conditions set forth in Section 8.4 are satisfied ("Covenant
Defeasance"), and the Securities shall thereafter be deemed to be not
"outstanding" for the purposes of any direction, waiver, consent or declaration
or act of Holders (and the consequences of any thereof) in connection with
Sections 4.9, 4.10, 4.11 and 4.12, but shall continue to be deemed "outstanding"
for all other purposes hereunder. For this purpose, such Covenant Defeasance
means that, with respect to the outstanding Securities, the Company may omit to
comply with and shall have no liability in respect of any term, condition or
limitation set forth in any such Section or such other covenant, whether
directly or indirectly, by reason of any reference elsewhere herein to any such
Section or such other covenant or by reason of reference in any such Section or
such other covenant to any other provision herein or in any other document and
such omission to comply shall not constitute a default or an Event of Default
under Section 6.1(4), 6.1(5) or 6.1(6) or otherwise, as the case may be, but,
except as specified above, the remainder of this Indenture and the Securities
shall be unaffected thereby.

SECTION 8.4  CONDITIONS TO DEFEASANCE OR COVENANT DEFEASANCE.

          The following shall be the conditions to application of Section 8.2 or
Section 8.3 to the outstanding Securities:

          (a) The Company shall irrevocably have deposited or caused to be
deposited with the Trustee (or another trustee satisfying the requirements of
Section 7.10 who shall agree to comply with the provisions of this Article 8
applicable to it) as trust funds in trust for the purpose of making the
following payments, specifically pledged as security for, and dedicated solely
to, the benefit of the Holders of such Securities, (i) cash in an amount in
which such Securities are then specified as payable at stated maturity, (ii)
U.S. Government Obligations applicable to such Securities which through the
scheduled payment of principal and interest in respect thereof in accordance
with their terms will provide, not later than one day before the due date of any
payment of principal of (and premium, if any) and interest, if any, on such
Securities, money in an amount, or (iii) a combination thereof, in any case, in
an amount, sufficient, without consideration of any reinvestment of such
principal and interest, in the opinion of a nationally recognized firm of
independent public accountants expressed in a written certification thereof
delivered to the Trustee, to pay and discharge, and which shall be applied by
the Trustee (or other qualifying trustee) to pay and discharge the principal of
(and premium, if any) and interest on the outstanding Securities on the stated
maturity of such principal (and premium, if any) or installment of principal or
interest; PROVIDED that the Trustee shall have been irrevocably instructed in
writing to apply such money or the proceeds of such U.S. Government Obligations
to said payments with respect to the Securities. Before such a deposit, the
Company may give to the Trustee, in accordance with Section 3.1(b) hereof, a
notice of its election to redeem all or any portion of the outstanding
Securities at a future date in accordance with the terms of the Securities and
Article 3 hereof, which notice shall be irrevocable. Such irrevocable redemption
notice, if given, shall be given effect in applying the foregoing.

          (b) Such Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance shall not result in a
breach or violation of or constitute a default under, this Indenture or any
other material agreement or instrument to which the Company is a party or by
which it is bound.

          (c) No Default or Event of Default with respect to the Securities
shall have occurred and be continuing on the date of such deposit or, insofar as
Section 6.1(5) or 6.1(6) is concerned, at any time during the period ending on
the 91st day after the date of such deposit (it being understood that this
condition shall not be deemed satisfied until the expiration of such period).

          (d) In the case of an election under Section 8.2, the Company shall
have delivered to the Trustee an Opinion of Counsel stating that (i) the Company
has received from, or there has been published by, the Internal Revenue Service
a ruling, or (ii) since the date of execution of this Indenture, there has been
a change in the applicable Federal income tax law, in either case to the effect
that, and based thereon such opinion shall confirm that, the Holders of the
outstanding Securities will not recognize income, gain or loss for Federal
income tax purposes as a result of such Defeasance and will be subject to
Federal income tax on the same amounts, in the same manner and at the same times
as would have been the case if such Defeasance had not occurred.

          (e) In the case of an election under Section 8.3, the Company shall
have delivered to the Trustee an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that the
Holders of the outstanding Securities will not recognize income, gain or loss
for Federal income tax purposes as a result of such Covenant Defeasance and will
be subject to Federal income tax on the same amounts, in the same manner and at
the same times as would have been the case if such Covenant Defeasance had not
occurred.

          (f) The Company shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officer's
Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, each stating that all conditions
precedent to Defeasance under Section 8.2 or Covenant Defeasance under Section
8.3 (as the case may be) have been complied with and an Opinion of Counsel to
the effect that either (i) as a result of a deposit pursuant to Paragraph (a)
above and the related exercise of the Company option under Section 8.2 or
Section 8.3 (as the case may be), registration is not required under the
Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, by the Company, with respect to the
trust funds representing such deposit or by the Trustee for such trust funds, or
(ii) all necessary registrations under said Act have been effected.

SECTION 8.5  DEPOSITED MONEY AND U.S. GOVERNMENT OBLIGATIONS TO BE HELD IN
             TRUST; OTHER MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS.

          All money and U.S. Government Obligations (including the proceeds
thereof) deposited with the Trustee pursuant to Section 8.4 in respect of the
outstanding Securities shall be held in trust and applied by the Trustee, in
accordance with the provisions of such Securities and this Indenture, to the
payment, either directly or through any Paying Agent (including the Company
acting as its own Paying Agent) as the Trustee may determine, to the Holders of
such Securities of all sums due and to become due thereon in respect of
principal (and premium, if any), interest, if any, but such money need not be
segregated from other funds except to the extent required by law.

          The Company shall pay and indemnify the Trustee against any tax, fee
or other charge imposed on or assessed against the U.S. Government Obligations
deposited pursuant to Section 8.4 or the principal and interest received in
respect thereof other than any such tax, fee or other charge which by law is for
the account of the Holders of the outstanding Securities.

          Anything in this Article 8 to the contrary notwithstanding, subject to
Section 7.7, the Trustee shall deliver or pay to the Company from time to time
upon Company Order any money or U.S. Government Obligations (or other property
and any proceeds therefrom) held by it as provided in Section 8.4 which, in the
opinion of a nationally recognized firm of independent public accountants
expressed in a written certification thereof delivered to the Trustee, are in
excess of the amount thereof which would then be required to be deposited to
effect Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance, as applicable, in accordance with this
Article 8.


                                    ARTICLE 9

                           SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE

SECTION 9.1  SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE OF INDENTURE.

          The Indenture shall upon Company Order cease to be of further effect
with respect to the Securities (except as to any surviving rights of
registration of transfer or exchange of Securities expressly provided for herein
or pursuant hereto, the rights of Holders of outstanding Securities to receive,
solely from the trust fund described in subclause (ii) of clause (a) of this
Section, payments in respect of the principal of (and premium, if any) and
interest on such Securities when such payments are due, and the Trustee, upon
receipt of a Company Order, and at the expense of the Company, shall execute
proper instruments acknowledging satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture
when

          (a) either

               (1) all the Securities theretofore authenticated and delivered
          (other than (A) Securities which have been destroyed, lost or stolen
          and which have been replaced or paid as provided in Section 2.10 and
          (B) Securities for whose payment money has theretofore been deposited
          in trust or segregated and held in trust by the Company and thereafter
          repaid to the Company or discharged from such trust, as provided in
          Section 2.5) have been delivered to the Trustee for cancellation; or

               (2) all the Securities not theretofore delivered to the Trustee
          for cancellation

                           (A) have become due and payable,

                           (B) will become due and payable at their stated
                           maturity within one year or

                           (C) will be called for redemption within one year
                           under arrangements satisfactory to the Trustee for
                           the giving of notice of redemption by the Trustee in
                           the name, and at the expense, of the Company,

                  and the Company, in the case of (A), (B) or (C) above, has
                  irrevocably deposited or caused to be deposited with the
                  Trustee as trust funds in trust an amount sufficient to pay
                  and discharge the entire indebtedness on the Securities, for
                  principal (and premium, if any) and interest, to the date of
                  such deposit (in the case of Securities which have become due
                  and payable) or to the stated maturity or Redemption Date, as
                  the case may be;

          (b) The Company has paid or caused to be paid all other sums payable
hereunder by the Company; and

          (3) The Company has delivered to the Trustee an Officer's Certificate
and an Opinion of Counsel, each stating that all conditions precedent herein
provided fore relating to the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture have
been complied with.

Notwithstanding the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture, the
obligations of the Company to the Trustee and any predecessor Trustee under
Section 7.7 and, if money shall have been deposited with and held by the Trustee
pursuant to subclause (ii) of clause (a) of this Section 9.1, the obligations of
the Trustee under Section 9.2 shall be unaffected hereby.

SECTION 9.2  APPLICATION OF TRUST FUNDS.

          All money deposited with the Trustee pursuant to Section 9.1 shall be
held in trust and applied by it, in accordance with the provisions of the
Securities and this Indenture, to the payment either directly or through any
Paying Agent (including the Company acting as its own Paying Agent) as the
Trustee may determine, to the Persons entitled thereto, of the principal (and
premium, if any) and any interest for whose payment such money has been
deposited or received by the Trustee, but such money need not be segregated from
other funds except to the extent required by law.


                                   ARTICLE 10

                             SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURES

SECTION 10.1  SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURES WITHOUT CONSENT OF HOLDERS.

          The Company, when authorized by Board Resolution, and the Trustee at
any time and from time to time, may amend this Indenture or enter into one or
more indentures supplemental hereto, to be in a form satisfactory to the Trustee
without notice to or consent of any Securityholder for any of the following
purposes:

          (1) to comply with Section 5.1; or

          (2) to provide for uncertificated Securities in addition to or in
place of certificated Securities; or

          (3) to add to the covenants of the Company, for the benefit of the
Holders of all of the Securities, or to surrender any right or power herein
conferred upon the Company; or

          (4) to add any Events of Default; or

          (5) to cure any ambiguity, to correct or supplement any provision
herein which may be defective or inconsistent with any other provision herein,
or to make any other provisions with respect to matters or questions arising
under this Indenture which shall not be inconsistent with any provision of this
Indenture, provided such other provisions shall not adversely affect the
interests of the Holders of Securities in any material respect.

SECTION 10.2  SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURES WITH CONSENT OF HOLDERS.

          With the written consent of the Holders of not less than a majority in
aggregate principal amount of the Securities at the time outstanding, the
Company, when authorized by Board Resolution, and the Trustee may amend this
Indenture or from time to time and at any time enter into an indenture or
indentures supplemental hereto (which shall conform to the provisions of the TIA
as in force at the date of the execution thereof) for the purpose of adding any
provisions to or changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of
this Indenture or of any supplemental indenture, except as otherwise permitted
by Section 10.1, or of modifying in any manner the rights of the Holders of the
Securities. Subject to Section 10.4, without the consent of each Holder of
Securities, however, an amendment, supplement or waiver, including a waiver
pursuant to Section 6.4, may not:

          (1) extend the fixed maturity of any Securities, or reduce the
principal amount thereof or premium, if any, or reduce the rate or extend the
time of payment of interest thereon, without the consent of the Holder of each
Security;

          (2) reduce the aforesaid percentage of Securities, the consent of the
Holders of which is required for any such supplemental indenture, without the
consent of the Holders of all Securities then outstanding;

          (3) waive (except, unless theretofore cured) a default in the payment
of the principal of (and premium, if any on), interest on or redemption amounts
with respect to any Security; or

          (4) make any Security payable in money other than that stated in the
Security; or

          (5) make any change in Sections 6.4 or 6.6 or in this sentence of
Section 10.2.

          Upon the written request of the Company, accompanied by a copy of a
Board Resolution certified by the Secretary or an Assistant Secretary of the
Company authorizing the execution of any such supplemental indenture, and upon
the filing with the Trustee of evidence of the consent of Securityholders as
aforesaid, the Trustee shall join with the Company in the execution of such
supplemental indenture unless the Trustee, in its reasonable discretion,
determines that such supplemental indenture affects the Trustee's own rights,
duties or immunities under this Indenture or otherwise, in which case the
Trustee may in its reasonable discretion, but shall not be obligated to, enter
into such supplemental indenture.

          It shall not be necessary for the consent of the Securityholders under
this Section to approve the particular form of any proposed amendment,
supplement or waiver, but it shall be sufficient if such consent shall approve
the substance thereof.

          Promptly after the execution by the Company and the Trustee of any
supplemental indenture pursuant to the provisions of this Section, the Company
shall mail a notice, setting forth in general terms the substance of such
supplemental indenture, to all Holders of Securities as the names and addresses
of such Holders shall appear on the registry books. Any failure of the Company
to mail such notice, or any defect therein, shall not, however, in any way
impair or affect the validity of any such supplemental indenture.

SECTION 10.3  COMPLIANCE WITH TRUST INDENTURE ACT.

          Every amendment or supplement to this Indenture or the Securities
shall comply with the TIA as then in effect.

SECTION 10.4  REVOCATION AND EFFECT OF CONSENTS.

          Subject to this Indenture, each amendment, supplement or waiver
evidencing other action shall become effective in accordance with its terms.
Until an amendment, supplement or waiver becomes effective, a consent to it by a
Holder of a Security is a continuing consent by the Holder even if notation of
the consent is not made on any Security. Any such Holder or subsequent Holder,
however, may revoke the consent as to his Security or portion of a Security, if
the Trustee receives the written notice of revocation before the date the
amendment, waiver or other action becomes effective.

          The Company may, but shall not be obligated to, fix a record date for
the purpose of determining the Holders entitled to consent to any amendment,
supplement or waiver. If a record date is fixed, then notwithstanding the
provisions of the immediately preceding paragraph, those Persons who were
Holders on such record date (or their duly designated proxies) and only those
Persons, shall be entitled to consent to such amendment, supplement or waiver or
to revoke any consent previously given, whether or not such Persons continue to
be Holders after such record date. No consent shall be valid or effective for
more than 90 days after such record date unless consent from Holders of the
principal amount of Securities then outstanding required hereunder for such
amendment, supplement or waiver to be effective shall have also been given and
not revoked within such 90-day period.

          After an amendment, supplement or waiver becomes effective, it shall
bind every Securityholder.

SECTION 10.5  NOTATION ON OR EXCHANGE OF SECURITIES.

          If an amendment, supplement or waiver changes the terms of a Security,
the Trustee may request the Holder of the Security to deliver it to the Trustee.
The Trustee may place an appropriate notation on the Security about the changed
terms and return it to the Holder. Alternatively, if the Company or the Trustee
so determines, the Company in exchange for the Security shall issue and the
Trustee shall authenticate a new Security that reflects the changed terms, the
cost and expense of which will be borne by the Company.

SECTION 10.6  EFFECT OF SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURES.

          Upon the execution of any supplemental indenture under this Article,
this Indenture shall be modified in accordance therewith, and such supplemental
indenture shall form a part of this Indenture for all purposes; and every Holder
of Securities shall be bound thereby.


                                   ARTICLE 11

                                  MISCELLANEOUS

SECTION 11.1  TRUST INDENTURE ACT CONTROLS.

          If any provision of this Indenture limits, qualifies or conflicts with
another provision which is required to be included in this Indenture by the TIA,
the required provisions shall control.

SECTION 11.2  NOTICES.

          Any notices or other communications required or permitted hereunder
shall be in writing, and shall be sufficiently given if made by hand delivery,
or first class mail, postage prepaid (except that any notice by the Trustee to
the Company of a default or an Event of Default under this Indenture shall be by
registered or certified mail, postage prepaid, return receipt requested), or by
a nationally-recognized overnight express courier service (which notices or
communications shall be deemed received the Business Day after the receipt
thereof by such service), addressed as follows:

                  if to the Company:

                  Interpool, Inc.
                  211 College Road East
                  Princeton, New Jersey  08540
                  Attention:  Chief Financial Officer

                  if to the Trustee:

                  United States Trust Company of New York
                  114 West 47th Street
                  New York, New York  10036
                  Attention:  Corporate Trust Division

The Company or the Trustee by notice to the other may designate additional or
different addresses as shall be furnished in writing by either party. Any notice
or communication to the Company or the Trustee shall be deemed to have been
given or made as of the date so delivered if personally delivered, and five (5)
calendar days after mailing if sent by registered or certified mail (except that
a notice of change of address shall not be deemed to have been given until
actually received by the addressee).

          Any notice or communication mailed to a Securityholder shall be mailed
to the address of such Securityholder as it appears on the registration books of
the Registrar and shall be sufficiently given if so mailed within the time
prescribed.

          Failure to mail a notice or communication to a Securityholder or any
defect in it shall not affect its sufficiency with respect to other
Securityholders. If a notice or communication is mailed in the manner provided
above, it is duly given, whether or not the addressee receives it.

          In case by reason of the suspension of regular mail service, or by
reason of any other cause, it shall be impossible to mail any notice, as
required by this Indenture, then such method of notification as shall be made
with the approval of the Trustee shall constitute a sufficient mailing of such
notice.

          If the Company mails any notice or communication to Securityholders,
it shall mail a copy to the Trustee and all Agents at the same time.

SECTION 11.3  COMMUNICATIONS BY HOLDERS WITH OTHER HOLDERS.

          Securityholders may communicate pursuant to TIA Section 312(b) with
other Securityholders with respect to their rights under this Indenture or the
Securities. The Company, the Trustee, the Registrar and anyone else shall have
the protection of TIA Section 312(c).

SECTION 11.4  CERTIFICATE AND OPINION AS TO CONDITIONS PRECEDENT. 

          Upon any request or application by the Company to the Trustee to take
any action under this Indenture, the Company shall furnish to the Trustee:

          (1) an Officers' Certificate (which shall include the statements set
forth in Section 11.5) stating that, in the opinion of the signers, all
conditions precedent, if any, provided for in this Indenture relating to the
proposed action have been complied with; and

          (2) an Opinion of Counsel (which shall include the statements set
forth in Section 11.5) stating that, in the opinion of such counsel, all such
conditions precedent have been complied with.

SECTION 11.5  STATEMENTS REQUIRED IN CERTIFICATE AND OPINION.

          Each Certificate and Opinion with respect to compliance with a
condition or covenant provided for in this Indenture shall include:

          (1) a statement that the Person making such certificate or opinion has
read such covenant or condition;

          (2) a brief statement as to the nature and scope of the examination or
investigation upon which the statements or opinions contained in such
certificate or opinion are based;

          (3) a statement that in the opinion of such Person, he has made such
examination or investigation as is necessary to enable him to express an
informed opinion as to whether or not such covenant or condition has been
complied with; and

          (4) a statement as to whether or not, in the opinion of such Person,
such covenant or condition has been complied with.

SECTION 11.6  RULES BY TRUSTEE AND AGENTS.

          The Trustee may make reasonable rules for action by or at a meeting of
Securityholders. The Registrar or Paying Agent may make reasonable rules for its
functions.

SECTION 11.7  RECORD DATE.

          Whenever the Company or the Trustee solicits an act of
Securityholders, the Company or the Trustee may fix in advance of the
solicitation of such act a date as the record date for determining
Securityholders entitled to perform said act. The record date shall be not more
than 15 days prior to the date fixed for the solicitation of said act.

SECTION 11.8  BUSINESS DAYS.

          If a payment date is not a Business Day, payment may be made on the
next succeeding day that is a Business Day, and no interest shall accrue for the
intervening period.

SECTION 11.9  GOVERNING LAW.

          The laws of the State of New York shall govern this Indenture and the
Securities without regard to principles of conflicts of law.

SECTION 11.10 NO ADVERSE INTERPRETATION OF OTHER AGREEMENTS.

          This Indenture may not be used to interpret another indenture, loan or
debt agreement of the Company or a Subsidiary thereof. Any such indenture, loan
or debt agreement may not be used to interpret this Indenture.

SECTION 11.11 NO RECOURSE AGAINST OTHERS.

          No shareholder, director or officer, as such, past, present or future,
of the Company or of any successor corporation or trust shall have any liability
for any obligation of the Company under the Securities or the Indenture or for
any claim based on, in respect of or by reason of, such obligations or their
creation. Each Holder of a Security by accepting a Security waives and releases
all such liability. The waiver and release are part of the consideration for the
issuance of the Securities.

SECTION 11.12 SUCCESSORS.

          All agreements of the Company in this Indenture and the Securities
shall bind its successor. All agreements of the Trustee in this Indenture shall
bind its successor.

SECTION 11.13 MULTIPLE COUNTERPARTS.

          The parties may sign multiple counterparts of this Indenture. Each
signed counterpart shall be deemed an original, but all of them together
represent the same agreement.

SECTION 11.14 TABLE OF CONTENTS, HEADINGS, ETC.

          The table of contents, cross-reference sheet and headings of the
Articles and Sections of this Indenture have been inserted for convenience of
reference only, are not to be considered a part hereof, and shall in no way
modify or restrict any of the terms or provisions hereof.

SECTION 11.15 SEVERABILITY.

          In case any provision in this Indenture or in the Securities shall be
invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity, legality and enforceability of
the remaining provisions shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby,
and a Holder shall have no claim therefor against any party hereto.

<PAGE>

          IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Indenture to
be duly executed, all as of the date first written above.


                                  INTERPOOL, INC.


                                  By:/S/  MARTIN TUCHMAN
                                     ---------------------------------
                                     Name:  Martin Tuchman
                                     Title: Chairman and CEO


                                  UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY OF NEW YORK
                                  as Trustee


                                  By:/S/  JAMES NESCI
                                     ---------------------------------
                                     Name:  James Nesci
                                     Title: Authorized Officer

<PAGE>

                                    EXHIBIT A

                       (FORM OF FACE OF ORIGINAL SECURITY)

          [IF THE SECURITY IS A GLOBAL SECURITY, INSERT: THIS SECURITY IS A
GLOBAL SECURITY WITHIN THE MEANING OF THE INDENTURE HEREINAFTER REFERRED TO AND
IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF A DEPOSITARY OR A NOMINEE OF A DEPOSITARY. THIS
SECURITY IS EXCHANGEABLE FOR SECURITIES REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF A PERSON OTHER
THAN THE DEPOSITARY OR ITS NOMINEE ONLY IN THE LIMITED CIRCUMSTANCES DESCRIBED
IN THE INDENTURE, AND NO TRANSFER OF THIS SECURITY (OTHER THAN A TRANSFER OF
THIS SECURITY AS A WHOLE BY THE DEPOSITARY TO A NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY OR BY
A NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY TO THE DEPOSITARY OR ANOTHER NOMINEE OF THE
DEPOSITARY) MAY BE REGISTERED EXCEPT IN LIMITED CIRCUMSTANCES.

          UNLESS THIS SECURITY IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF
THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY, A NEW YORK CORPORATION ("DTC") TO THE ISSUER OR
ITS AGENT FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER, EXCHANGE OR PAYMENT, AND ANY SECURITY
ISSUED IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR IN SUCH OTHER NAME AS
REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC (AND ANY PAYMENT HEREON IS MADE
TO CEDE & CO. OR TO SUCH OTHER ENTITY AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED
REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC), ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR
OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY PERSON IS WRONGFUL IN AS MUCH AS SINCE THE REGISTERED
OWNER HEREOF, CEDE & CO., HAS AN INTEREST HEREIN.]

          THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED HEREBY HAVE NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE
SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE "SECURITIES ACT"), OR ANY STATE
SECURITIES LAWS OR ANY OTHER APPLICABLE SECURITIES LAW. NEITHER THIS SECURITY
NOR ANY INTEREST OR PARTICIPATION HEREIN MAY BE REOFFERED, SOLD, ASSIGNED,
TRANSFERRED, PLEDGED, ENCUMBERED OR OTHERWISE DISPOSED OF IN THE ABSENCE OF SUCH
REGISTRATION OR UNLESS SUCH TRANSACTION IS EXEMPT FROM, OR NOT SUBJECT TO,
REGISTRATION.

          THE HOLDER OF THIS SECURITY BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF AGREES TO OFFER,
SELL OR OTHERWISE TRANSFER THIS SECURITY, PRIOR TO THE DATE (THE "RESALE
RESTRICTION TERMINATION DATE") WHICH IS TWO YEARS AFTER THE LATER OF THE
ORIGINAL ISSUANCE DATE HEREOF AND THE LAST DATE ON WHICH THE COMPANY OR ANY
"AFFILIATE" OF THE COMPANY WAS THE OWNER OF THIS SECURITY (OR ANY PREDECESSOR OF
THIS SECURITY) ONLY (A) TO THE COMPANY, (B) PURSUANT TO A REGISTRATION STATEMENT
WHICH HAS BEEN DECLARED EFFECTIVE UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, (C) SO LONG AS THIS
SECURITY IS ELIGIBLE FOR RESALE PURSUANT TO RULE 144A UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT
("RULE 144A"), TO A PERSON IT REASONABLY BELIEVES IS A "QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL
BUYER" (AS DEFINED IN RULE 144A) THAT PURCHASES FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT OR FOR THE
ACCOUNT OF A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER TO WHOM NOTICE IS GIVEN THAT THE
TRANSFER IS BEING MADE IN RELIANCE ON RULE 144A, (D) PURSUANT TO OFFERS AND
SALES TO NON-U.S. PERSONS THAT OCCUR OUTSIDE THE UNITED STATES WITHIN THE
MEANING OF REGULATION S UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, (E) IN A MINIMUM PRINCIPAL
AMOUNT OF $100,000 TO AN INSTITUTIONAL "ACCREDITED INVESTOR" WITHIN THE MEANING
OF SUBPARAGRAPH (A)(1), (2), (3) OR (7) OF RULE 501 UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT
THAT IS ACQUIRING THIS SECURITY FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT, OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF SUCH
AN INSTITUTIONAL ACCREDITED INVESTOR, FOR INVESTMENT PURPOSES AND NOT WITH A
VIEW TO, OR FOR OFFER OR SALE IN CONNECTION WITH, ANY DISTRIBUTION IN VIOLATION
OF THE SECURITIES ACT, OR (F) PURSUANT TO ANY OTHER AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM THE
REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, SUBJECT TO THE RIGHT OF THE
COMPANY PRIOR TO ANY SUCH OFFER, SALE OR TRANSFER (i) PURSUANT TO CLAUSE (D),
(E) OR (F) TO REQUIRE THE DELIVERY OF AN OPINION OF COUNSEL, CERTIFICATIONS
AND/OR OTHER INFORMATION SATISFACTORY TO THE COMPANY, AND (ii) PURSUANT TO
CLAUSE (E), TO REQUIRE THAT THE TRANSFEROR DELIVER TO THE COMPANY A LETTER FROM
THE TRANSFEREE SUBSTANTIALLY IN THE FORM OF ANNEX A TO THE OFFERING MEMORANDUM
DATED FEBRUARY 19, 1998. SUCH HOLDER FURTHER AGREES THAT IT WILL DELIVER TO EACH
PERSON TO WHOM THIS SECURITY IS TRANSFERRED A NOTICE SUBSTANTIALLY TO THE EFFECT
OF THIS LEGEND.

<PAGE>

                                 INTERPOOL, INC.
                              6-5/8% Notes due 2003

CUSIP No. _________                                             $__________
No. __

          Interpool, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company", which term
includes any successor Person under the Indenture hereinafter referred to), for
value received, hereby promises to pay to _____________ or registered assigns,
the principal sum of $___________ on March 1, 2003 (the "Maturity Date"), and to
pay interest on the outstanding principal amount hereof from February 24, 1998,
or from the most recent interest payment date (each such date, an "Interest
Payment Date") to which interest has been paid or duly provided for,
semi-annually (subject to deferral as set forth herein) in arrears on March 1
and September 1 of each year, commencing September 1, 1998 at the rate of 6-5/8%
per annum until the principal hereof shall have become due and payable, and at
the same rate per annum on any overdue principal and (without duplication and to
the extent that payment of such interest is enforceable under applicable law) on
any overdue installment of interest at the same rate per annum compounded
semi-annually. The amount of interest payable on any Interest Payment Date shall
be computed on the basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30day months and, for any
period less than a full calendar month, the number of days elapsed in such
month. In the event that any date on which the principal of or interest on this
Security is payable is not a Business Day, then the payment payable on such date
will be made on the next succeeding day that is a Business Day (and without any
interest or other payment in respect of any such delay), with the same force and
effect as if made on such date. Pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement,
in certain limited circumstances the Company will be required to pay Liquidated
Damages (as defined in the Registration Rights Agreement) with respect to this
Security.

          The interest installment so payable, and punctually paid or duly
provided for, on any Interest Payment Date will, as provided in the Indenture,
be paid to the person in whose name this Security (or one or more Predecessor
Securities, as defined in said Indenture) is registered at the close of business
on the regular record date for such interest installment, which shall be the
February 15 or August 15 immediately preceding the relevant interest payment
date. Any such interest installment not punctually paid or duly provided for
shall forthwith cease to be payable to the holders on such regular record date
and may be paid to the Person in whose name this Security (or one or more
Predecessor Securities) is registered at the close of business on a special
record date to be fixed by the Trustee for the payment of such defaulted
interest, notice whereof shall be given to the holders of Securities not less
than 10 days prior to such special record date, or may be paid at any time in
any other lawful manner not inconsistent with the requirements of any securities
exchange on which the Securities may be listed, and upon such notice as may be
required by such exchange, all as more fully provided in the Indenture.

          The principal of and interest on this Security shall be payable at the
office or agency of the Company maintained for that purpose in any coin or
currency of the United States of America that at the time of payment is legal
tender for payment of public and private debts; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that, payment
of interest may be made at the option of the Company by (i) check mailed to the
holder at such address as shall appear in the Security Register or (ii) by
transfer to an account maintained by the Person entitled thereto, provided that
proper written transfer instructions have been received by the relevant record
date.

          This Security shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Indenture
hereinafter referred to, or be valid or become obligatory for any purpose until
the Certificate of Authentication hereon shall have been signed by or on behalf
of the Trustee.

          The provisions of this Security are continued on the reverse side
hereof and such provisions shall for all purposes have the same effect as though
fully set forth at this place.

<PAGE>

         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Company has caused this instrument to be
executed.


                                           Interpool, Inc.


                                           By: ______________________
                                               Name:
                                               Title:



Attest:

By: ______________________
    Name:
    Title:

<PAGE>

                     (FORM OF CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION)

                          CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION

          This is one of the Securities referred to in the within-mentioned
Indenture.

Dated _________________________


UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY OF NEW YORK
as Trustee


By: ______________________
    Authorized Officer

<PAGE>

                          (FORM OF REVERSE OF SECURITY)


                                 INTERPOOL, INC.
                              6-5/8% Notes due 2003

          1. INTEREST. Interpool, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company"),
promises to pay interest on the principal amount of this Security at the rate
per annum shown above. The Company will pay interest semiannually on March 1 and
September 1 of each year, beginning September 1, 1998. Interest on the
Securities will accrue from the most recent date to which interest has been paid
or, if no interest has been paid, from the date of initial issuance of the
Securities; provided, that, if there is no existing Default in the payment of
interest, and if this Security is authenticated between a record date referred
to on the face hereof and the next succeeding interest payment date, interest
shall accrue from such interest payment date. Interest will be computed on the
basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months.

          Pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement, in certain limited
circumstances the Company will be required to pay Liquidated Damages (as defined
in the Registration Rights Agreement) with respect to this Security.

          2. METHOD OF PAYMENT. The Company will pay interest on the Securities
(except defaulted interest) to the Persons who are the registered Holders of the
Securities at the close of business on the February 15 or August 15 next
preceding the interest payment date. The Company will pay principal, premium, if
any, and interest in money of the United States that at the time of payment is
legal tender for payment of public and private debts. The Company, however, may
pay principal, premium, if any, and interest by its check payable in such money.

          The principal of and interest on this Security shall be payable at the
office or agency of the Company maintained for that purpose; PROVIDED, HOWEVER,
that, payment of interest may be made at the option of the Company by (i) check
mailed to the holder at such address as shall appear in the Security Register or
(ii) by transfer to an account maintained by the Person entitled thereto,
provided that proper written transfer instructions have been received by the
relevant record date.

          The foregoing notwithstanding, principal of and premium, if any, and
interest on Securities which are represented by Global Securities held of record
by the Depositary will be payable in same-day funds.

          3. REGISTRAR AND AGENTS. Initially, United States Trust Company of New
York will act as Registrar, Paying Agent and agent for service of notices and
demands. The Company or any of its subsidiaries may act as Paying Agent. The
address of United States Trust Company of New York is 114 West 47th Street, New
York, New York 10036, Attention: Corporate Trust and Agency Division.

          4. INDENTURE; LIMITATIONS. The Company issued the Securities under an
Indenture dated as of February 24, 1998 (the "Indenture"), between the Company
and United States Trust Company of New York, as trustee (in such capacity, the
"Trustee"). Capitalized terms herein are used as defined in the Indenture unless
otherwise defined herein. The terms of the Securities include those stated in
the Indenture and those made part of the Indenture by reference to the Trust
Indenture Act of 1939 (15 U.S. Code 77aaa-77bbbb) as in effect on the date of
the Indenture. The Securities are subject to all such terms, and the Holders of
the Securities are referred to the Indenture and said Act for a statement of
them.

          The Securities are general unsecured obligations of the Company
limited to $100,000,000 aggregate principal amount. The Indenture imposes
certain limitations on the ability of the Company to, among other things, incur
liens, make payments in respect of its Capital Stock, merge or consolidate with
any other Person and sell, lease, transfer or otherwise dispose of its
properties or assets.

          5. OPTIONAL REDEMPTION BY THE COMPANY. The Company may redeem the
Securities, at any time, in whole or from time to time in part, at the election
of the Company, at a Redemption Price equal to the sum of (i) the principal
amount of the Securities being redeemed plus accrued interest thereon to the
Redemption Date and (ii) the Make-Whole Amount, if any, with respect to such
Securities. "Make-Whole Amount" means, in connection with any optional
redemption of any Security, the excess, if any of (i) the aggregate present
value as of the date of such redemption of each dollar of principal being
redeemed and the amount of interest (exclusive of any interest accrued to the
date of redemption) that would have been payable in respect of such dollar if
such redemption had not been made, determined by discounting, on a semi-annual
basis, such principal and interest at the Reinvestment Rate (as defined in the
Indenture) (which rate shall be determined as of the third Business Day
preceding the date such notice of redemption is given) from the respective dates
on which such principal and interest would have been payable if such redemption
had not been made, over (ii) the aggregate principal amount of the Securities
being redeemed.

          6. NOTICE OF REDEMPTION. Notice of redemption will be mailed at least
30 days but not more than 60 days before the Redemption Date to each Holder of
Securities to be redeemed at his registered address. Securities in denominations
larger than $1,000 principal amount may be redeemed in part, but only in whole
multiples thereof. On and after the Redemption Date interest will cease to
accrue on Securities or portions thereof called for redemption.

          7. DENOMINATIONS, TRANSFER, EXCHANGE. This Security is one of a duly
authorized issue of Securities of the Company designated as its 6-5/8% Notes due
2003, limited in aggregate principal amount to $100,000,000. The Securities are
issuable in registered form without coupons in denominations of $1,000 principal
amount and integral multiples thereof. A Holder may register the transfer of or
exchange Securities in accordance with the Indenture and subject to the transfer
restrictions as may be contained herein and therein from time to time. The
Registrar may require a Holder, among other things, to furnish appropriate
endorsements and transfer documents and to pay any taxes and fees required by
law or permitted by the Indenture. The Registrar need not register the transfer
of or exchange any Securities selected for redemption or register the transfer
of or exchange any Securities for a period of 15 days before a selection of
Securities to be redeemed.

          8. PERSONS DEEMED OWNERS. The registered Holder of a Security may be
treated as its owner for all purposes.

          9. UNCLAIMED MONEY. If money for the payment of principal, premium, if
any, or interest on any Securities remains unclaimed for two years, the Trustee
and the Paying Agent will pay the money back to the Company at its written
request. After that, Holders may look only to the Company for payment.

          10. DISCHARGE PRIOR TO REDEMPTION OR MATURITY. Except as set forth in
the Indenture, if the Company irrevocably deposits with the Trustee, in trust,
for the benefit of the Holders, cash, U.S. Government Obligations or a
combination thereof, in such amounts as will be sufficient in the opinion of a
nationally recognized firm of independent public accountants, to pay the
principal of, premium, if any and interest on the Securities to redemption or
maturity and comply with the other provisions of the Indenture relating thereto,
the Company will be discharged from certain provisions of the Indenture and the
Securities (including the restrictive covenants described in paragraph 4 above,
but excluding its obligation to pay the principal of and interest on the
Securities).

          11. AMENDMENT AND WAIVER. Subject to certain exceptions, without
notice to the Holders of the Securities, the Indenture or the Securities may be
amended with the consent of the Holders of at least a majority in principal
amount of the Securities then outstanding and any existing default or compliance
with any provision may be waived with the consent of the Holders of a majority
in principal amount of the Securities then outstanding. Without the consent of
or notice to any Holder of Securities, the Company may amend the Indenture or
the Securities to, among other things, cure any ambiguity, defect or
inconsistency or make any other change that does not adversely affect the rights
of any Securityholder.

          12. SUCCESSORS. When a successor assumes all the obligations of its
predecessor under the Securities and the Indenture, the predecessor will be
released from those obligations.

          13. DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES. If an Event of Default, as defined in the
Indenture, occurs and is continuing, the Trustee or the Holders of a majority in
principal amount of Securities may declare all the Securities to be due and
payable immediately in the manner and with the effect provided in the Indenture.
Holders of Securities may not enforce the Indenture or the Securities except as
provided in the Indenture. The Trustee may require indemnity satisfactory to it,
subject to the provisions of the TIA, before it enforces the Indenture or the
Securities. Subject to certain limitations, Holders of a majority in principal
amount of the Securities then outstanding may direct the Trustee in writing in
its exercise of any trust or power with respect to the Securities. The Company
is required to file periodic reports with the Trustee as to the absence of any
Default or Event of Default.

          14. TRUSTEE DEALINGS WITH THE COMPANY. United States Trust Company of
New York, the Trustee under the Indenture, in its individual or any other
capacity, may make loans to, accept deposits from, and perform services for the
Company or its Affiliates, and may otherwise deal with the Company or its
Affiliates, as if it were not Trustee.

          15. NO RECOURSE AGAINST OTHERS. No stockholder, director, officer or
incorporator, as such, past, present or future, of the Company or any successor
corporation or trust shall have any liability for any obligation of the Company
under the Securities or the Indenture or for any claim based on, in respect of
or by reason of, such obligations or their creation. Each Holder of a Security
by accepting a Security waives and releases all such liability. This waiver and
release are part of the consideration for the issuance of the Securities.

          16. AUTHENTICATION. This Security shall not be valid until the Trustee
or any authenticating agent appointed by the Trustee signs the certificate of
authentication on the other side of this Security.

          17. REGISTRATION RIGHTS. Pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement
between the Company and the Initial Purchaser for itself and on behalf of the
Holders of the Original Securities, the Company will be obligated to consummate
an exchange offer pursuant to which the Holder of this Security shall have the
right to exchange this Security for the Company's 6-5/8% Notes due 2003, which
will have been registered under the Securities Act, in like principal amount and
having terms identical in all material respects as the Original Securities. The
Holders of the Original Securities shall be entitled to receive certain
liquidated damages in the event such exchange offer is not consummated and upon
certain other conditions, all pursuant to and in accordance with the terms of
the Registration Rights Agreement.

          18. ABBREVIATIONS. Customary abbreviations may be used in the name of
a Securityholder or an assignee, such as: TEN COM (= tenants in common), TEN ENT
(= tenants by the entireties), JT TEN (= joint tenants with rights of
survivorship and not as tenants in common), CUST (= Custodian), AND U/G/M/A (=
Uniform Gifts to Minors Act).

          THE COMPANY WILL FURNISH TO ANY SECURITYHOLDER UPON WRITTEN REQUEST
AND WITHOUT CHARGE A COPY OF THE INDENTURE. REQUESTS MAY BE MADE TO: INTERPOOL,
INC., 211 COLLEGE ROAD EAST, PRINCETON, NEW JERSEY 08540, ATTENTION: INVESTOR
RELATIONS.

<PAGE>

                                 ASSIGNMENT FORM

If you the holder want to assign this Security, fill in the form below and have
your signature guaranteed:


I or we assign and transfer this Security to

- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

(Insert assignee's social security or tax ID number)---------------------------

- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

(Print or type assignee's name, address and zip code) and

irrevocably appoint

- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

agent to transfer this Security on the books of the Company. The agent may
substitute another to act for such agent.


Date: --------------------------      Your signature:  ------------------------
                                                       (Sign exactly as your
                                                       name appears on the
                                                       other side of this
                                                       Security)


                                                  By:  ------------------------
                                                       NOTICE:  To be executed
                                                       by an executive officer


NOTICE: Signature(s) must be guaranteed by an institution which is a participant
in the Securities Transfer Agent Medallion Program ("STAMP") or similar program.

<PAGE>

        SCHEDULE OF EXCHANGES OF DEFINITIVE SECURITIES1

          The following exchanges of a part of this Global Security for
Definitive Securities have been made:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
<S>                 <C>                     <C>                   <C>                     <C>    
                 Amount of               Amount of             Principal              Signature of
                 decrease in             increase in           Amount of this         authorized
                 Principal               Principal             Global Security        officer of
                 Amount of               Amount of             following such         Trustee or
Date of          this Global             this Global           decrease (or           Securities
Exchange         Security                Security              increase               Custodian
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------




<FN>
1   This schedule should only be added if the Security is issued in global form.
</FN>
</TABLE>

<PAGE>

CERTIFICATE TO BE DELIVERED UPON EXCHANGE OR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER OF
SECURITIES

Re: 6-5/8% NOTES DUE 2003 OF INTERPOOL, INC.

     This Certificate relates to $______ principal amount of Securities held in
(check applicable box) _____ book-entry or ______ definitive form by _____ (the
"Transferor").

The Transferor (check applicable box):

     ___ has requested the Registrar by written order to deliver in exchange for
its beneficial interest in the Global Security held by the Depositary a Security
or Securities in definitive, registered form of authorized denominations and an
aggregate principal amount equal to its beneficial interest in such Global
Security (or the portion thereof indicated above); or

     ___ has requested the Registrar by written order to exchange or register
the transfer of a Security or Securities.

     In connection with such request and in respect of each such Security, the
Transferor does hereby certify that Transferor is familiar with the Indenture
relating to the above-captioned Securities and as provided in Section 2.9 of
such Indenture, the transfer of this Security does not require registration
under the Securities Act (as defined below) because (check applicable box):

     ___ Such Security is being acquired for the Transferor's own account,
without transfer (in satisfaction of Section 2.9(c)(2)(A) or Section
2.9(f)(1)(A) of the Indenture).

     ___ Such Security is being transferred to a "qualified institutional buyer"
(as defined in Rule 144A under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the
"Securities Act")) in reliance on Rule 144A (in satisfaction of Section
2.9(c)(2)(B) or Section 2.9(f)(1)(B) of the Indenture) or pursuant to an
effective registration statement under the Securities Act (in satisfaction of
Section 2.9(c)(2)(C) or Section 2.9(f)(1)(C) of the Indenture).

     ___ Such Security is being transferred in accordance with Rule 144 under
the Securities Act, or pursuant to an exemption from registration in accordance
with Regulation S under the Securities Act or to an institutional "accredited
investor" within the meaning of Rule 501(A)(1), (2), (3) or (7) under the
Securities Act that is acquiring the Security for its own account, or for the
account of such an institutional accredited investor, in each case in a minimum
principal amount of $100,000, not with a view to or for distribution in
violation of the Securities Act (in satisfaction of Section 2.9(c)(2)(C) or
Section 2.9(f)(1)(C) of the Indenture).

     ___ Such Security is being transferred in reliance on and in compliance
with an exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act,
other than Rule 144A, in accordance with Rule 144 under the Securities Act, or
to an institutional "accredited investor" within the meaning of Rule 501(A)(1),
(2), (3) or (7) under the Securities Act that is acquiring the Security for its
own account, or for the account of such an institutional accredited investor, in
each case in a minimum principal amount of $100,000, not with a view to or for
distribution in violation of the Securities Act, and an Opinion of Counsel to
the effect that such transfer does not require registration under the Securities
Act accompanies this Certificate (in satisfaction of Section 2.9(c)(2)(C) or
Section 2.9(f)(1)(C) of the Indenture).



                                          -------------------------------------
                                          [INSERT NAME OF TRANSFEROR]


                                          By:  --------------------------------



Date:  -------------------------

<PAGE>

                                    EXHIBIT B

                      (FORM OF FACE OF EXCHANGE SECURITY)1

     [IF THE SECURITY IS A GLOBAL SECURITY, INSERT: THIS SECURITY IS A GLOBAL
SECURITY WITHIN THE MEANING OF THE INDENTURE HEREINAFTER REFERRED TO AND IS
REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF A DEPOSITARY OR A NOMINEE OF A DEPOSITARY. THIS
SECURITY IS EXCHANGEABLE FOR SECURITIES REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF A PERSON OTHER
THAN THE DEPOSITARY OR ITS NOMINEE ONLY IN THE LIMITED CIRCUMSTANCES DESCRIBED
IN THE INDENTURE, AND NO TRANSFER OF THIS SECURITY (OTHER THAN A TRANSFER OF
THIS SECURITY AS A WHOLE BY THE DEPOSITARY TO A NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY OR BY
A NOMINEE OF THE DEPOSITARY TO THE DEPOSITARY OR ANOTHER NOMINEE OF THE
DEPOSITARY) MAY BE REGISTERED EXCEPT IN LIMITED CIRCUMSTANCES.

     UNLESS THIS SECURITY IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF THE
DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY, A NEW YORK CORPORATION ("DTC") TO THE ISSUER OR ITS
AGENT FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER, EXCHANGE OR PAYMENT, AND ANY SECURITY ISSUED
IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR IN SUCH OTHER NAME AS REQUESTED BY AN
AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC (AND ANY PAYMENT HEREON IS MADE TO CEDE & CO.
OR TO SUCH OTHER ENTITY AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC),
ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY
PERSON IS WRONGFUL IN AS MUCH AS SINCE THE REGISTERED OWNER HEREOF, CEDE & CO.,
HAS AN INTEREST HEREIN.]

- ----------------------
1   Except as provided in Section 2.4(b) of the Indenture.


<PAGE>

                                 INTERPOOL, INC.
                              6-5/8% Notes due 2003

CUSIP No. _________                                                $__________
No. __

     Interpool, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company", which term includes
any successor Person under the Indenture hereinafter referred to), for value
received, hereby promises to pay to ____________, or registered assigns, the
principal sum of (__________) on March 1, 2003 (the "Maturity Date"), and to pay
interest on the outstanding principal amount hereof from February 24, 1998, or
from the most recent interest payment date (each such date, an "Interest Payment
Date") to which interest has been paid or duly provided for, semi-annually
(subject to deferral as set forth herein) in arrears on March 1 and September 1
of each year, commencing September 1, 1998 at the rate of 6-5/8% per annum until
the principal hereof shall have become due and payable, and at the same rate per
annum on any overdue principal and (without duplication and to the extent that
payment of such interest is enforceable under applicable law) on any overdue
installment of interest at the same rate per annum compounded semi-annually. The
amount of interest payable on any Interest Payment Date shall be computed on the
basis of a 360day year of twelve 30day months and, for any period less than a
full calendar month, the number of days elapsed in such month. In the event that
any date on which the principal of or interest on this Security is payable is
not a Business Day, then the payment payable on such date will be made on the
next succeeding day that is a Business Day (and without any interest or other
payment in respect of any such delay), with the same force and effect as if made
on such date.

     The interest installment so payable, and punctually paid or duly provided
for, on any Interest Payment Date will, as provided in the Indenture, be paid to
the person in whose name this Security (or one or more Predecessor Securities,
as defined in said Indenture) is registered at the close of business on the
regular record date for such interest installment, which shall be the February
15 or August 15 immediately preceding the relevant interest payment date. Any
such interest installment not punctually paid or duly provided for shall
forthwith cease to be payable to the holders on such regular record date and may
be paid to the Person in whose name this Security (or one or more Predecessor
Securities) is registered at the close of business on a special record date to
be fixed by the Trustee for the payment of such defaulted interest, notice
whereof shall be given to the holders of Securities not less than 10 days prior
to such special record date, or may be paid at any time in any other lawful
manner not inconsistent with the requirements of any securities exchange on
which the Securities may be listed, and upon such notice as may be required by
such exchange, all as more fully provided in the Indenture.

     The principal of and interest on this Security shall be payable at the
office or agency of the Company maintained for that purpose in any coin or
currency of the United States of America that at the time of payment is legal
tender for payment of public and private debts; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that, payment
of interest may be made at the option of the Company by (i) check mailed to the
holder at such address as shall appear in the Security Register or (ii) by
transfer to an account maintained by the Person entitled thereto, provided that
proper written transfer instructions have been received by the relevant record
date.

     This Security shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Indenture
hereinafter referred to, or be valid or become obligatory for any purpose until
the Certificate of Authentication hereon shall have been signed by or on behalf
of the Trustee.

     The provisions of this Security are continued on the reverse side hereof
and such provisions shall for all purposes have the same effect as though fully
set forth at this place.

<PAGE>

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Company has caused this instrument to be executed.

                                              Interpool, Inc.


                                              By:__________________________
                                                 Name:
                                                 Title:


Attest:

By: ______________________
    Name:
    Title:

<PAGE>

                     (FORM OF CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION)

                          CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION

     This is one of the Securities referred to in the within mentioned
Indenture.

Dated ____________________


UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY OF NEW YORK
as Trustee


By________________________
  Authorized Officer

<PAGE>

                          (FORM OF REVERSE OF SECURITY)


                                 INTERPOOL, INC.
                              6-5/8% Notes due 2003

          1. INTEREST. Interpool, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company"),
promises to pay interest on the principal amount of this Security at the rate
per annum shown above. The Company will pay interest semiannually on March 1 and
September 1 of each year, beginning September 1, 1998. Interest on the
Securities will accrue from the most recent date to which interest has been paid
or, if no interest has been paid, from the date of initial issuance of the
Securities; provided, that, if there is no existing Default in the payment of
interest, and if this Security is authenticated between a record date referred
to on the face hereof and the next succeeding interest payment date, interest
shall accrue from such interest payment date. Interest will be computed on the
basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months.

          2. METHOD OF PAYMENT. The Company will pay interest on the Securities
(except defaulted interest) to the Persons who are the registered Holders of the
Securities at the close of business on the February 15 or August 15 next
preceding the interest payment date. The Company will pay principal, premium, if
any, and interest in money of the United States that at the time of payment is
legal tender for payment of public and private debts. The Company, however, may
pay principal, premium, if any, and interest by its check payable in such money.

          The principal of and interest on this Security shall be payable at the
office or agency of the Company maintained for that purpose; PROVIDED, HOWEVER,
that, payment of interest may be made at the option of the Company by (i) check
mailed to the holder at such address as shall appear in the Security Register or
(ii) by transfer to an account maintained by the Person entitled thereto,
provided that proper written transfer instructions have been received by the
relevant record date.

          The foregoing notwithstanding, principal of and premium, if any, and
interest on Securities which are represented by Global Securities held of record
by the Depositary will be payable in same-day funds.

          3. REGISTRAR AND AGENTS. Initially, United States Trust Company of New
York will act as Registrar, Paying Agent and agent for service of notices and
demands. The Company or any of its subsidiaries may act as Paying Agent. The
address of United States Trust Company of New York is 114 West 47th Street, New
York, New York 10036, Attention: Corporate Trust and Agency Division.

          4. INDENTURE; LIMITATIONS. The Company issued the Securities under an
Indenture dated as of February 24, 1998 (the "Indenture"), between the Company
and United States Trust Company of New York, as trustee (in such capacity, the
"Trustee"). Capitalized terms herein are used as defined in the Indenture unless
otherwise defined herein. The terms of the Securities include those stated in
the Indenture and those made part of the Indenture by reference to the Trust
Indenture Act of 1939 (15 U.S. Code 77aaa-77bbbb) as in effect on the date of
the Indenture. The Securities are subject to all such terms, and the Holders of
the Securities are referred to the Indenture and said Act for a statement of
them.

          The Securities are general unsecured obligations of the Company
limited to $100,000,000 aggregate principal amount. The Indenture imposes
certain limitations on the ability of the Company to, among other things, incur
liens, make payments in respect of its Capital Stock, merge or consolidate with
any other Person and sell, lease, transfer or otherwise dispose of its
properties or assets.

          5. OPTIONAL REDEMPTION BY THE COMPANY. The Company may redeem the
Securities, at any time, in whole or from time to time in part, at the election
of the Company, at a Redemption Price equal to the sum of (i) the principal
amount of the Securities being redeemed plus accrued interest thereon to the
Redemption Date and (ii) the Make-Whole Amount, if any, with respect to such
Securities. "Make-Whole Amount" means, in connection with any optional
redemption of any Security, the excess, if any of (i) the aggregate present
value as of the date of such redemption of each dollar of principal being
redeemed and the amount of interest (exclusive of any interest accrued to the
date of redemption) that would have been payable in respect of such dollar if
such redemption had not been made, determined by discounting, on a semi-annual
basis, such principal and interest at the Reinvestment Rate (as defined in the
Indenture) (which rate shall be determined as of the third Business Day
preceding the date such notice of redemption is given) from the respective dates
on which such principal and interest would have been payable if such redemption
had not been made, over (ii) the aggregate principal amount of the Securities
being redeemed.

          6. NOTICE OF REDEMPTION. Notice of redemption will be mailed at least
30 days but not more than 60 days before the Redemption Date to each Holder of
Securities to be redeemed at his registered address. Securities in denominations
larger than $1,000 principal amount may be redeemed in part, but only in whole
multiples thereof. On and after the Redemption Date interest will cease to
accrue on Securities or portions thereof called for redemption.

          7. DENOMINATIONS, TRANSFER, EXCHANGE. This Security is one of a duly
authorized issue of Securities of the Company designated as its 6-5/8% Notes due
2003, limited in aggregate principal amount to $100,000,000. The Securities are
issuable in registered form without coupons in denominations of $1,000 principal
amount and integral multiples thereof. A Holder may register the transfer of or
exchange Securities in accordance with the Indenture. The Registrar may require
a Holder, among other things, to furnish appropriate endorsements and transfer
documents and to pay any taxes and fees required by law or permitted by the
Indenture. The Registrar need not register the transfer of or exchange any
Securities selected for redemption or register the transfer of or exchange any
Securities for a period of 15 days before a selection of Securities to be
redeemed.

          8. PERSONS DEEMED OWNERS. The registered Holder of a Security may be
treated as its owner for all purposes.

          9. UNCLAIMED MONEY. If money for the payment of principal, premium, if
any, or interest on any Securities remains unclaimed for two years, the Trustee
and the Paying Agent will pay the money back to the Company at its written
request. After that, Holders may look only to the Company for payment.

          10. DISCHARGE PRIOR TO REDEMPTION OR MATURITY. Except as set forth in
the Indenture, if the Company irrevocably deposits with the Trustee, in trust,
for the benefit of the Holders, cash, U.S. Government Obligations or a
combination thereof, in such amounts as will be sufficient in the opinion of a
nationally recognized firm of independent public accountants, to pay the
principal of, premium, if any and interest on the Securities to redemption or
maturity and comply with the other provisions of the Indenture relating thereto,
the Company will be discharged from certain provisions of the Indenture and the
Securities (including the restrictive covenants described in paragraph 4 above,
but excluding its obligation to pay the principal of and interest on the
Securities).

          11. AMENDMENT AND WAIVER. Subject to certain exceptions, without
notice to the Holders of the Securities, the Indenture or the Securities may be
amended with the consent of the Holders of at least a majority in principal
amount of the Securities then outstanding and any existing default or compliance
with any provision may be waived with the consent of the Holders of a majority
in principal amount of the Securities then outstanding. Without the consent of
or notice to any Holder of Securities, the Company may amend the Indenture or
the Securities to, among other things, cure any ambiguity, defect or
inconsistency or make any other change that does not adversely affect the rights
of any Securityholder.

          12. SUCCESSORS. When a successor assumes all the obligations of its
predecessor under the Securities and the Indenture, the predecessor will be
released from those obligations.

          13. DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES. If an Event of Default, as defined in the
Indenture, occurs and is continuing, the Trustee or the Holders of a majority in
principal amount of Securities may declare all the Securities to be due and
payable immediately in the manner and with the effect provided in the Indenture.
Holders of Securities may not enforce the Indenture or the Securities except as
provided in the Indenture. The Trustee may require indemnity satisfactory to it,
subject to the provisions of the TIA, before it enforces the Indenture or the
Securities. Subject to certain limitations, Holders of a majority in principal
amount of the Securities then outstanding may direct the Trustee in writing in
its exercise of any trust or power with respect to the Securities. The Company
is required to file periodic reports with the Trustee as to the absence of any
Default or Event of Default.

          14. TRUSTEE DEALINGS WITH THE COMPANY. United States Trust Company of
New York, the Trustee under the Indenture, in its individual or any other
capacity, may make loans to, accept deposits from, and perform services for the
Company or its Affiliates, and may otherwise deal with the Company or its
Affiliates, as if it were not Trustee.

          15. NO RECOURSE AGAINST OTHERS. No stockholder, director, officer or
incorporator, as such, past, present or future, of the Company or any successor
corporation or trust shall have any liability for any obligation of the Company
under the Securities or the Indenture or for any claim based on, in respect of
or by reason of, such obligations or their creation. Each Holder of a Security
by accepting a Security waives and releases all such liability. This waiver and
release are part of the consideration for the issuance of the Securities.

          16. AUTHENTICATION. This Security shall not be valid until the Trustee
or any authenticating agent appointed by the Trustee signs the certificate of
authentication on the other side of this Security.

          17. ABBREVIATIONS. Customary abbreviations may be used in the name of
a Securityholder or an assignee, such as: TEN COM (= tenants in common), TEN ENT
(= tenants by the entireties), JT TEN (= joint tenants with rights of
survivorship and not as tenants in common), CUST (= Custodian), AND U/G/M/A (=
Uniform Gifts to Minors Act).

          THE COMPANY WILL FURNISH TO ANY SECURITYHOLDER UPON WRITTEN REQUEST
AND WITHOUT CHARGE A COPY OF THE INDENTURE. REQUESTS MAY BE MADE TO: INTERPOOL,
INC., 211 COLLEGE ROAD EAST, PRINCETON, NEW JERSEY 08540, ATTENTION: INVESTOR
RELATIONS.



                                                    Exhibit 4.3
===============================================================================


                          REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT


                             DATED FEBRUARY 24, 1998


                                     BETWEEN


                                 INTERPOOL, INC.


                                       AND


               DONALDSON, LUFKIN & JENRETTE SECURITIES CORPORATION


                                   ----------

                              as Initial Purchaser


===============================================================================

<PAGE>

                               REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT

          THIS REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT (the "AGREEMENT") is made and
entered into as of February 24, 1998, between INTERPOOL, INC., a Delaware
corporation (the "COMPANY"), and DONALDSON, LUFKIN & JENRETTE SECURITIES
CORPORATION (the "INITIAL PURCHASER").

          This Agreement is made pursuant to the Purchase Agreement dated
February 19, 1998 (the "PURCHASE AGREEMENT"), between the Company, as issuer of
the 6-5/8% Notes due 2003 (the "Notes"), and the Initial Purchaser, which
provides for, among other things, the sale by the Company to the Initial
Purchaser of $100,000,000 aggregate principal amount of the Company's Notes. In
order to induce the Initial Purchaser to enter into the Purchase Agreement, the
Company has agreed to provide to the Initial Purchaser and its direct and
indirect transferees the registration rights set forth in this Agreement. The
execution and delivery of this Agreement is a condition to the closing under the
Purchase Agreement.

          In consideration of the foregoing, the parties hereto agree as
follows:

          1. DEFINITIONS. As used in this Agreement, the following capitalized
defined terms shall have the following meanings:

          "ADVICE" shall have the meaning set forth in the last paragraph of
Section 3 hereof.

          "AFFILIATE" shall have the meaning given to that term in Rule 405
under the Securities Act or any successor rule thereunder.

          "APPLICABLE PERIOD" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 3(t)
hereof.

          "BUSINESS DAY" means each day, other than a Saturday or Sunday, which
is not a day on which banking institutions in the City of New York are
authorized or obligated by law or executive order to close.

          "CLOSING TIME" shall mean the Closing Time as defined in the Purchase
Agreement.

          "COMPANY" shall have the meaning set forth in the preamble to this
Agreement and also includes the Company's successors and permitted assigns.

          "DEPOSITARY" shall mean The Depository Trust Company, or any other
depositary appointed by the Company; PROVIDED, however, that such depositary
must have an address in the Borough of Manhattan, in The City of New York.

          "EFFECTIVENESS PERIOD" shall have the meaning set forth in Section
2(b) hereof.

          "EXCHANGE ACT" shall mean the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended from time to time.

          "EXCHANGE NOTES" shall mean securities issued by the Company under an
Indenture and containing terms substantially identical to the Notes (except that
they will not contain terms with respect to the transfer restrictions under the
Securities Act, will not require transfers thereof to be in minimum blocks of
$100,000 aggregate principal amount and will not provide for any Liquidated
Damages thereon).

          "EXCHANGE OFFER" shall mean the offer by the Company to the Holders to
exchange all of the Registrable Notes for an equal principal amount of Exchange
Notes pursuant to Section 2(a) hereof.

          "EXCHANGE OFFER REGISTRATION" shall mean a registration under the
Securities Act effected pursuant to Section 2(a) hereof.

          "EXCHANGE OFFER REGISTRATION STATEMENT" shall mean an exchange offer
registration statement on Form S-4 (or, if applicable, on another appropriate
form), and all amendments and supplements to such registration statement, in
each case including the Prospectus contained therein, all exhibits thereto and
all material incorporated by reference therein.

          "EXCHANGE PERIOD" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2(a)
hereof.

          "HOLDER" shall mean the Initial Purchaser, for so long as it owns any
Registrable Notes, and each of its respective successors, assigns and direct and
indirect transferees who become registered owners of Registrable Notes under the
Indenture.

          "INDENTURE" shall mean the Indenture relating to the Notes dated as of
February 24, 1998, between the Company, as issuer, and United States Trust
Company of New York, as trustee, as the same may be amended from time to time in
accordance with the terms thereof.

          "INITIAL PURCHASER" shall have the meaning set forth in the preamble
to this Agreement.

          "INSPECTORS" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 3(n) hereof.

          "ISSUE DATE" shall mean the date of original issuance of the Notes.

          "LIQUIDATED DAMAGES" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2(e)
hereof.

          "MAJORITY HOLDERS" shall mean the Holders of a majority of the
aggregate principal amount of outstanding Notes.

          "NOTES" shall have the meaning set forth in the preamble to this
Agreement.

          "PARTICIPATING BROKER-DEALER" shall have the meaning set forth in
Section 3(t) hereof.

          "PERSON" shall mean an individual, partnership, corporation, trust or
unincorporated organization, limited liability company, or a government or
agency or political subdivision thereof.

          "PROSPECTUS" shall mean the prospectus included in a Registration
Statement, including any preliminary prospectus, and any such prospectus as
amended or supplemented by any prospectus supplement, including a prospectus
supplement with respect to the terms of the offering of any portion of the
Registrable Notes covered by a Shelf Registration Statement, and by all other
amendments and supplements to a prospectus, including post-effective amendments,
and in each case including all material incorporated by reference therein.

          "PURCHASE AGREEMENT" shall have the meaning set forth in the preamble
to this Agreement.

          "RECORDS" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 3(n) hereof.

          "REGISTRABLE NOTES" shall mean the Notes; PROVIDED, however, that the
Notes shall cease to be Registrable Notes when (i) a Registration Statement with
respect to such Notes for the exchange or resale thereof, as the case may be,
shall have been declared effective under the Securities Act and such Notes shall
have been exchanged or disposed of pursuant to such Registration Statement, (ii)
such Notes shall have been sold or are eligible to be sold to the public
pursuant to Rule 144(k) (or any similar provision then in force, but not Rule
144A) under the Securities Act, (iii) such Notes shall have ceased to be
outstanding or (iv) such Notes shall have been exchanged for Exchange Notes upon
consummation of the Exchange Offer and are thereafter freely tradeable by the
holder thereof (other than an Affiliate of the Company).

          "REGISTRATION EXPENSES" shall mean any and all expenses incident to
performance of or compliance by the Company with this Agreement, including
without limitation: (i) all SEC or National Association of Securities Dealers,
Inc. (the "NASD") registration and filing fees, including, if applicable, the
fees and expenses of any "qualified independent underwriter" (and its counsel)
that is required to be retained by any Holder of Registrable Notes in accordance
with the rules and regulations of the NASD, (ii) all fees and expenses incurred
in connection with compliance with state securities or blue sky laws (including
reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel for any underwriters or Holders in
connection with blue sky qualification of any of the Exchange Notes or
Registrable Notes) and compliance with the rules of the NASD, (iii) all expenses
of any Persons in preparing or assisting in preparing, word processing, printing
and distributing any Registration Statement, any Prospectus and any amendments
or supplements thereto, and in preparing or assisting in preparing, printing and
distributing any underwriting agreements, securities sales agreements and other
documents relating to the performance of and compliance with this Agreement,
(iv) all rating agency fees, (v) the fees and disbursements of counsel for the
Company and of the independent certified public accountants of the Company,
including the expenses of any "cold comfort" letters required by or incident to
such performance and compliance, (vi) the fees and expenses of the Trustee and
its counsel, and any exchange agent or custodian, (vii) all fees and expenses
incurred in connection with the listing, if any, of any of the Exchange Notes or
the Registrable Notes on any securities exchange or exchanges, and (viii) the
reasonable fees and expenses of any special experts retained by the Company in
connection with any Registration Statement.

          "REGISTRATION STATEMENT" shall mean any registration statement of the
Company which covers any of the Exchange Notes or Registrable Notes pursuant to
the provisions of this Agreement, and all amendments and supplements to any such
Registration Statement, including post-effective amendments, in each case
including the Prospectus contained therein, all exhibits thereto and all
material incorporated by reference therein.

          "SEC" shall mean the Securities and Exchange Commission.

          "SECURITIES ACT" shall mean the Securities Act of 1933, as amended
from time to time.

          "SHELF REGISTRATION" shall mean a registration effected pursuant to
Section 2(b) hereof.

          "SHELF REGISTRATION EVENT" shall have the meaning set forth in Section
2(b) hereof.

          "SHELF REGISTRATION EVENT DATE" shall have the meaning set forth in
Section 2(b) hereof.

          "SHELF REGISTRATION STATEMENT" shall mean a "shelf" registration
statement of the Company pursuant to the provisions of Section 2(b) hereof which
covers all of the Registrable Notes on an appropriate form under Rule 415 under
the Securities Act, or any similar rule that may be adopted by the SEC, and all
amendments and supplements to such registration statement, including
post-effective amendments, in each case including the Prospectus contained
therein, all exhibits thereto and all material incorporated by reference
therein.

          "TIA" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 3(l) hereof.

          "TRUSTEES" shall mean any and all trustees with respect to the Notes.

          2. REGISTRATION UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT.

          (a) EXCHANGE OFFER. To the extent not prohibited by any applicable law
or applicable interpretation of the staff of the SEC, the Company shall, for the
benefit of the Holders, at the Company's cost, use its best efforts to (i) cause
to be filed with the SEC within 120 days after the Issue Date an Exchange Offer
Registration Statement on an appropriate form under the Securities Act covering
the Exchange Offer, (ii) cause such Exchange Offer Registration Statement to be
declared effective under the Securities Act within 150 days after the Issue Date
and (iii) keep such Exchange Offer Registration Statement effective for not less
than 30 calendar days (or longer if required by applicable law) after the date
notice of the Exchange Offer has been mailed to the Holders. Upon the
effectiveness of the Exchange Offer Registration Statement, the Company shall
promptly commence the Exchange Offer, it being the objective of such Exchange
Offer to enable each Holder eligible and electing to exchange Registrable Notes
for an equal principal amount of Exchange Notes (assuming that such Holder
represents that the Holder (i) is not an Affiliate of the Company, (ii) acquired
the Exchange Notes in the ordinary course of such Holder's business and (iii)
has no arrangements or understandings with any Person to participate in the
distribution (within the meaning of the Securities Act) of the Exchange Notes)
to transfer such Exchange Notes from and after their receipt without any
limitations or restrictions under the Securities Act and under state securities
or blue sky laws.

          In connection with the Exchange Offer, the Company shall:

          (i) mail or cause to be mailed to each Holder a copy of the Prospectus
     forming part of the Exchange Offer Registration Statement, together with an
     appropriate letter of transmittal and related documents;

          (ii) keep the Exchange Offer open for acceptance for a period of not
     less than 30 days after the date notice thereof is mailed to the Holders
     (or longer if required by applicable law) (such period referred to herein
     as the "EXCHANGE PERIOD");

          (iii) utilize the services of the Depositary for the Exchange Offer;

          (iv) permit Holders to withdraw tendered Notes at any time prior to
     the close of business, New York time, on the last Business Day of the
     Exchange Period, by sending to the institution specified in the notice, a
     telegram, telex, facsimile transmission or letter setting forth the name of
     such Holder, the principal amount of Notes delivered for exchange, and a
     statement that such Holder is withdrawing its election to have such Notes
     exchanged;

          (v) notify each Holder that any Note not tendered by such Holder in
     the Exchange Offer will remain outstanding and continue to accrue interest
     or accumulate distributions, as the case may be, but will not retain any
     rights under this Agreement (except in the case of the Initial Purchaser
     and Participating Broker-Dealers as provided herein); and

          (vi) otherwise comply in all respects with all applicable laws
     relating to the Exchange Offer.

          As soon as practicable after the close of the Exchange Offer, the
Company shall:

          (i) accept for exchange all Notes or portions thereof tendered and not
     validly withdrawn pursuant to the Exchange Offer;

          (ii) deliver, or cause to be delivered, to the Trustee for
     cancellation all Notes or portions thereof so accepted for exchange by the
     Company; and

          (iii) issue, and cause the Trustee under the Indenture to promptly
     authenticate and deliver to each Holder, new Exchange Notes equal in
     principal amount to the principal amount of the Notes as are surrendered by
     such Holder.

          Interest on each Exchange Note issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer
will accrue from the last date on which interest was paid on the Notes
surrendered in exchange therefor or, if no interest has been paid on such Note,
from the Issue Date. To the extent not prohibited by any law or applicable
interpretation of the staff of the SEC, the Company shall use its efforts to
complete the Exchange Offer as provided above, and shall comply with the
applicable requirements of the Securities Act, the Exchange Act and other
applicable laws in connection with the Exchange Offer. Except as provided
herein, the Exchange Offer shall not be subject to any conditions, other than
that the Exchange Offer does not violate applicable law or any applicable
interpretation of the staff of the SEC. Each Holder of Registrable Notes who
wishes to exchange such Registrable Notes for Exchange Notes in the Exchange
Offer will be required to make certain customary representations in connection
therewith, including, in the case of any Holder, representations that (i) the
Holder is not an Affiliate of the Company, (ii) the Exchange Notes to be
received by it were acquired in the ordinary course of its business and (iii) at
the time of the Exchange Offer, it has no arrangement with any person to
participate in the distribution (within the meaning of the Securities Act) of
the Exchange Notes. The Company shall inform the Initial Purchaser, after
consultation with the Trustee, of the names and addresses of the Holders to whom
the Exchange Offer is made, and the Initial Purchaser shall have the right to
contact such Holders and otherwise facilitate the tender of Registrable Notes in
the Exchange Offer.

          Upon consummation of the Exchange Offer in accordance with this
Section 2, the provisions of this Agreement shall continue to apply, MUTATIS
MUTANDIS, solely with respect to Registrable Notes that are Exchange Notes held
by Participating Broker-Dealers, and the Company shall have no further
obligation to register the Registrable Notes pursuant to Section 2(b) of this
Agreement.

          (b) SHELF REGISTRATION. If prior to the expiration of the Exchange
Offer: (i) the Company or the Majority Holders reasonably determine, after
conferring with counsel (which may be in-house counsel), that the Exchange Offer
Registration provided in Section 2(a) above is not available under applicable
law and regulations and currently prevailing interpretations of the staff of the
SEC, (ii) for any reason the Exchange Offer Registration Statement is not
declared effective within 150 days after the Issue Date or (iii) upon the
request of the Initial Purchaser with respect to any Registrable Notes held by
it, if, in the reasonable opinion of Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP or
other counsel experienced in such matters, the Initial Purchaser is not
permitted pursuant to applicable law or applicable interpretations of the staff
of the SEC, to participate in the Exchange Offer and thereby receive securities
that are freely tradeable without restriction under the Securities Act and
applicable blue sky or state securities laws (any of the events specified in
(i)-(iii) being a "SHELF REGISTRATION EVENT" and the date of occurrence thereof,
the "SHELF REGISTRATION EVENT DATE"), then in addition to or in lieu of
effecting the registration of the Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer
Registration Statement, the Company will (y) promptly deliver to the Holders
written notice thereof and (z) at the Company's sole expense: (a) as promptly as
practicable after such Shelf Registration Event Date file a Shelf Registration
covering resales of the Notes and (b) use its best efforts to cause the Shelf
Registration Statement to be declared effective under the Securities Act. No
Holder of Registrable Notes shall be entitled to include any of its Registrable
Notes in any Shelf Registration pursuant to this Agreement unless and until such
Holder agrees in writing to be bound by all of the provisions of this Agreement
applicable to such Holder and furnishes to the Company in writing, within 15
days after receipt of a request therefor, such information as the Company may,
after conferring with counsel with regard to information relating to Holders
that would be required by the SEC to be included in such Shelf Registration
Statement or Prospectus included therein, reasonably request for inclusion in
any Shelf Registration Statement or Prospectus included therein. Each Holder as
to which any Shelf Registration is being effected agrees to furnish to the
Company all information with respect to such Holder necessary to make the
information previously furnished to the Company by such Holder not materially
misleading.

          The Company agrees to use its best efforts to keep effective the Shelf
Registration Statement until the earlier of two years after the Issue Date (six
months in the case of a Shelf Registration Statement filed at the request of the
Initial Purchaser under Section 2(b)(iii) hereof) or such time as all of the
applicable Notes have been sold thereunder or otherwise cease to be Registrable
Notes within the meaning of this Agreement (the "EFFECTIVENESS PERIOD"). The
Company shall not permit any securities other than Registrable Notes to be
included in the Shelf Registration. The Company will, in the event a Shelf
Registration Statement is filed, provide to each Holder copies of the Prospectus
that is a part of the Shelf Registration Statement, notify each such Holder when
the Shelf Registration Statement for the Notes has become effective and take
certain other actions as are required to permit unrestricted resales of the
Notes. The Company further agrees, if necessary, to supplement or amend the
Shelf Registration Statement, if required by the rules, regulations or
instructions applicable to the registration form used by the Company for such
Shelf Registration Statement or by the Securities Act or by any other rules and
regulations thereunder for shelf registrations, and the Company agrees to
furnish to the Holders of Registrable Notes copies of any such supplement or
amendment promptly after its being used or filed with the SEC.

          (c) EXPENSES. The Company, as issuer of the Notes, shall pay all
Registration Expenses in connection with the registration pursuant to Section
2(a) and/or 2(b) hereof and will reimburse the Initial Purchaser for the
reasonable fees and disbursements of Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP,
counsel for the Initial Purchaser, incurred in connection with the Exchange
Offer and either Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP or any one other
counsel designated in writing by the Majority Holders to act as counsel for the
Holders of the Registrable Notes in connection with a Shelf Registration
Statement, which other counsel shall be reasonably satisfactory to the Company.
Except as provided herein, each Holder shall pay all expenses of its counsel,
underwriting discounts and commissions and transfer taxes, if any, relating to
the sale or disposition of such Holder's Registrable Notes pursuant to the Shelf
Registration Statement.

          (d) EFFECTIVE REGISTRATION STATEMENT. An Exchange Offer Registration
Statement pursuant to Section 2(a) hereof or a Shelf Registration Statement
pursuant to Section 2(b) hereof will not be deemed to have become effective
unless it has been declared effective by the SEC; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that if,
after it has been declared effective, the offering of Registrable Notes pursuant
to such Exchange Offer Registration Statement or Shelf Registration Statement is
interfered with by any stop order, injunction or other order or requirement of
the SEC or any other governmental agency or court, such Registration Statement
will be deemed not to have been effective during the period of such
interference, until the offering of Registrable Notes pursuant to such
Registration Statement may legally resume. The Company will be deemed not to
have used its best efforts to cause the Exchange Offer Registration Statement or
the Shelf Registration Statement, as the case may be, to become, or to remain,
effective during the requisite period if it voluntarily takes any action that
would result in any such Registration Statement not being declared effective or
that would result in the Holders of Registrable Notes covered thereby not being
able to exchange or offer and sell such Registrable Notes during that period
unless such action is required by applicable law.

          (e) LIQUIDATED DAMAGES. If the Company fails to comply with this
Agreement or if the Exchange Offer Registration Statement or the Shelf
Registration Statement fails to become effective, then, Liquidated Damages shall
become payable in respect of the Notes as follows:

          (i) if (A) neither the Exchange Offer Registration Statement nor a
     Shelf Registration Statement is filed with the SEC on or prior to the 120th
     day after the Issue Date or (B) notwithstanding that the Company has
     consummated or will consummate an Exchange Offer, the Company is required
     to file a Shelf Registration Statement and such Shelf Registration
     Statement is not filed on or prior to the date required by the Registration
     Rights Agreement, then commencing on the day after either such required
     filing date, Liquidated Damages shall be payable on the principal amount of
     the Notes at the rate of 0.25% per annum; or

          (ii) if (A) neither the Exchange Offer Registration Statement nor a
     Shelf Registration Statement is declared effective by the SEC on or prior
     to the 30th day after the applicable required filing date or (B)
     notwithstanding that the Company has consummated or will consummate an
     Exchange Offer, the Company is required to file a Shelf Registration
     Statement and such Shelf Registration Statement is not declared effective
     by the SEC on or prior to the later of the 30th day after the date such
     Shelf Registration Statement was required to be filed and the 150th day
     after the Issue Date then, commencing on (y) the 31st day after the
     applicable required filing date in the case of (A) above, or (z) the later
     of the 31st day after the date such Shelf Registration Statement was
     required to be filed and the 151st day after the Issue Date in the case of
     (B) above, Liquidated Damages shall be payable on the principal amount of
     the Notes at the rate of 0.25% per annum; or

          (iii) if (A) the Company has not exchanged Exchange Notes for all
     Notes validly tendered, in accordance with the terms of the Exchange Offer
     on or prior to the 45th day after the date on which the Exchange Offer
     Registration Statement was declared effective or (B) if applicable, the
     Shelf Registration Statement has been declared effective and such Shelf
     Registration Statement ceases to be available for use by Holders at any
     time prior to (y) the second anniversary of the Issue Date or (z) the
     expiration of 90 days from the effective date of Registration Statement
     filed at the request of the Initial Purchaser (other than after such time
     as all Notes have been disposed of thereunder or otherwise cease to be
     Registrable Notes within the meaning of this Agreement), and such event
     continues for a period exceeding 30 consecutive days or 90 days (whether or
     not consecutive) in any 360-day period, then Liquidated Damages shall be
     payable on the principal amount of Notes at a rate of 0.25% per annum
     commencing on (x) the 46th day after such effective date, in the case of
     (A) above, or (y) the 30th consecutive day or 91st day in any 360-day
     period following the day such Shelf Registration Statement ceases to be
     available in the case of (B) above;

PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that the Liquidated Damages on the Notes may not exceed in
the aggregate 0.25% per annum; PROVIDED, FURTHER, HOWEVER, that (1) upon the
filing of the Exchange Offer Registration Statement or a Shelf Registration
Statement (in the case of clause (i) above), (2) upon the effectiveness of the
Exchange Offer Registration Statement or a Shelf Registration Statement (in the
case of clause (ii) above), or (3) upon the exchange of Exchange Notes for all
Notes tendered (in the case of clause (iii)(A) above), or upon the availability
of the Shelf Registration Statement which had ceased to be available (in the
case of clause (iii)(B) above), Liquidated Damages on the Notes shall cease to
be payable.

          Any amounts of Liquidated Damages due pursuant to clause (i), (ii) or
(iii) above will be payable in cash on the next succeeding March 1 and September
1, as the case may be, to the Holders of record at the close of business on the
February 15 or August 15 immediately preceding such date.

          (f) SPECIFIC ENFORCEMENT. Without limiting the remedies available to
the Holders, the Company acknowledges that any failure by the Company to comply
with its obligations under Section 2(a) and Section 2(b) hereof may result in
material irreparable injury to the Holders for which there is no adequate remedy
at law, that it would not be possible to measure damages for such injuries
precisely and that, in the event of any such failure, any Holder may obtain such
relief as may be required to specifically enforce the Company's obligations
under Section 2(a) and Section 2(b) hereof.

          3. REGISTRATION PROCEDURES. In connection with the obligations of the
Company with respect to the Registration Statements pursuant to Sections 2(a)
and 2(b) hereof, the Company shall use its best efforts to:

          (a) prepare and file with the SEC a Registration Statement or
Registration Statements as prescribed by Sections 2(a) and 2(b) hereof within
the relevant time period specified in Section 2 hereof on the appropriate form
under the Securities Act, which form (i) shall be selected by the Company, (ii)
shall, in the case of a Shelf Registration, be available for the sale of the
Registrable Notes by the selling Holders thereof and, in the case of an Exchange
Offer, be available for the exchange of Registrable Notes, and (iii) shall
comply as to form in all material respects with the requirements of the
applicable form and include all financial statements required by the SEC to be
filed therewith or incorporated therein by reference, if applicable; and use its
best efforts to cause such Registration Statement to become effective and remain
effective (and, in the case of a Shelf Registration Statement, available for
use) in accordance with Section 2 hereof; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that if (1) such
filing is pursuant to Section 2(b), or (2) a Prospectus contained in an Exchange
Offer Registration Statement filed pursuant to Section 2(a) is required to be
delivered under the Securities Act by any Participating Broker-Dealer who seeks
to sell Exchange Notes, before filing any Registration Statement or Prospectus
or any amendments or supplements thereto, the Company shall furnish to and
afford the Holders of the Registrable Notes and each such Participating
Broker-Dealer, as the case may be, covered by such Registration Statement, their
counsel and the managing underwriters, if any, a reasonable opportunity to
review copies of all such documents (including copies of any documents to be
incorporated by reference therein and all exhibits thereto) proposed to be
filed. The Company shall not file any Registration Statement or Prospectus or
any amendments or supplements thereto in respect of which the Holders must be
afforded an opportunity to review prior to the filing of such document if the
Majority Holders or such Participating Broker-Dealer, as the case may be, their
counsel or the managing underwriters, if any, shall reasonably object;

          (b) prepare and file with the SEC such amendments and post-effective
amendments to each Registration Statement as may be necessary to keep such
Registration Statement effective for the Effectiveness Period or the Applicable
Period, as the case may be; and cause each Prospectus to be supplemented, if so
determined by the Company or requested by the SEC, by any required prospectus
supplement and as so supplemented to be filed pursuant to Rule 424 (or any
similar provision then in force) under the Securities Act, and comply with the
provisions of the Securities Act, the Exchange Act and the rules and regulations
promulgated thereunder applicable to it with respect to the disposition of all
securities covered by each Registration Statement during the Effectiveness
Period or the Applicable Period, as the case may be, in accordance with the
intended method or methods of distribution by the selling Holders thereof
described in this Agreement (including sales by any Participating
Broker-Dealer);

          (c) in the case of a Shelf Registration, (i) notify each Holder of
Registrable Notes included in the Shelf Registration Statement, at least three
Business Days prior to filing, that a Shelf Registration Statement with respect
to the Registrable Notes is being filed and advise such Holder that the
distribution of Registrable Notes will be made in accordance with the method
selected by the Majority Holders; and (ii) furnish to each Holder of Registrable
Notes included in the Shelf Registration Statement and to each underwriter of an
underwritten offering of Registrable Notes, if any, without charge, as many
copies of each Prospectus, including each preliminary Prospectus, and any
amendment or supplement thereto and such other documents as such Holder or
underwriter may reasonably request, in order to facilitate the public sale or
other disposition of the Registrable Notes; and (iii) consent to the use of the
Prospectus or any amendment or supplement thereto by each of the selling Holders
of Registrable Notes included in the Shelf Registration Statement in connection
with the offering and sale of the Registrable Notes covered by the Prospectus or
any amendment or supplement thereto;

          (d) in the case of a Shelf Registration, use its best efforts to
register or qualify the Registrable Notes under all applicable state securities
or "blue sky" laws of such jurisdictions by the time the applicable Registration
Statement is declared effective by the SEC as any Holder of Registrable Notes
covered by a Registration Statement and each underwriter of an underwritten
offering of Registrable Notes shall reasonably request in writing in advance of
such date of effectiveness, and do any and all other acts and things which may
be reasonably necessary or advisable to enable such Holder and underwriter to
consummate the disposition in each such jurisdiction of such Registrable Notes
owned by such Holder; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that the Company shall not be required
to (i) qualify as a foreign corporation or as a dealer in securities in any
jurisdiction where it would not otherwise be required to qualify but for this
Section 3(d), (ii) file any general consent to service of process in any
jurisdiction where it would not otherwise be subject to such service of process
or (iii) subject itself to taxation in any such jurisdiction if it is not then
so subject;

          (e) (1) in the case of a Shelf Registration or (2) if Participating
Broker-Dealers from whom the Company has received prior written notice that they
will be utilizing the Prospectus contained in the Exchange Offer Registration
Statement as provided in Section 3(t) hereof, are seeking to sell Exchange Notes
and are required to deliver Prospectuses, promptly notify each Holder of
Registrable Notes, or such Participating Broker-Dealers, as the case may be,
their counsel and the managing underwriters, if any, and promptly confirm such
notice in writing (i) when a Registration Statement has become effective and
when any post-effective amendments and supplements thereto become effective,
(ii) of any request by the SEC or any state securities authority for amendments
and supplements to a Registration Statement or Prospectus or for additional
information after the Registration Statement has become effective, (iii) of the
issuance by the SEC or any state securities authority of any stop order
suspending the effectiveness of a Registration Statement or the qualification of
the Registrable Notes or the Exchange Notes to be offered or sold by any
Participating Broker-Dealer in any jurisdiction described in paragraph 3(d)
hereof or the initiation of any proceedings for that purpose, (iv) in the case
of a Shelf Registration, if, between the effective date of a Registration
Statement and the closing of any sale of Registrable Notes covered thereby, the
representations and warranties of the Company contained in any purchase
agreement, securities sales agreement or other similar agreement, cease to be
true and correct in all material respects, (v) of the happening of any event or
the failure of any event to occur or the discovery of any facts or otherwise,
during the Effectiveness Period which makes any statement made in such
Registration Statement or the related Prospectus untrue in any material respect
or which causes such Registration Statement or Prospectus to omit to state a
material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in the light of the
circumstances under which they were made, not misleading, and (vi) the Company's
reasonable determination that a post-effective amendment to the Registration
Statement would be appropriate;

          (f) make every reasonable effort to obtain the withdrawal of any order
suspending the effectiveness of a Registration Statement at the earliest
possible moment;

          (g) in the case of a Shelf Registration, furnish to each Holder of
Registrable Notes included within the coverage of such Shelf Registration
Statement, without charge, at least one conformed copy of each Registration
Statement relating to such Shelf Registration and any post-effective amendment
thereto (without documents incorporated therein by reference or exhibits
thereto, unless requested);

          (h) in the case of a Shelf Registration, cooperate with the selling
Holders of Registrable Notes to facilitate the timely preparation and delivery
of certificates representing Registrable Notes to be sold and not bearing any
restrictive legends and in such denominations (consistent with the provisions of
the Indenture) and registered in such names as the selling Holders or the
underwriters may reasonably request at least two Business Days prior to the
closing of any sale of Registrable Notes pursuant to such Shelf Registration
Statement;

          (i) in the case of a Shelf Registration or an Exchange Offer
Registration, upon the occurrence of any circumstance contemplated by Section
3(e)(ii), 3(e)(iii), 3(e)(v) or 3(e)(vi) hereof, use its best efforts to prepare
a supplement or post-effective amendment to such Registration Statement or the
related Prospectus or any document incorporated therein by reference or file any
other required document so that, as thereafter delivered to the purchasers of
the Registrable Notes, such Prospectus will not contain any untrue statement of
a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the
statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were
made, not misleading; and to notify each Holder to suspend use of the Prospectus
as promptly as practicable after the occurrence of such an event, and each
Holder hereby agrees to suspend the sale of Notes pursuant to such Prospectus
until the Company has amended or supplemented such Prospectus to correct such
misstatement or omission and has furnished copies of the amended or supplemented
prospectus to such holder (or Participating Broker-Dealer, as the case may be)
or the Company has given notice that the sale of the Notes may be resumed, as
the case may be;

          (j) in the case of a Shelf Registration, a reasonable time prior to
the filing of any document which is to be incorporated by reference into a
Registration Statement or a Prospectus after the initial filing of a
Registration Statement, provide a reasonable number of copies of such document
to the Holders; and make such of the representatives of the Company as shall be
reasonably requested by the Holders of Registrable Notes or an Initial Purchaser
on behalf of such Holders available for discussion of such document;

          (k) obtain a CUSIP number for all Exchange Notes not later than the
effective date of a Registration Statement, and provide the Trustee with printed
certificates for the Exchange Notes or the Registrable Notes, as the case may
be, in a form eligible for deposit with the Depositary;

          (l) cause the Indenture to be qualified under the Trust Indenture Act
of 1939 (the "TIA") in connection with the registration of the Exchange Notes or
Registrable Notes, as the case may be, and effect such changes to such documents
as may be required for them to be so qualified in accordance with the terms of
the TIA and execute, and use its best efforts to cause the Trustee to execute,
all documents as may be required to effect such changes, and all other forms and
documents required to be filed with the SEC to enable such documents to be so
qualified in a timely manner;

          (m) in the case of a Shelf Registration, enter into such agreements
(including underwriting agreements) as are customary in underwritten offerings
and take all such other appropriate actions as are reasonably requested in order
to expedite or facilitate the registration or the disposition of such
Registrable Notes, and in such connection, whether or not an underwriting
agreement is entered into and whether or not the registration is an underwritten
registration, if requested by (x) the Initial Purchaser, in the case where the
Initial Purchaser holds Notes acquired by it as part of its initial allotment
and (y) other Holders of the Registrable Notes covered thereby: (i) make such
representations and warranties to Holders of such Registrable Notes and the
underwriters (if any), with respect to the business of the Company and its
subsidiaries as then conducted and the Registration Statement, Prospectus and
documents, if any, incorporated or deemed to be incorporated by reference
therein, in each case, as are customarily made by issuers to underwriters in
underwritten offerings, and confirm the same if and when requested; (ii) obtain
opinions of counsel to the Company and updates thereof (which may be in the form
of a reliance letter) in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the
managing underwriters (if any) and the Holders of a majority in principal amount
of the Registrable Notes being sold, addressed to each selling Holder and the
underwriters (if any) covering the matters customarily covered in opinions
requested in underwritten offerings and such other matters as may be reasonably
requested by such underwriters (it being agreed that the matters to be covered
by such opinion may be subject to customary qualifications and exceptions);
(iii) obtain "cold comfort" letters and updates thereof in form and substance
reasonably satisfactory to the managing underwriters from the independent
certified public accountants of the Company (and, if necessary, any other
independent certified public accountants of any subsidiary of the Company or of
any business acquired by the Company for which financial statements and
financial data are, or are required to be, included in the Registration
Statement), addressed to each of the underwriters, such letters to be in
customary form and covering matters of the type customarily covered in "cold
comfort" letters in connection with underwritten offerings and such other
matters as reasonably requested by such underwriters in accordance with
Statement on Auditing Standards No. 72; and (iv) if an underwriting agreement is
entered into, the same shall contain indemnification provisions and procedures
no less favorable to the underwriters and the Holders of Registrable Notes than
those set forth in Section 4 hereof (or such other provisions and procedures
acceptable to Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount or liquidation
amount, as the case may be, of Registrable Notes covered by such Registration
Statement and the managing underwriters and agents) customary for such
agreements with respect to all parties to be indemnified pursuant to said
Section (including, without limitation, such underwriters and selling Holders).
The above shall be done at each closing under such underwriting agreement, or as
and to the extent required thereunder;

          (n) if (1) a Shelf Registration is filed pursuant to Section 2(b) or
(2) a Prospectus contained in an Exchange Offer Registration Statement filed
pursuant to Section 2(a) is required to be delivered under the Securities Act by
any Participating Broker-Dealer who seeks to sell Exchange Notes during the
Applicable Period, make reasonably available for inspection by any selling
Holder of such Registrable Notes being sold, or each such Participating
Broker-Dealer, as the case may be, any underwriter participating in any such
disposition of Registrable Notes, if any, and any attorney, accountant or other
agent retained by any such selling Holder or each such Participating
Broker-Dealer, as the case may be, or underwriter (collectively, the
"INSPECTORS"), at the offices where normally kept, during reasonable business
hours, all financial and other records, pertinent corporate documents and
properties of the Company and its subsidiaries (collectively, the "RECORDS") as
shall be reasonably necessary to enable them to exercise any applicable due
diligence responsibilities, and cause the officers, directors and employees of
the Company and its subsidiaries to supply all relevant information in each case
reasonably requested by any such Inspector in connection with such Registration
Statement; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that the foregoing inspection and information
gathering shall be coordinated on behalf of any Participating Broker-Dealer by
the Initial Purchaser and on behalf of the other parties by one counsel
designated by the Majority Holders on behalf of such other parties as described
in Section 2(c) hereof. Records which the Company determines, in good faith, to
be confidential and any records which it notifies the Inspectors are
confidential shall not be disclosed by the Inspectors unless (i) the disclosure
of such Records is necessary to avoid or correct a material misstatement or
omission in such Registration Statement, (ii) the release of such Records is
ordered pursuant to a subpoena or other order from a court of competent
jurisdiction or is necessary in connection with any action, suit or proceeding
or (iii) the information in such Records has been made generally available to
the public. Each selling Holder of such Registrable Notes and each such
Participating Broker-Dealer will be required to agree in writing that
information obtained by it as a result of such inspections shall be deemed
confidential and shall not be used by it as the basis for any market
transactions in the securities of the Company unless and until such is made
generally available to the public. Each selling Holder of such Registrable Notes
and each such Participating Broker-Dealer will be required to further agree in
writing that it will, upon learning that disclosure of such Records is sought in
a court of competent jurisdiction, give notice to the Company and allow the
Company at its expense to undertake appropriate action to prevent disclosure of
the Records deemed confidential;

          (o) comply with all applicable rules and regulations of the SEC so
long as any provision of this Agreement shall be applicable and make generally
available to its securityholders earning statements satisfying the provisions of
Section 11(a) of the Securities Act and Rule 158 thereunder (or any similar rule
promulgated under the Securities Act) no later than 45 days after the end of any
12-month period (or 90 days after the end of any 12-month period if such period
is a fiscal year) (i) commencing at the end of any fiscal quarter in which
Registrable Notes are sold to underwriters in a firm commitment or best efforts
underwritten offering and (ii) if not sold to underwriters in such an offering,
commencing on the first day of the first fiscal quarter of the Company after the
effective date of a Registration Statement, which statements shall cover said
12-month periods;

          (p) upon consummation of an Exchange Offer, if requested by a Trustee,
obtain an opinion of counsel to the Company addressed to the Trustee for the
benefit of all Holders of Registrable Notes participating in the Exchange Offer
substantially to the effect that (i) the Company has duly authorized, executed
and delivered the Exchange Notes and (ii) the Exchange Notes constitute legal,
valid and binding obligations of the Company, enforceable against the Company,
in accordance with its respective terms (in each case, with customary
exceptions);

          (q) if an Exchange Offer is to be consummated, upon delivery of the
Registrable Notes by Holders to the Company (or to such other Person as directed
by the Company), in exchange for the Exchange Notes, the Company shall mark, or
cause to be marked, on such Registrable Notes delivered by such Holders that
such Registrable Notes are being cancelled in exchange for the Exchange Notes;
in no event shall such Registrable Notes be marked as paid or otherwise
satisfied;

          (r) cooperate with each seller of Registrable Notes covered by any
Registration Statement and each underwriter, if any, participating in the
disposition of such Registrable Notes and their respective counsel in connection
with any filings required to be made with the NASD;

          (s) use its best efforts to take all other steps necessary to effect
the registration of the Registrable Notes covered by a Registration Statement
contemplated hereby;

          (t) (A) in the case of the Exchange Offer Registration Statement (i)
include in the Exchange Offer Registration Statement a section entitled "Plan of
Distribution," which section shall be reasonably acceptable to the Initial
Purchaser or another representative of the Participating Broker-Dealers, and
which shall contain a summary statement of the positions taken or policies made
by the staff of the SEC with respect to the potential "underwriter" status of
any broker-dealer (a "PARTICIPATING BROKER-DEALER") that holds Registrable Notes
acquired for its own account as a result of market-making activities or other
trading activities and that will be the beneficial owner (as defined in Rule
13d-3 under the Exchange Act) of Exchange Notes to be received by such
broker-dealer in the Exchange Offer, whether such positions or policies have
been publicly disseminated by the staff of the SEC or such positions or
policies, in the reasonable judgment of the Initial Purchaser or such other
representative, represent the prevailing views of the staff of the SEC,
including a statement that any such broker-dealer who receives Exchange Notes
for Registrable Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer may be deemed a statutory
underwriter and must deliver a prospectus meeting the requirements of the
Securities Act in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes, (ii)
furnish to each Participating Broker-Dealer who has delivered to the Company the
notice referred to in Section 3(e), without charge, as many copies of each
Prospectus included in the Exchange Offer Registration Statement, including any
preliminary prospectus, and any amendment or supplement thereto, as such
Participating Broker-Dealer may reasonably request (the Company hereby consents
to the use of the Prospectus forming part of the Exchange Offer Registration
Statement or any amendment or supplement thereto by any Person subject to the
prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act, including all
Participating Broker-Dealers, in connection with the sale or transfer of the
Exchange Notes covered by the Prospectus or any amendment or supplement
thereto), (iii) use its best efforts to keep the Exchange Offer Registration
Statement effective and to amend and supplement the Prospectus contained therein
in order to permit such Prospectus to be lawfully delivered by all Persons
subject to the prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act for such
period of time as such Persons must comply with such requirements under the
Securities Act and applicable rules and regulations in order to resell the
Exchange Notes; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that such period shall not be required to
exceed 180 days (or such longer period if extended pursuant to the last sentence
of Section 3 hereof) (the "APPLICABLE PERIOD"), and (iv) include in the
transmittal letter or similar documentation to be executed by an exchange
offeree in order to participate in the Exchange Offer (x) the following
provision:

          "If the exchange offeree is a broker-dealer holding Registrable Notes
          acquired for its own account as a result of market-making activities
          or other trading activities, it will deliver a prospectus meeting the
          requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any resale of
          Exchange Notes received in respect of such Registrable Notes pursuant
          to the Exchange Offer";

and (y) a statement to the effect that by a broker-dealer making the
acknowledgment described in clause (x) and by delivering a Prospectus in
connection with the exchange of Registrable Notes, the broker-dealer will not be
deemed to admit that it is an underwriter within the meaning of the Securities
Act; and

               (B) in the case of any Exchange Offer Registration Statement, the
          Company agrees to deliver to the Initial Purchaser or to another
          representative of the Participating Broker-Dealers, if requested by
          the Initial Purchaser or such other representative of the
          Participating Broker-Dealers, on behalf of the Participating
          Broker-Dealers upon consummation of the Exchange Offer (i) an opinion
          of counsel in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the
          Initial Purchaser or such other representative of the Participating
          Broker-Dealers, covering the matters customarily covered in opinions
          requested in connection with Exchange Offer Registration Statements
          and such other matters as may be reasonably requested (it being agreed
          that the matters to be covered by such opinion may be subject to
          customary qualifications and exceptions), (ii) an officers'
          certificate containing certifications substantially similar to those
          set forth in Section 5(h) of the Purchase Agreement and such
          additional certifications as are customarily delivered in a public
          offering of debt securities and (iii) as well as upon the
          effectiveness of the Exchange Offer Registration Statement, a comfort
          letter, in each case, in customary form if permitted by Statement on
          Auditing Standards No. 72.

          The Company may require each seller of Registrable Notes as to which
any registration is being effected to furnish to the Company, such information
regarding such seller as may be required by the staff of the SEC to be included
in a Registration Statement. The Company may exclude from such registration the
Registrable Notes of any seller who unreasonably fails to furnish such
information within a reasonable time after receiving such request. The Company
shall have no obligation to register under the Securities Act the Registrable
Notes of a seller who so fails to furnish such information.

          In the case of a Shelf Registration Statement, or if Participating
Broker-Dealers who have notified the Company that they will be utilizing the
Prospectus contained in the Exchange Offer Registration Statement as provided in
Section 3(t) hereof are seeking to sell Exchange Notes and are required to
deliver Prospectuses, each Holder agrees that, upon receipt of any notice from
the Company of the happening of any event of the kind described in Section
3(e)(ii), 3(e)(iii), 3(e)(v) or 3(e)(vi) hereof, such Holder will forthwith
discontinue disposition of Registrable Notes pursuant to a Registration
Statement until such Holder's receipt of the copies of the supplemented or
amended Prospectus contemplated by Section 3(i) hereof or until it is advised in
writing (the "ADVICE") by the Company that the use of the applicable Prospectus
may be resumed, and, if so directed by the Company, such Holder will deliver to
the Company (at the Company's expense, as the case requires) all copies in such
Holder's possession, other than permanent file copies then in such Holder's
possession, of the Prospectus covering such Registrable Notes or Exchange Notes,
as the case may be, current at the time of receipt of such notice. If the
Company shall give any such notice to suspend the disposition of Registrable
Notes or Exchange Notes, as the case may be, pursuant to a Registration
Statement, the Company shall use its best efforts to file and have declared
effective (if an amendment) as soon as practicable an amendment or supplement to
the Registration Statement and shall extend the period during which such
Registration Statement shall be maintained effective pursuant to this Agreement
by the number of days in the period from and including the date of the giving of
such notice to and including the date when the Company shall have made available
to the Holders (x) copies of the supplemented or amended Prospectus necessary to
resume such dispositions or (y) the Advice.

          4. INDEMNIFICATION AND CONTRIBUTION.

          (a) In connection with any Registration Statement, the Company agrees,
jointly and severally, to indemnify and hold harmless the Initial Purchaser,
each Holder, each underwriter who participates in an offering of the Registrable
Notes, each Participating Broker-Dealer, each agent, employee, officer and
director of any of the foregoing parties and each person that controls each of
the foregoing parties within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act or
Section 20 of the Exchange Act, and agents, employees, officers and directors of
any such controlling person (each, a "SECTION 4(A) INDEMNIFIED PARTY") from and
against any and all losses, claims, damages, judgments, liabilities and expenses
(including the reasonable fees and expenses of counsel and other expenses in
connection with investigating, defending or settling any such action or claim)
as they are incurred which arise out of or based upon any untrue statement or
alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in any Registration
Statement covering Registrable Notes or Exchange Notes or any amendment or
supplement thereto or arising out of or based upon any omission or alleged
omission to state therein a material fact required to be stated therein or
necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, except (i) the Company
shall not be liable to any Section 4(a) Indemnified Party in any such case
insofar as such losses, claims, damages, judgments, liabilities or expenses
arise out of, or are based upon, any such untrue statement or omission or
alleged untrue statement or omission based upon information furnished in writing
by such Holder, Initial Purchaser, Participating Broker-Dealer or any
underwriter to the Company expressly for use therein and (ii) the Company shall
not be liable to any Section 4(a) Indemnified Party under the indemnity
agreement in this Section 4(a) with respect to any untrue statement or alleged
untrue statement or omission or alleged omission in any preliminary Prospectus
to the extent that any such loss, claim, damage, judgment, liability or expense
of any Holder, Initial Purchaser, Participating Broker-Dealer, any underwriter
or controlling person results from the fact that such Holder, Initial Purchaser,
any underwriter or Participating Broker-Dealer sold Notes to a person to whom
there was not sent or given, at or prior to the written confirmation of such
sale, a copy of the final Prospectus as then amended or supplemented if the
Company had previously furnished copies thereof to such Holder, Initial
Purchaser, underwriter or Participating Broker-Dealer and the loss, claim,
damage, judgment, liability or expense of such Holder, Initial Purchaser,
underwriter, Participating Broker-Dealer or controlling person results from an
untrue statement or omission of a material fact contained in the preliminary
Prospectus which was corrected in the final Prospectus. Any amounts advanced by
the Company to a Section 4(a) Indemnified Party as a result of such losses shall
be returned to the Company if it shall be finally determined by a court in a
judgment not subject to appeal or final review that such indemnified party was
not entitled to indemnification by the Company.

          (b) If any action or proceeding (including any governmental or
regulatory investigation or proceeding) shall be brought or asserted against any
Section 4(a) Indemnified Party with respect to which indemnity may be sought
against the Company pursuant to this Section 4, such Section 4(a) Indemnified
Party shall promptly notify the Company in writing, and the Company shall have
the right to assume the defense thereof, including the employment of counsel
reasonably satisfactory to such Section 4(a) Indemnified Party and payment of
all fees and expenses; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that the omission so to notify the
Company shall not relieve the Company from any liability that they may have to
any Section 4(a) Indemnified Party (except to the extent that the Company is
materially prejudiced or otherwise forfeit substantive rights or defenses by
reason of such failure). A Section 4(a) Indemnified Party shall have the right
to employ separate counsel in any such action or proceeding and to participate
in the defense thereof, but the fees and expenses of such counsel shall be at
the expense of such Section 4(a) Indemnified Party unless (i) the Company agrees
in writing to pay such fees and expenses, (ii) the Company has failed promptly
to assume the defense and employ counsel satisfactory to the Section 4(a)
Indemnified Party or (iii) the named parties to any such action or proceeding
(including any unpleaded parties) include the Section 4(a) Indemnified Party and
the Company and such Section 4(a) Indemnified Party shall have been advised in
writing by its counsel that representation of them and the Company by the same
counsel would be inappropriate under applicable standards of professional
conduct (whether or not such representation has been proposed) due to actual or
potential differing interests between them (in which case the Company shall not
have the right to assume the defense of such action on behalf of such Section
4(a) Indemnified Party). It is understood that the Company shall not, in
connection with any one such action or separate but substantially similar or
related actions in the same jurisdiction arising out of the same general
allegations or circumstances, be liable for the fees and expenses of more than
one separate firm of attorneys (in addition to any local counsel) at any time
for such Section 4(a) Indemnified Party, and that all such fees and expenses
shall be reimbursed as they are incurred. The Company shall not be liable for
any settlement of any such action effected without the written consent of the
Company, but if settled with the written consent of the Company, or if there is
a final judgment with respect thereto, the Company agrees to indemnify and hold
harmless each Section 4(a) Indemnified Party from and against any loss or
liability by reason of such settlement or judgment. The Company shall not,
without the prior written consent of each Section 4(a) Indemnified Party
affected thereby, effect any settlement of any pending or threatened proceeding
in which such Section 4(a) Indemnified Party has sought indemnity hereunder,
unless such settlement includes an unconditional release of such Section 4(a)
Indemnified Party from all liability arising out of such action, claim,
litigation or proceeding.

          (c) Each Holder agrees, severally and not jointly, to indemnify and
hold harmless the Company, any underwriter and the other selling Holders and
each of their respective directors, officers (including each officer of the
Company who signed the Registration Statement) and any person controlling the
Company, any underwriter or any other selling Holder within the meaning of
Section 15 of the Act or Section 20 of the Exchange Act (each such party, a
"SECTION 4(C) INDEMNIFIED PARTY") to the same extent as the foregoing indemnity
from the Company to any Section 4(a) Indemnified Party, but only with respect to
information furnished to the Company in writing by such Holder, expressly for
use in the Registration Statement, Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement
thereto), or any preliminary Prospectus, PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that, in the case of
a Shelf Registration Statement, no such Holder shall be liable for any amount
hereunder in excess of the amount by which the net proceeds received by such
Holder from the sale of Registrable Notes pursuant to such Shelf Registration
Statement exceeds the amount of any damages which such Holder has otherwise been
required to pay by reason of such untrue or alleged untrue statement or omission
or alleged omission. In case any action shall be brought against any Section
4(c) Indemnified Party based on the Registration Statement, Prospectus (or any
amendment or supplement thereto), or any preliminary Prospectus and in respect
of which indemnification may be sought against each Holder pursuant to this
Section 4(c), each Holder shall have the rights and duties given to the Company
by Section 4(a) (except that if the Company shall have assumed the defense
thereof, each Holder may, but shall not be required to, employ separate counsel
therein and participate in the defense thereof and the fees and expenses of such
counsel shall be at the expense of the Holder) and the Section 4(c) Indemnified
Parties shall have the rights and duties given to the Section 4(a) Indemnified
Parties by Section 4(b).

          (d) If the indemnification provided for in this Section 4 is
unavailable to any party entitled to indemnification pursuant to Section 4(a) or
4(c), then each indemnifying party, in lieu of indemnifying such indemnified
party, shall contribute to the amount paid or payable by such indemnified party
as a result of such losses, claims, damages, judgments, liabilities and expenses
in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect the relative fault of the
Company, on the one hand, and each Holder, on the other, in connection with the
statements or omissions which resulted in such losses, claims, damages,
judgments, liabilities or expenses, as well as any other relevant equitable
considerations. The relative fault of the Company, on the one hand, and each
Holder, on the other, shall be determined by reference to, among other things,
whether the untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material fact or the
omission or alleged omission to state a material fact relates to information
supplied by the Company, on the one hand, or by each Holder, on the other, and
the parties' relative intent, knowledge, access to information and opportunity
to correct or prevent such statement or omission.

          (e) The Company, and each Holder agree that it would not be just and
equitable if contribution pursuant to Section 4(d) were determined by pro rata
allocation or by any other method of allocation that does not take account of
the equitable considerations referred to in Section 4(d). No person found guilty
of fraudulent misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the Act)
shall be entitled to contribution from any person who was not found guilty of
such fraudulent misrepresentation.

          (f) The indemnity and contribution agreements contained in this
Section 4 are in addition to any liability that any indemnifying party may
otherwise have to any indemnified party.

          5. MISCELLANEOUS.

          (a) RULE 144 AND RULE 144A. For so long as the Company is subject to
the reporting requirements of Section 13 or 15 of the Exchange Act and any
Registrable Notes remain outstanding, the Company will use its best efforts to
file the reports required to be filed by it under the Securities Act and Section
13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act and the rules and regulations adopted by the
SEC thereunder, or, if it ceases to be so required to file such reports, it
will, upon the request of any Holder of Registrable Notes (a) make publicly
available such information as is necessary to permit sales of its securities
pursuant to Rule 144 under the Securities Act, (b) deliver such information to a
prospective purchaser as is necessary to permit sales of its securities pursuant
to Rule 144A under the Securities Act and it will take such further action as
any Holder of Registrable Notes may reasonably request, and (c) take such
further action that is reasonable in the circumstances, in each case, to the
extent required from time to time to enable such Holder to sell its Registrable
Notes without registration under the Securities Act within the limitation of the
exemptions provided by (i) Rule 144 under the Securities Act, as such rule may
be amended from time to time, (ii) Rule 144A under the Securities Act, as such
rule may be amended from time to time, or (iii) any similar rules or regulations
hereafter adopted by the SEC. Upon the request of any Holder of Registrable
Notes, the Company will deliver to such Holder a written statement as to whether
it has complied with such requirements.

          (b) NO INCONSISTENT AGREEMENTS. The Company has not entered into, nor
will the Company on or after the date of this Agreement enter into, any
agreement which is inconsistent with the rights granted to the Holders of
Registrable Notes in this Agreement or otherwise conflicts with the provisions
hereof. The rights granted to the Holders hereunder do not in any way conflict
with and are not inconsistent with the rights granted to the holders of the
Company's other issued and outstanding securities under any such agreements.

          (c) AMENDMENTS AND WAIVERS. The provisions of this Agreement,
including the provisions of this sentence, may not be amended, modified or
supplemented, and waivers or consents to departures from the provisions hereof
may not be given, unless the Company has obtained the written consent of Holders
of at least a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding
Registrable Notes affected by such amendment, modification, supplement, waiver
or departure; PROVIDED that no amendment, modification or supplement or waiver
or consent to the departure with respect to the provisions of Section 4 hereof
shall be effective as against any Holder of Registrable Notes unless consented
to in writing by such Holder of Registrable Notes. Notwithstanding the foregoing
sentence, (i) this Agreement may be amended, without the consent of any Holder
of Registrable Notes, by written agreement signed by the Company and the Initial
Purchaser, to cure any ambiguity, correct or supplement any provision of this
Agreement that may be inconsistent with any other provision of this Agreement or
to make any other provisions with respect to matters or questions arising under
this Agreement which shall not be inconsistent with other provisions of this
Agreement, (ii) this Agreement may be amended, modified or supplemented, and
waivers and consents to departures from the provisions hereof may be given by
written agreement signed by the Company and the Initial Purchaser to the extent
that any such amendment, modification, supplement, waiver or consent is, in
their reasonable judgment, necessary or appropriate to comply with applicable
law (including any interpretation of the Staff of the SEC) or any change therein
and (iii) to the extent any provision of this Agreement relates to an Initial
Purchaser, such provision may be amended, modified or supplemented, and waivers
or consents to departures from such provisions may be given, by written
agreement signed by the Company and the Initial Purchaser.

          (d) NOTICES. All notices and other communications provided for or
permitted hereunder shall be made in writing by hand-delivery, registered
first-class mail, telex, telecopier, or any courier guaranteeing overnight
delivery (i) if to a Holder, at the most current address given by such Holder to
the Company by means of a notice given in accordance with the provisions of this
Section 7(d), which address initially is, with respect to the Initial Purchaser,
the address set forth in the Purchase Agreement; and (ii) if to the Company,
initially at the Company's address set forth in the Purchase Agreement and
thereafter at such other address, notice of which is given in accordance with
the provisions of this Section 7(d).

          All such notices and communications shall be deemed to have been duly
given: at the time delivered by hand, if personally delivered; five Business
Days after being deposited in the mail, postage prepaid, if mailed; when
answered back, if telexed; when receipt is acknowledged, if telecopied; and on
the next Business Day, if timely delivered to an air courier guaranteeing
overnight delivery.

          Copies of all such notices, demands, or other communications shall be
concurrently delivered by the Person giving the same to the Trustee, at the
address specified in the Indenture.

          (e) SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS. This Agreement shall inure to the benefit
of and be binding upon the respective successors, assigns and transferees of the
Initial Purchaser, including, without limitation and without the need for an
express assignment, subsequent Holders; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that nothing herein
shall be deemed to permit any assignment, transfer or other disposition of
Registrable Notes in violation of the terms of the Purchase Agreement or the
Indenture. If any transferee of any Holder shall acquire Registrable Notes, in
any manner, whether by operation of law or otherwise, such Registrable Notes
shall be held subject to all of the terms of this Agreement, and by taking and
holding such Registrable Notes, such Person shall be conclusively deemed to have
agreed to be bound by and to perform all of the terms and provisions of this
Agreement and such Person shall be entitled to receive the benefits hereof.

          (f) THIRD PARTY BENEFICIARY. The Initial Purchaser shall be a third
party beneficiary of the agreements made hereunder between the Company, on the
one hand, and the Holders, on the other hand, and shall have the right to
enforce such agreements directly to the extent it deems such enforcement
necessary or advisable to protect its rights or the rights of Holders hereunder.

          (g) COUNTERPARTS. This Agreement may be executed in any number of
counterparts and by the parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which
when so executed shall be deemed to be an original and all of which taken
together shall constitute one and the same agreement.

          (h) HEADINGS. The headings in this Agreement are for convenience of
reference only and shall not limit or otherwise affect the meaning hereof.

          (i) GOVERNING LAW. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE DEEMED TO HAVE BEEN MADE IN
THE STATE OF NEW YORK. THE VALIDITY AND INTERPRETATION OF THIS AGREEMENT, AND
THE TERMS AND CONDITIONS SET FORTH HEREIN, SHALL BE GOVERNED BY AND CONSTRUED IN
ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK WITHOUT GIVING EFFECT TO ANY
PROVISIONS RELATING TO CONFLICTS OF LAWS. EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO AGREES TO
SUBMIT TO THE JURISDICTION OF THE COURTS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK IN ANY ACTION
OR PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT.

          (j) SEVERABILITY. In the event that any one or more of the provisions
contained herein, or the application thereof in any circumstance, is held
invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity, legality and enforceability of
any such provision in every other respect and of the remaining provisions
contained herein shall not be affected or impaired thereby.

          (k) SECURITIES HELD BY THE COMPANY OR ITS Affiliates. Whenever the
consent or approval of Holders of a specified percentage of Registrable Notes is
required hereunder, Registrable Notes held by the Company or its Affiliates
shall not be counted in determining whether such consent or approval was given
by the Holders of such required percentage.

<PAGE>

          IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Agreement as of the
date first written above.

                                     INTERPOOL, INC.


                                     By:  /S/ MARTIN TUCHMAN
                                          -------------------------------------
                                     Name:  Martin Tuchman
                                     Title: Chairman and CEO




Confirmed and accepted as of
the date first above
written:

DONALDSON, LUFKIN & JENRETTE
SECURITIES CORPORATION


By: /S/  STEWART WHITMAN
    -------------------------
Name:   Stewart Whitman
Title:  Managing Director




                                                                   Exhibit 5.1


June 4, 1998


Interpool, Inc.
211 College Road East
Princeton, New Jersey  08540


Re:  Registration Statement on Form S-4

Ladies and Gentlemen:

We have acted as special counsel to Interpool, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the
"Company"), in connection with the preparation and filing with the Securities
and Exchange Commission (the "Commission") under the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended (the "Act"), of a Registration Statement on Form S-4 (the "Registration
Statement") relating to the offer (the "Exchange Offer") by the Company to
exchange $1,000 principal amount of its 6-5/8% Notes due 2003 (the "Exchange
Notes") for each $1,000 principal amount of its outstanding 6-5/8% Notes due
2003 (the "Private Notes"), of which $100,000,000 aggregate principal amount was
issued and sold on February 24, 1998 in a transaction exempt from registration
under the Act and is outstanding on the date hereof. The Private Notes were
issued under, and the Exchange Notes are to be issued under, the Indenture dated
as of February 24, 1998 between the Company and United States Trust Company of
New York, as trustee (the "Trustee").

As such counsel, we have examined originals or copies of (i) the Certificate of
Incorporation and By-Laws of the Company, each as amended to date, (ii) the
Indenture and (iii) the Registration Statement. We have also examined original,
reproduced or certified copies of all such records of the Company, such
agreements and such certificates of officers and representatives of the Company
and others, and such statutes and authorities, as we have deemed relevant and
necessary to form the basis of the opinions hereinafter expressed. In such
examinations, we have assumed the genuineness of all signatures, the
authenticity of all documents submitted to us as originals and the conformity to
original documents of the copies of documents supplied to us as copies thereof.
As to various matters of fact material to the opinions hereinafter expressed, we
have relied on representations, statements and certificates of officers and
representatives of the Company and others.

For purposes of the opinions hereinafter expressed, we have assumed that (a)
each party (other than the Company) to any document, including, without
limitation, the Indenture, has the power to enter into and perform all its
obligations thereunder, (b) each such party (other than the Company) has taken
all necessary actions to authorize the due execution, delivery and performance
of such document by it, and (c) each such document is the legal, valid and
binding obligation of each such party (other than the Company) thereto.

Attorneys involved in the preparation of this opinion are admitted to practice
law in the State of New York and we do not purport to express any opinion herein
concerning, any laws other than the laws of the State of New York, the federal
laws of the United States of America and the Delaware General Corporation
Law.

Based upon and subject to the foregoing, we are of the opinion that:

         1.       The execution and delivery of the Indenture have been
                  duly authorized by the Company and the Indenture
                  constitutes a valid and binding obligation of the
                  Company enforceable against the Company in accordance
                  with its terms, except that we express no opinion as
                  to the validity or enforceability of rights of
                  indemnity or contribution, or both.  Our opinion in
                  this paragraph is subject to applicable bankruptcy,
                  insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization or
                  similar laws affecting the rights of creditors
                  generally and to general principles of equity.

         2.       The Exchange Notes have been duly and validly
                  authorized and, when duly executed by the proper
                  officers of the Company, duly authenticated by the
                  Trustee and issued by the Company in accordance with
                  the terms of the Indenture and the Exchange Offer,
                  will constitute the legal, valid and binding
                  obligations of the Company and will be entitled to the
                  benefits of the Indenture, except that we express no
                  opinion as to the validity or enforceability of rights
                  of indemnity of contribution, or both.  Our opinion in
                  this paragraph is subject to applicable bankruptcy,
                  insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization or
                  similar laws affecting the rights of creditors
                  generally and to general principles of equity.

We consent to being named in the Registration Statement and related prospectus
as counsel who are passing upon the legality of the Exchange Notes for the
Company and to the reference to our name under the caption "Legal Matters" in
such prospectus. We also consent to the filing of this opinion as an exhibit to
the Registration Statement or any amendment thereto. In giving such consents, we
do not admit hereby that we come within the category of persons whose consent is
required under Section 7 of the Act or the rules and regulations of the
Commission thereunder.

Very truly yours,

/s/ STROOCK & STROOCK & LAVAN LLP

STROOCK & STROOCK & LAVAN LLP



                                  EXHIBIT 23.1

                    CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS

To Interpool, Inc.

          As independent public accountants, we hereby consent to the
incorporation by reference in this Form S-4 Registration Statement of our report
dated February 24, 1998 included in Interpool, Inc.'s Form 10-K for the year
ended December 31, 1997, and to all references to our firm included in or made
a part of this registration statement.


/s/ Arthur Andersen LLP

Arthur Andersen LLP

New York, New York
June 2, 1998


                                                               Exhibit 25.1

                                  UNITED STATES
                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             WASHINGTON, D. C. 20549
                           --------------------------
                                    FORM T-1

            STATEMENT OF ELIGIBILITY UNDER THE TRUST INDENTURE ACT OF
               1939 OF A CORPORATION DESIGNATED TO ACT AS TRUSTEE
                              =====================

                      CHECK IF AN APPLICATION TO DETERMINE
                      ELIGIBILITY OF A TRUSTEE PURSUANT TO
                            SECTION 305(b)(2) _______
                              =====================

                 UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY OF NEW YORK (Exact
                  name of trustee as specified in its charter)

      NEW YORK                                          13-3818954
  (Jurisdiction of incorporation                     (I. R. S. Employer
  if not a U. S. national bank)                      Identification No.)

      114 WEST 47TH STREET
      NEW YORK, NEW YORK                                    10036-1532
    (Address of principal                                   (Zip Code)
    executive offices)

                                      NONE
            (Name, address and telephone number of agent for service)
                            ========================

                                 INTERPOOL, INC.
               (Exact name of obligor as specified in its charter)


      DELAWARE                                            13-3467669
 (State or other jurisdiction of                     (I. R. S. Employer
  incorporation or organization)                     Identification No.)

      211 COLLEGE ROAD EAST
            SUITE 180
      PRINCETON, NEW JERSEY                                08540
 (Address of principal executive offices)               ( Zip Code)


                              6 5/8% NOTES DUE 2003
                       (Title of the indenture securities)

<PAGE>

                                     GENERAL

1.   GENERAL INFORMATION

     FURNISH THE FOLLOWING INFORMATION AS TO THE TRUSTEE:

     (a) NAME AND ADDRESS OF EACH EXAMINING OR SUPERVISING AUTHORITY TO WHICH 
IT IS SUBJECT.

       FEDERAL RESERVE BANK OF NEW YORK (2ND DISTRICT), NEW YORK, NEW YORK
             (BOARD OF GOVERNORS OF THE FEDERAL RESERVE SYSTEM)
             FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION, WASHINGTON, D.C.
             NEW YORK STATE BANKING DEPARTMENT, ALBANY, NEW YORK

     (b) WHETHER IT IS AUTHORIZED TO EXERCISE CORPORATE TRUST POWERS.

             THE TRUSTEE IS AUTHORIZED TO EXERCISE CORPORATE TRUST POWERS.

2.   AFFILIATIONS WITH THE OBLIGOR

     IF THE OBLIGOR IS AN AFFILIATE OF THE TRUSTEE, DESCRIBE EACH SUCH
AFFILIATION.

             NONE

3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 AND 15:

     THE OBLIGOR IS CURRENTLY NOT IN DEFAULT UNDER ANY OF ITS OUTSTANDING
     SECURITIES FOR WHICH UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY OF NEW YORK IS TRUSTEE.
     ACCORDINGLY, RESPONSES TO ITEMS 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 AND
     15 OF FORM T-1 ARE NOT REQUIRED UNDER GENERAL INSTRUCTION B.


16.      LIST OF EXHIBITS

     T-1.1        --       ORGANIZATION CERTIFICATE, AS AMENDED, ISSUED
                           BY THE  STATE OF NEW YORK BANKING DEPARTMENT
                           TO TRANSACT  BUSINESS AS A TRUST COMPANY, IS
                           INCORPORATED BY  REFERENCE TO EXHIBIT T-1.1
                           TO FORM T-1 FILED ON  SEPTEMBER 15, 1995
                           WITH THE COMMISSION PURSUANT TO  THE TRUST
                           INDENTURE ACT OF 1939, AS AMENDED BY THE
                           TRUST INDENTURE REFORM ACT OF 1990
                           (REGISTRATION NO.  33-97056).

     T-1.2        --       INCLUDED IN EXHIBIT T-1.1.

     T-1.3        --       INCLUDED IN EXHIBIT T-1.1.

<PAGE>

16.  LIST OF EXHIBITS
     (CONT'D)

     T-1.4        --       THE BY-LAWS OF UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY
                           OF NEW  YORK, AS AMENDED, IS INCORPORATED BY
                           REFERENCE TO  EXHIBIT T-1.4 TO FORM T-1
                           FILED ON SEPTEMBER 15, 1995  WITH THE
                           COMMISSION PURSUANT TO THE TRUST INDENTURE
                           ACT OF 1939, AS AMENDED BY THE TRUST
                           INDENTURE REFORM  ACT OF 1990 (REGISTRATION
                           NO. 33-97056).

     T-1.6        --       THE CONSENT OF THE TRUSTEE REQUIRED BY
                           SECTION 321(B) OF THE TRUST INDENTURE ACT
                           OF 1939, AS AMENDED BY THE TRUST INDENTURE
                           REFORM ACT OF 1990.

     T-1.7        --       A COPY OF THE LATEST REPORT OF CONDITION OF
                           THE TRUSTEE  PURSUANT TO LAW OR THE
                           REQUIREMENTS OF ITS SUPERVISING  OR
                           EXAMINING AUTHORITY.

NOTE

AS OF JUNE 1, 1998, THE TRUSTEE HAD 2,999,020 SHARES OF COMMON STOCK
OUTSTANDING, ALL OF WHICH ARE OWNED BY ITS PARENT COMPANY, U.S. TRUST
CORPORATION. THE TERM "TRUSTEE" IN ITEM 2, REFERS TO EACH OF UNITED STATES TRUST
COMPANY OF NEW YORK AND ITS PARENT COMPANY, U. S. TRUST CORPORATION.

IN ANSWERING ITEM 2 IN THIS STATEMENT OF ELIGIBILITY AS TO MATTERS PECULIARLY
WITHIN THE KNOWLEDGE OF THE OBLIGOR OR ITS DIRECTORS, THE TRUSTEE HAS RELIED
UPON INFORMATION FURNISHED TO IT BY THE OBLIGOR AND WILL RELY ON INFORMATION TO
BE FURNISHED BY THE OBLIGOR AND THE TRUSTEE DISCLAIMS RESPONSIBILITY FOR THE
ACCURACY OR COMPLETENESS OF SUCH INFORMATION.

                               ------------------

PURSUANT TO THE REQUIREMENTS OF THE TRUST INDENTURE ACT OF 1939, THE TRUSTEE,
UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY OF NEW YORK, A CORPORATION ORGANIZED AND EXISTING
UNDER THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, HAS DULY CAUSED THIS STATEMENT OF
ELIGIBILITY TO BE SIGNED ON ITS BEHALF BY THE UNDERSIGNED, THEREUNTO DULY
AUTHORIZED, ALL IN THE CITY OF NEW YORK, AND STATE OF NEW YORK, ON THE 1ST OF
JUNE 1998.

UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY
         OF NEW YORK, TRUSTEE

BY: /S/ Gerard F. Ganey
        ---------------------
        GERARD F. GANEY
        SENIOR VICE PRESIDENT
<PAGE>


                                                                EXHIBIT T-1.6

        THE CONSENT OF THE TRUSTEE REQUIRED BY SECTION 321(B) OF THE ACT.

                     UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY OF NEW YORK
                              114 WEST 47TH STREET
                               NEW YORK, NY 10036


DECEMBER 19, 1997



SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
450 5TH STREET, N.W.
WASHINGTON, DC  20549

GENTLEMEN:

PURSUANT TO THE PROVISIONS OF SECTION 321(B) OF THE TRUST INDENTURE ACT OF 1939,
AS AMENDED BY THE TRUST INDENTURE REFORM ACT OF 1990, AND SUBJECT TO THE
LIMITATIONS SET FORTH THEREIN, UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY OF NEW YORK ("U.S.
TRUST") HEREBY CONSENTS THAT REPORTS OF EXAMINATIONS OF U.S. TRUST BY FEDERAL,
STATE, TERRITORIAL OR DISTRICT AUTHORITIES MAY BE FURNISHED BY SUCH AUTHORITIES
TO THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION UPON REQUEST THEREFOR.



VERY TRULY YOURS,


UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY
         OF NEW YORK



BY: /s/ Gerard F. Ganey
    ----------------------
    GERARD F. GANEY
    SENIOR VICE PRESIDENT

<PAGE>


                                                               EXHIBIT T-1.7
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                     UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY OF NEW YORK
                       CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CONDITION
                                 MARCH 31, 1998
                                ($ IN THOUSANDS)

ASSETS
<S>                                                       <C>           
CASH AND DUE FROM BANKS                                  $  303,692

SHORT-TERM INVESTMENTS                                      325,044

SECURITIES, AVAILABLE FOR SALE                              650,954

LOANS                                                     1,717,101
LESS:  ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES                           16,546
                                                       ------------
      NET LOANS                                           1,700,555
PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT                                       58,868
OTHER ASSETS                                                120,865
      Total Assets                                       $3,159,978

LIABILITIES
DEPOSITS:
      NON-INTEREST BEARING                               $  602,769
      INTEREST BEARING                                    1,955,571
                                                         ----------
         TOTAL DEPOSITS                                   2,558,340

SHORT-TERM CREDIT FACILITIES                                293,185
ACCOUNTS PAYABLE AND ACCRUED LIABILITIES                    136,396
      Total Liabilities                                  $2,987,921

STOCKHOLDER'S EQUITY
COMMON STOCK                                                 14,995
CAPITAL SURPLUS                                              49,541
RETAINED EARNINGS                                           105,214
UNREALIZED GAINS ON SECURITIES
     AVAILABLE FOR SALE (NET OF TAXES)                        2,307
                                                     --------------

Total Stockholder's Equity                                  172,057
    Total Liabilities and
     Stockholder's Equity                                $3,159,978
</TABLE>


I, RICHARD E. BRINKMANN, SENIOR VICE PRESIDENT & COMPTROLLER OF THE NAMED BANK
DO HEREBY DECLARE THAT THIS STATEMENT OF CONDITION HAS BEEN PREPARED IN
CONFORMANCE WITH THE INSTRUCTIONS ISSUED BY THE APPROPRIATE REGULATORY AUTHORITY
AND IS TRUE TO THE BEST OF MY KNOWLEDGE AND BELIEF.

RICHARD E. BRINKMANN, SVP & CONTROLLER

MAY 6, 1998



                                                                  Exhibit 99.1


                              LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL

                             TO TENDER FOR EXCHANGE
                              6-5/8% NOTES DUE 2003

                                       OF

                                 INTERPOOL, INC.

              PURSUANT TO THE PROSPECTUS DATED____________ __, 1998


===============================================================================
THE EXCHANGE OFFER AND WITHDRAWAL RIGHTS WILL EXPIRE AT 5:00 P.M., NEW YORK CITY
TIME, ON ______________, 1998 (THE "EXPIRATION DATE"), UNLESS THE EXCHANGE OFFER
IS EXTENDED, IN WHICH CASE THE TERM "EXPIRATION DATE" SHALL MEAN THE LATEST DATE
AND TIME TO WHICH THE EXCHANGE OFFER IS EXTENDED. TENDERS MAY BE WITHDRAWN AT
ANY TIME PRIOR TO 5:00 P.M., NEW YORK CITY TIME, ON THE EXPIRATION DATE.
===============================================================================


                             THE EXCHANGE AGENT IS:
                     UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY OF NEW YORK


BY REGISTERED OR               BY HAND:                BY OVERNIGHT COURIER:
CERTIFIED MAIL:

United States Trust          United States Trust        United States Trust
 Company of New York          Company of New York        Company of New York
P.O. Box 844                 111 Broadway               770 Broadway, 13th Fl.
Attn:  Corporate Trust       Lower Level                New York, NY  10003
       Services              Attn:  Corporate Trust     Attn:  Corporate Trust
       Cooper Station               Services                   Services
New York, NY 10276-0844      New York, NY 10006

                              CONFIRM BY TELEPHONE:
                                 1-800-548-6565

                            FACSIMILE TRANSMISSIONS:
                          (ELIGIBLE INSTITUTIONS ONLY)
                     United States Trust Company of New York
                                 (212) 420-6152
                         Attn: Corporate Trust Services

   DELIVERY OF THIS INSTRUMENT TO AN ADDRESS OTHER THAN AS SET FORTH ABOVE OR
       TRANSMISSION OF INSTRUCTIONS VIA A FACSIMILE NUMBER OTHER THAN THE
             ONE LISTED ABOVE WILL NOT CONSTITUTE A VALID DELIVERY.

    THE INSTRUCTIONS SET FORTH IN THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL SHOULD BE READ
           CAREFULLY BEFORE THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL IS COMPLETED.

<PAGE>

          The undersigned acknowledges receipt of the Prospectus dated
____________ __, 1998 (the "Prospectus"), of Interpool, Inc., a Delaware
corporation (the "Company"), and this Letter of Transmittal (the "Letter of
Transmittal"), which together with the Prospectus constitutes the Company's
offer (the "Exchange Offer") to exchange $1,000 principal amount of its 6-5/8%
Notes due 2003 (the "Exchange Notes") for each $1,000 principal amount of its
6-5/8% Notes due 2003 (the "Private Notes"). Recipients of the Prospectus should
read the requirements described in such Prospectus with respect to eligibility
to participate in the Exchange Offer. Capitalized terms used but not defined
herein have the meaning given to them in the Prospectus.

          The undersigned hereby tenders the Private Notes described in the box
entitled "Description of Private Notes" below pursuant to the terms and
conditions described in the Prospectus and this Letter of Transmittal. The
undersigned is the registered owner of all the Private Notes and the undersigned
represents that it has received from each beneficial owner of Private Notes
("Beneficial Owners") a duly completed and executed form of "Instruction to
Registered Holder from Beneficial Owner" accompanying this Letter of
Transmittal, instructing the undersigned to take the action described in this
Letter of Transmittal.

          This Letter of Transmittal is to be used only by a holder of Private
Notes (i) if certificates representing Private Notes are to be forwarded
herewith or (ii) if delivery of Private Notes is to be made by book-entry
transfer to the Exchange Agent's account at The Depository Trust Company (the
"Depositary"), pursuant to the procedures set forth in the section of the
Prospectus entitled "The Exchange Offer -- Procedures for Tendering." If
delivery of the Private Notes is to be made by book-entry transfer to the
account maintained by the Exchange Agent at the Depositary, this Letter of
Transmittal need not be manually executed; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that tenders of
the Private Notes must be effected in accordance with the procedures mandated by
the Depositary's Automated Tender Offer Program and the procedures set forth in
the Prospectus under the caption "The Exchange Offer -- Book-Entry Transfer."

          Any beneficial owner whose Private Notes are registered in the name of
a broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company or other nominee and who wishes
to tender should contact such registered holder of Private Notes promptly and
instruct such registered holder of Private Notes to tender on behalf of the
beneficial owner. If such beneficial owner wishes to tender on its own behalf,
such beneficial owner must, prior to completing and executing this Letter of
Transmittal and delivering its Private Notes, either make appropriate
arrangements to register ownership of the Private Notes in such beneficial
owner's name or obtain a properly completed bond power from the registered
holder of Private Notes. The transfer of record ownership may take considerable
time.

          In order to properly complete this Letter of Transmittal, a holder of
Private Notes must (i) complete the box entitled "Description of Private Notes,"
(ii) if appropriate, check and complete the boxes relating to book-entry
transfer, guaranteed delivery, Special Issuance Instructions and Special
Delivery Instructions, (iii) sign the Letter of Transmittal by completing the
box entitled "Sign Here" and (iv) complete the Substitute Form W-9. Each holder
of Private Notes should carefully read the detailed instructions below prior to
completing the Letter of Transmittal.

          Holders of Private Notes who desire to tender their Private Notes for
exchange and (i) whose Private Notes are not immediately available, (ii) who
cannot deliver their Private Notes and all other documents required hereby to
the Exchange Agent on or prior to the Expiration Date or (iii) who are unable to
complete the procedure for book-entry transfer on a timely basis, must tender
the Private Notes pursuant to the guaranteed delivery procedures set forth in
the section of the Prospectus entitled "The Exchange Offer -- Guaranteed
Delivery Procedures." See Instruction 2 of the Instructions beginning on page 9
hereof.

          Holders of Private Notes who wish to tender their Private Notes for
exchange must, at a minimum, complete columns (1), (2), if applicable (see
footnote 1 below), and (3) in the box below entitled "Description of Private
Notes" and sign the box on page 8 under the words "Sign Here." If only those
columns are completed, such holder of Private Notes will have tendered for
exchange all Private Notes listed in column (3) below. If the holder of Private
Notes wishes to tender for exchange less than all of such Private Notes, column
(4) must be completed in full. In such case, such holder of Private Notes should
refer to Instruction 5 on page 10.

<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
===============================================================================
                          DESCRIPTION OF PRIVATE NOTES
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                   (1)                               (2)                         (3)                          (4)

<S>                                                   <C>                         <C>                          <C>
  Name(s) and Address(es) of                                                                              Principal Amount
Registered Holder(s) of Private                                                                         Tendered For Exchange
  Note(s), exactly as name(s)                    Private Note                                             (only if different
  appear(s) on Private Note                     Number(s) (1)                                             amount from column
        Certificate(s)                          (Attach signed            Aggregate Principal         (3)) (must be in integral
  (Please fill in, if blank)                  (List if necessary)              Amount                  multiples of $1,000) (2)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                         ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(1)  Column (2) need not be completed by holders of Private Notes tendering Private Notes for exchange by book-entry transfer.
     Please check the appropriate box on the next page and provide the requested information.
(2)  Column (4) need not be completed by holders of Private Notes who wish to tender for exchange the principal amount of
     Private Notes listed in Column (3).  Completion of column (4) will indicate that the holder of Private Notes wishes to
      tender for exchange only the principal amount of Private Notes indicated in column (4).
==================================================================================================================================
</TABLE>

___       CHECK HERE IF TENDERED PRIVATE NOTES ARE ENCLOSED HEREWITH.

___       CHECK HERE IF TENDERED PRIVATE NOTES ARE BEING DELIVERED BY BOOK-ENTRY
          TRANSFER MADE TO THE ACCOUNT MAINTAINED BY THE EXCHANGE AGENT WITH THE
          DEPOSITARY AND COMPLETE THE FOLLOWING (FOR USE BY ELIGIBLE
          INSTITUTIONS (AS HEREINAFTER DEFINED) ONLY):

          Name of Tendering Institution: --------------------------------------
          Account Number:------------------------------------------------------
          Transaction Code Number:---------------------------------------------

___       CHECK HERE IF TENDERED PRIVATE NOTES ARE BEING DELIVERED PURSUANT TO A
          NOTICE OF GUARANTEED DELIVERY ENCLOSED HEREWITH AND COMPLETE THE
          FOLLOWING (FOR USE BY ELIGIBLE INSTITUTIONS ONLY):

          Name of Registered Holder of Private Note(s):------------------------
          Date of Execution of Notice of Guaranteed Delivery:------------------
          Window Ticket Number (if available):---------------------------------
          Name of Institution with Guaranteed Delivery:------------------------
          Account Number (if delivered by book-entry transfer):----------------

___       CHECK HERE IF YOU ARE A BROKER-DEALER AND WISH TO RECEIVE 10
          ADDITIONAL COPIES OF THE PROSPECTUS AND 10 COPIES OF ANY AMENDMENTS OR
          SUPPLEMENTS THERETO.

          Name:----------------------------------------------------------------
          Address:-------------------------------------------------------------
                  -------------------------------------------------------------

<PAGE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
<S>                                                                                 <C>
=====================================================            ======================================================
           SPECIAL ISSUANCE INSTRUCTIONS                                         SPECIAL DELIVERY INSTRUCTIONS
         (See Instructions 1, 6, 7 and 8)                                      (See Instructions 1, 6, 7 and 8)
To be completed ONLY (i) if the Exchange                           To be completed ONLY if the Exchange Notes issed
Notes issued in exchange for Private Notes,                        in exchange for Private Notes in a principal amount 
certificates for Private Notes in a principal                      not exchanged for Exchange Notes (if any) not tendered
amount not exchanged for Exchange Notes or                         for exchange, are to be mailed or delivered (i) to 
Private Notes (if any) not tendered for                            someone other than the undersigned, or (ii) to the 
exchange, are to be issued in the name of                          undersigned at an address other than the address 
someone other than the undersigned, or (ii)                        shown below the undersigned's signature.
if Private Notes tendered by book-entry
transfer which are not exchanged are to be
returned by credit to an account maintained
at the Depositary.
Issue to:                                                          Mail or deliver to:
Name------------------------------------------                     Name------------------------------------------
                   (Please Print)                                                     (Please Print)
Address---------------------------------------                     Address---------------------------------------
- ----------------------------------------------                     ----------------------------------------------
- ----------------------------------------------                     ----------------------------------------------
                 (Include Zip Code)                                                (Include Zip Code)

- ----------------------------------------------                     ----------------------------------------------
         (Tax Identification or                                             (Tax Identification or 
            Social Security No.)                                               Social Security No.)

___  Credit Private Notes not exchanged and
     delivered by book-entry transfer to
     the Depositary account set forth below:

- ---------------------------------------------
               (Account Number)
=====================================================            ======================================================
</TABLE>

          If delivery of Private Notes is to be made by book-entry transfer to
the account maintained by the Exchange Agent at the Depositary, then tenders of
Private Notes must be effected in accordance with the procedures mandated by the
Depositary's Automated Tender Offer Program and the procedures set forth in the
Prospectus under the caption "The Exchange Offer -- Book-Entry Transfer."

<PAGE>

                        SIGNATURES MUST BE PROVIDED BELOW
               PLEASE READ THE ACCOMPANYING INSTRUCTIONS CAREFULLY

LADIES AND GENTLEMEN:

          Pursuant to the offer by Interpool, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the
"Company"), upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in the
Prospectus dated ________ __, 1998 (the "Prospectus") and this Letter of
Transmittal (the "Letter of Transmittal"), which together with the Prospectus
constitutes the Company's offer (the "Exchange Offer") to exchange $1,000
principal amount of its 6-5/8% Notes due 2003 (the "Exchange Notes") for each
$1,000 principal amount of its outstanding 6-5/8% Notes due 2003 (the "Private
Notes"), the undersigned hereby tenders to the Company for exchange the Private
Notes.

          By executing this Letter of Transmittal and subject to and effective
upon acceptance for exchange of the Private Notes tendered for exchange
herewith, the undersigned (A) acknowledges and agrees that, except as set forth
in the Prospectus under the caption "The Exchange Offer--Termination of Certain
Rights", all of the rights of such undersigned pursuant to that certain
Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of February 24, 1998 between Interpool,
Inc. and the Initial Purchaser (as defined in the Prospectus), will have been
satisfied and extinguished in all respects and (B) will have irrevocably sold,
assigned, transferred and exchanged, to the Company, all right, title and
interest in, to and under all of the Private Notes tendered for exchange hereby,
and hereby appoints the Exchange Agent as the true and lawful agent and
attorney-in-fact (with full knowledge that the Exchange Agent also acts as agent
of the Company) of such holder of Private Notes with respect to such Private
Notes, with full power of substitution to (i) deliver certificates representing
such Private Notes, or transfer ownership of such Private Notes on the account
books maintained by the Depositary (together, in any such case, with all
accompanying evidences of transfer and authenticity), to the Company, (ii)
present and deliver such Private Notes for transfer on the books of the Company
and (iii) receive all benefits and otherwise exercise all rights and incidents
of beneficial ownership with respect to such Private Notes, all in accordance
with the terms of the Exchange Offer. The power of attorney granted in this
paragraph shall be deemed to be irrevocable and coupled with an interest.

          The undersigned hereby represents and warrants that (i) the
undersigned is the owner; (ii) has a net long position within the meaning of
Rule 14e-4 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended ("Rule 14e-4")
equal to or greater than the principal amount of Private Notes tendered hereby;
(iii) the tender of such Private Notes complies with Rule 14e-4 (to the extent
that Rule 14e-4 is applicable to such exchange); (iv) the undersigned has full
power and authority to tender, exchange, assign and transfer the Private Notes;
and (v) that when such Private Notes are accepted for exchange by the Company,
the Company will acquire good and marketable title thereto, free and clear of
all liens, restrictions, charges and encumbrances and not subject to any adverse
claims. The undersigned will, upon receipt, execute and deliver any additional
documents deemed by the Exchange Agent or the Company to be necessary or
desirable to complete the exchange, assignment and transfer of the Private Notes
tendered for exchange hereby.

          The undersigned hereby further represents to the Company that (i) the
Exchange Notes to be acquired by the undersigned in exchange for the Private
Notes tendered hereby and any beneficial owner(s) of such Private Notes in
connection with the Exchange Offer will be acquired by the undersigned and such
beneficial owner(s) in the ordinary course of business of the undersigned, (ii)
the undersigned (if not a broker-dealer referred to in the last sentence of this
paragraph) are not engaging and do not intend to engage in the distribution of
the Exchange Notes, (iii) the undersigned have no arrangement or understanding
with any person to participate in the distribution of the Exchange Notes, (iv)
the undersigned and each beneficial owner acknowledge and agree that any person
participating in the Exchange Offer for the purpose of distributing the Exchange
Notes must comply with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of
the Securities Act in connection with a secondary resale transaction of the
Exchange Notes acquired by such person and cannot rely on the position of the
staff of the Commission set forth in certain no-action letters, (v) the
undersigned and each beneficial owner understand that a secondary resale
transaction described in clause (iv) above should be covered by an effective
registration statement containing the selling security holder information
required by Item 507 of Regulation S-K of the Commission and (vi) neither the
undersigned nor any beneficial owner is an "affiliate" of the Company, as
defined under Rule 405 under the Securities Act. If the undersigned is a
broker-dealer that will receive Exchange Notes for its own account in exchange
for Private Notes that were acquired as a result of market making activities or
other trading activities, it acknowledges that it will deliver a prospectus
meeting the requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any resale of
such Exchange Notes received in respect of such Private Notes pursuant to the
Exchange Offer; however, by so acknowledging and by delivering a prospectus, the
undersigned will not be deemed to admit that it is an "underwriter" within the
meaning of the Securities Act.

          For purposes of the Exchange Offer, the Company will be deemed to have
accepted for exchange, and to have exchanged, validly tendered Private Notes,
if, as and when the Company gives oral or written notice thereof to the Exchange
Agent. Tenders of Private Notes for exchange may be withdrawn at any time prior
to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the Expiration Date. See "The Exchange
Offer -- Withdrawal of Tenders" in the Prospectus. Any Private Notes tendered by
the undersigned and not accepted for exchange will be returned to the
undersigned at the address set forth above unless otherwise indicated in the box
above entitled "Special Delivery Instructions."

          The undersigned acknowledges that the Company's acceptance of Private
Notes validly tendered for exchange pursuant to any one of the procedures
described in the section of the Prospectus entitled "The Exchange Offer" and in
the instructions hereto will constitute a binding agreement between the
undersigned and the Company upon the terms and subject to the conditions of the
Exchange Offer.

          Unless otherwise indicated in the box entitled "Special Issuance
Instructions," please return any Private Notes not tendered for exchange in the
name(s) of the undersigned. Similarly, unless otherwise indicated in the box
entitled "Special Delivery Instructions," please mail any certificates for
Private Notes not tendered or exchanged (and accompanying documents, as
appropriate) to the undersigned at the address shown below the undersigned's
signature(s). In the event that both "Special Issuance Instructions" and
"Special Delivery Instructions" are completed, please issue the certificates
representing the Exchange Notes issued in exchange for the Private Notes
accepted for exchange in the name(s) of, and return any Private Notes not
tendered for exchange or not exchanged to, the person(s) so indicated. The
undersigned recognizes that the Company has no obligation pursuant to the
"Special Issuance Instructions" and "Special Delivery Instructions" to transfer
any Private Notes from the name of the holder of Private Note(s) thereof if the
Company does not accept for exchange any of the Private Notes so tendered for
exchange or if such transfer would not be in compliance with any transfer
restrictions applicable to such Private Note(s).

          IN ORDER TO VALIDLY TENDER PRIVATE NOTES FOR EXCHANGE, HOLDERS OF
PRIVATE NOTES MUST COMPLETE, EXECUTE, AND DELIVER THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL.

          Except as stated in the Prospectus, all authority herein conferred or
agreed to be conferred shall survive the death or incapacity of the undersigned,
and any obligation of the undersigned hereunder shall be binding upon the heirs,
personal representatives, successors and assigns of the undersigned. Except as
otherwise stated in the Prospectus, this tender for exchange of Private Notes is
irrevocable.

<PAGE>

===============================================================================
                                   SIGN HERE
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                           (Signature(s) of Owner(s))
Date:                  , 1998
Must be signed by the registered holder(s) of Private Notes exactly as name(s)
appear(s) on certificate(s) representing the Private Notes or on a security
position listing or by person(s) authorized to become registered Private Note
holder(s) by certificates and documents transmitted herewith. If signature is by
trustees, executors, administrators, guardians, attorneys-in-fact, officers of
corporations or others acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, please
provide the following information. (See Instruction 6).
Name(s):-----------------------------------------------------------------------
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                 (Please Print)

Capacity (full title):---------------------------------------------------------
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Address:-----------------------------------------------------------------------
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                               (Include Zip Code)
Area Code and Telephone No. (___)----------------------------------------------
Tax Identification or Social Security Nos.:------------------------------------
Please complete Substitute Form W-9
                            GUARANTEE OF SIGNATURE(S)
         (Signature(s) must be guaranteed if required by Instruction 1)
Authorized Signature:----------------------------------------------------------
Dated:-------------------------------------------------------------------------
Name and Title:----------------------------------------------------------------
                                 (Please Print)

Name of Firm:------------------------------------------------------------------

===============================================================================

<PAGE>

                                  INSTRUCTIONS

         FORMING PART OF THE TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER

          1. GUARANTEE OF SIGNATURES. Except as otherwise provided below, all
signatures on this Letter of Transmittal must be guaranteed by an institution
which is an "eligible guarantor institution" within the meaning of Rule 17Ad-15
under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, which is a member of one
of the following recognized Signature Guarantee Programs (an "Eligible
Institution"):

          a. The Securities Transfer Agents Medallion Program (STAMP)
          b. The New York Stock Exchange Medallion Signature Program (MSP)
          c. The Stock Exchange Medallion Program (SEMP)

Signatures on this Letter of Transmittal need not be guaranteed (i) if this
Letter of Transmittal is signed by the registered holder(s) of the Private Notes
tendered herewith and such registered holder(s) have not completed the box
entitled "Special Issuance Instructions" or the box entitled "Special Delivery
Instructions" on this Letter of Transmittal or (ii) if such Private Notes are
tendered for the account of an Eligible Institution. IN ALL OTHER CASES, ALL
SIGNATURES MUST BE GUARANTEED BY AN ELIGIBLE INSTITUTION.

          2. DELIVERY OF THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL AND PRIVATE NOTES;
GUARANTEED DELIVERY PROCEDURE. This Letter of Transmittal is to be completed by
holders of Private Notes (i) if certificates are to be forwarded herewith or
(ii) if tenders are to be made pursuant to the procedures for tender by
book-entry transfer or guaranteed delivery set forth in the section of the
Prospectus entitled "The Exchange Offer." Certificates for all physically
tendered Private Notes or any confirmation of a book-entry transfer (a
"Book-Entry Confirmation"), as well as a properly completed and duly executed
copy of this Letter of Transmittal or facsimile hereof, and any other documents
required by this Letter of Transmittal, must be received by the Exchange Agent
at its address set forth on the cover of this Letter of Transmittal prior to
5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the Expiration Date. Holders of Private Notes
who elect to tender Private Notes and (i) whose Private Notes are not
immediately available, (ii) who cannot deliver the Private Notes or other
required documents to the Exchange Agent prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time
on the Expiration Date or (iii) who are unable to complete the procedure for
book-entry transfer on a timely basis, may have such tender effected if: (a)
such tender is made by or through an Eligible Institution; (b) prior to 5:00
p.m., New York time, on the Expiration Date, the Exchange Agent has received
from such Eligible Institution a properly completed and duly executed Letter of
Transmittal (or a facsimile hereof) and Notice of Guaranteed Delivery (by
telegram, telex, facsimile transmission, mail or hand delivery) setting forth
the name and address of the holder of such Private Notes, the certificate
number(s) of such Private Notes and the principal amount of Private Notes
tendered for exchange, stating that tender is being made thereby and
guaranteeing that, within five New York Stock Exchange trading days after the
Expiration Date, the certificates representing such Private Notes (or a
Book-Entry Confirmation), in proper form for transfer, and any other documents
required by this Letter of Transmittal, will be deposited by such Eligible
Institution with the Exchange Agent; and (c) certificates for all tendered
Private Notes, or a Book-Entry Confirmation, together with a copy of the
previously executed Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile thereof) and any other
documents required by this Letter of Transmittal are received by the Exchange
Agent within five New York Stock Exchange trading days after the Expiration
Date.

          THE METHOD OF DELIVERY OF PRIVATE NOTES, THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL
AND ALL OTHER REQUIRED DOCUMENTS IS AT THE ELECTION AND RISK OF THE TENDERING
HOLDER OF PRIVATE NOTES. EXCEPT AS OTHERWISE PROVIDED BELOW, THE DELIVERY WILL
BE DEEMED MADE ONLY WHEN ACTUALLY RECEIVED OR CONFIRMED BY THE EXCHANGE AGENT.
IF DELIVERY IS BY MAIL, REGISTERED MAIL WITH RETURN RECEIPT REQUESTED, PROPERLY
INSURED, IS RECOMMENDED. NEITHER THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL NOR ANY PRIVATE
NOTES SHOULD BE SENT TO THE COMPANY.

<PAGE>

          No alternative, conditional or contingent tenders will be accepted.
All tendering holders of Private Notes, by execution of this Letter of
Transmittal (or facsimile hereof, if applicable), waive any right to receive
notice of the acceptance of their Private Notes for exchange.

          3. INADEQUATE SPACE. If the space provided in the box entitled
"Description of Private Notes" above is inadequate, the certificate numbers and
principal amounts of the Private Notes being tendered should be listed on a
separate signed schedule affixed hereto.

          4. WITHDRAWALS. A tender of Private Notes may be withdrawn at any time
prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the Expiration Date by delivery of
written notice of withdrawal to the Exchange Agent at the address set forth on
the cover of this Letter of Transmittal. To be effective, a notice of withdrawal
of Private Notes must (i) specify the name of the person who tendered the
Private Notes to be withdrawn (the "Depositor"), (ii) identify the Private Notes
to be withdrawn (including the certificate number or numbers and aggregate
principal amount of such Private Notes), (iii) be signed by the holder of
Private Notes in the same manner as the original signature on the Letter of
Transmittal by which such Private Notes were tendered (including any required
signature guarantees) or be accompanied by documents of transfer sufficient to
have the applicable transfer agent register the transfer of such Private Notes
into the name of the person withdrawing the tender. Withdrawals of tenders of
Private Notes may not be rescinded, and any Private Notes withdrawn will
thereafter be deemed not validly tendered for purposes of the Exchange Offer and
no Exchange Notes will be issued with respect thereto unless the Private Notes
so withdrawn are validly retendered. Properly withdrawn Private Notes may be
retendered by following one of the procedures described in the section of the
Prospectus entitled "The Exchange Offer -- Procedures for Tendering" at any time
prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the Expiration Date.

          5. PARTIAL TENDERS. (Not applicable to holders of Private Notes who
tender Private Notes by book-entry transfer.) Tenders of Private Notes will be
accepted only in integral multiples of $1,000 principal amount. If a tender for
exchange is to be made with respect to less than the entire principal amount of
any Private Notes, fill in the principal amount of Private Notes which are
tendered for exchange in column (4) of the box entitled "Description of Private
Notes" on page 3, as more fully described in the footnotes thereto. In case of a
partial tender for exchange, a new certificate, in fully registered form, for
the remainder of the principal amount of the Private Notes, will be sent to the
holders of Private Notes unless otherwise indicated in the appropriate box on
this Letter of Transmittal as promptly as practicable after the expiration or
termination of the Exchange Offer.

          6. SIGNATURES ON THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL, POWERS OF ATTORNEY AND
ENDORSEMENTS.

          (a) The signature(s) of the holder of Private Notes on this Letter of
Transmittal must correspond with the name(s) as written on the face of the
Private Notes without alternation, enlargement or any change whatsoever.

          (b) If tendered Private Notes are owned of record by two or more joint
owners, all such owners must sign this Letter of Transmittal.

          (c) If any tendered Private Notes are registered in different names on
several certificates, it will be necessary to complete, sign and submit as many
separate copies of this Letter of Transmittal and any necessary or required
documents as there are different registrations or certificates.

          (d) When this Letter of Transmittal is signed by the holder of the
Private Notes listed and transmitted hereby, no endorsements of Private Notes or
separate powers of attorney are required. If, however, Private Notes not
tendered or not accepted, are to be issued or returned in the name of a person
other than the holder of Private Notes, then the Private Notes transmitted
hereby must be endorsed or accompanied by appropriate powers of attorney in a
form satisfactory to the Company, in either case signed exactly as the name(s)
of the holder of Private Notes appear(s) on the Private Notes. Signatures on
such Private Notes or powers of attorney must be guaranteed by an Eligible
Institution (unless signed by an Eligible Institution).

          (e) If this Letter of Transmittal or Private Notes or powers of
attorney are signed by trustees, executors, administrators, guardians,
attorneys-in-fact, officers of corporations or others acting in a fiduciary or
representative capacity, such persons should so indicate when signing, and
proper evidence satisfactory to the Company of their authority so to act must be
submitted.

          (f) If this Letter of Transmittal is signed by a person other than the
registered holder of Private Notes listed, the Private Notes must be endorsed or
accompanied by appropriate powers of attorney, in either case signed exactly as
the name(s) of the registered holder of Private Notes appear(s) on the
certificates. Signatures on such Private Notes or powers of attorney must be
guaranteed by an Eligible Institution (unless signed by an Eligible
Institution).

          7. TRANSFER TAXES. Except as set forth in this Instruction 7, the
Company will pay all transfer taxes, if any, applicable to the transfer and
exchange of Private Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer. If, however, issuance
of Exchange Notes is to be made to, or Private Notes not tendered for exchange
are to be issued or returned in the name of, any person other than the holder of
Private Notes, and satisfactory evidence of payment of such taxes or exemptions
from taxes therefrom is not submitted with this Letter of Transmittal, the
amount of any transfer taxes payable on account of the transfer to such person
will be imposed on and payable by the holder of Private Notes tendering Private
Notes for exchange prior to the issuance of the Exchange Notes.

          8. SPECIAL ISSUANCE AND DELIVERY INSTRUCTIONS. If the Exchange Notes
are to be issued, or if any Private Notes not tendered for exchange are to be
issued or sent to someone other than the holder of Private Notes or to an
address other than that shown above, the appropriate boxes on this Letter of
Transmittal should be completed. Holders of Private Notes tendering Private
Notes by book-entry transfer may request that Private Notes not accepted be
credited to such account maintained at the Depositary as such holder of Private
Notes may designate.

          9. IRREGULARITIES. All questions as to the form of documents and the
validity, eligibility (including time of receipt), acceptance and withdrawal of
Private Notes will be determined by the Company, in its sole discretion, whose
determination shall be final and binding. The Company reserves the absolute
right to reject any or all tenders for exchange of any particular Private Notes
that are not in proper form, or the acceptance of which would, in the opinion of
the Company or its counsel, be unlawful. The Company reserves the absolute right
to waive any defect, irregularity or condition of tender for exchange with
regard to any particular Private Notes. The Company's interpretation of the term
of, and conditions to, the Exchange Offer (including the instructions herein)
will be final and binding. Unless waived, any defects or irregularities in
connection with the Exchange Offer must be cured within such time as the Company
shall determine. Neither the Company, the Exchange Agent nor any other person
shall be under any duty to give notice of any defects or irregularities in
Private Notes tendered for exchange, nor shall any of them incur any liability
for failure to give such notice. A tender of Private Notes will not be deemed to
have been made until all defects and irregularities with respect to such tender
have been cured or waived. Any Private Notes received by the Exchange Agent that
are not properly tendered and as to which the defects or irregularities have not
been cured or waived will be returned by the Exchange Agent to the tendering
holders, unless otherwise provided in this Letter of Transmittal, as soon as
practicable following the Expiration Date.

          10. WAIVER OF CONDITIONS. The Company reserves the absolute right to
waive, amend or modify certain of the specified conditions as described under
"The Exchange Offer -- Conditions of the Exchange Offer" in the Prospectus in
the case of any Private Notes tendered (except as otherwise provided in the
Prospectus).

          11. MUTILATED, LOST, STOLEN OR DESTROYED PRIVATE NOTES. If a holder of
Private Notes desires to tender Private Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer,
but any of such Private Notes has been mutilated, lost, stolen or destroyed,
such holder of Private Notes should write to or telephone the Trustee at the
address listed below, concerning the procedures for obtaining replacement
certificates for such Private Notes, arranging for indemnification or any other
matter that requires handling by the Trustee:

                     United States Trust Company of New York
                                  P.O. Box 844
                         Attn: Corporate Trust Services
                                 Cooper Station
                          New York, New York 10276-0844
                                 1-800-548-6565

          12. REQUESTS FOR INFORMATION OR ADDITIONAL COPIES. Requests for
information or for additional copies of the Prospectus and this Letter of
Transmittal may be directed to the Exchange Agent at the address or telephone
number set forth on the cover of this Letter of Transmittal.

          IMPORTANT: THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL (OR A FACSIMILE THEREOF, IF
APPLICABLE) TOGETHER WITH CERTIFICATES, OR CONFIRMATION OF BOOK-ENTRY OR THE
NOTICE OF GUARANTEED DELIVERY, AND ALL OTHER REQUIRED DOCUMENTS MUST BE RECEIVED
BY THE EXCHANGE AGENT PRIOR TO 5:00 P.M., NEW YORK CITY TIME, ON THE EXPIRATION
DATE.

<PAGE>

                            IMPORTANT TAX INFORMATION

          Under certain federal income tax law, a holder of Private Notes whose
tendered Private Notes are accepted for exchange may be subject to backup
withholding unless the holder provides the Company (as payor), through the
Exchange Agent, with either (i) such holder's correct taxpayer identification
number ("TIN") on Substitute Form W-9 attached hereto, certifying that the TIN
provided on Substitute Form W-9 is correct (or that such holder of Private Notes
is awaiting a TIN) and that (A) the holder of Private Notes has not been
notified by the Internal Revenue Service that he or she is subject to backup
withholding as a result of a failure to report all interest or dividends or (B)
the Internal Revenue Service has notified the holder of Private Notes that he or
she is no longer subject to backup withholding; or (ii) an adequate basis for
exemption from backup withholding. If such holder of Private Notes is an
individual, the TIN is such holder's social security number. If the Exchange
Agent is not provided with the correct taxpayer identification number, the
holder of Private Notes may be subject to certain penalties imposed by the
Internal Revenue Service.

          Certain holders of Private Notes (including, among others, all
corporations and certain foreign individuals) are not subject to these backup
withholding and reporting requirements. Exempt holders of Private Notes should
indicate their exempt status on Substitute Form W-9. A foreign individual may
qualify as an exempt recipient by submitting to the Exchange Agent a properly
completed Internal Revenue Service Form W-8 (the terms of which the Exchange
Agent will provide upon request) signed under penalty of perjury, attesting to
the holder's exempt status. See the enclosed Guidelines for Certification of
Taxpayer Identification Number on Substitute Form W-9 (the "Guidelines") for
additional instructions.

          If backup withholding applies, the Company is required to withhold 31%
of any payment made to the holder of Private Notes or other payee. Backup
withholding is not an additional federal income tax. Rather, the federal income
tax liability of persons subject to backup withholding will be reduced by the
amount of tax withheld. If withholding results in an overpayment of taxes, a
refund may be obtained from the Internal Revenue Service.

          The holder of Private Notes is required to give the Exchange Agent the
TIN (e.g., social security number or employer identification number) of the
record owner of the Private Notes. If the Private Notes are held in more than
one name or are not held in the name of the actual owner, consult the enclosed
Guidelines for additional guidance regarding which number to report.

<PAGE>

- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
               PAYER'S NAME:-------------------------------------
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SUBSTITUTE              Part 1 - PLEASE PROVIDE YOUR TIN     ------------------
Form W-9                IN THE BOX AT RIGHT AND CERTIFY      Social Security
Department of the       BY SIGNING AND DATING BELOW          Number
Treasury Internal                                            OR
Revenue Service                                              ------------------
Payer's Request                                              Employer
for Taxpayer                                                 Identification
Identification                                               Number
Number (TIN)           --------------------------------------------------------

                       Part 2-                               Part 3-
                       Certification Under Penalties         Awaiting
                       of Perjury, I certify that:           TIN
                      (1) The number shown on this
                          form is my current taxpayer
                          identification number
                          (or I am waiting for a
                          number to be issued to me)
                          and
                      (2) I am not subject to backup
                          withholding either because
                          I have not been notified by
                          the Internal Revenue Service
                          (the "IRS") that I am subject
                          to backup withholding as a 
                          result of a failure to report
                          all interest or dividends, or the
                          IRS has notified me that I am no
                          longer subject to backup withholding.
                       --------------------------------------------------------
                        Certificate instructions - You must cross out item (2)
                        in Part 2 above if you have been notified by the IRS
                        that you are subject to backup withholding because of
                        underreporting interest or dividends on your tax return.
                        However, if after being notified by the IRS that you are
                        subject to backup withholding you receive another
                        notification from the IRS stating that you are no longer
                        subject to backup withholding, do not cross out item
                        (2).
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SIGNATURE__________________________________________________DATE________________
NAME___________________________________________________________________________
ADDRESS________________________________________________________________________
CITY_____________________________ STATE_________________ ZIP CODE______________

- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

NOTE:     FAILURE TO COMPLETE AND RETURN THIS FORM MAY RESULT IN BACKUP
          WITHHOLDING OF 31% OF ANY PAYMENT MADE TO YOU PURSUANT TO THE EXCHANGE
          OFFER. PLEASE REVIEW THE ENCLOSED GUIDELINES FOR CERTIFICATION OF
          TAXPAYER IDENTIFICATION NUMBER ON SUBSTITUTE FORM W-9 FOR ADDITIONAL
          DETAILS.

<PAGE>

               YOU MUST COMPLETE THE FOLLOWING CERTIFICATE IF YOU
                 CHECK THE BOX IN PART 3 OF SUBSTITUTE FORM W-9

===============================================================================
                                  PAYOR'S NAME:
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
             CERTIFICATE OF AWAITING TAXPAYER IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

I certify under penalties of perjury that a taxpayer identification number has
not been issued to me, and either (a) I have mailed or delivered an application
to receive a taxpayer identification number to the appropriate Internal Revenue
Service Center or Social Security Administration Office or (b) I intend to mail
or deliver such an application in the near future. I understand that if I do not
provide a taxpayer identification number with sixty (60) days, 31% of all
reportable payments made to me thereafter will be withheld until I provide such
a number.
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Signature------------------------------------

Date-----------------------------------------
===============================================================================

                                                                Exhibit 99.2

                                 INTERPOOL, INC.

                                 EXCHANGE OFFER
                                TO HOLDERS OF ITS
                              6-5/8% NOTES DUE 2003

                          NOTICE OF GUARANTEED DELIVERY

     This form or one substantially equivalent hereto must be used to accept the
Exchange Offer of Interpool, Inc. (the "Company") made pursuant to the
Prospectus dated ____________ __, 1998 (the "Prospectus") and the accompanying
Letter of Transmittal, if certificates for the above-referenced Notes (the
"Private Notes") are not immediately available or time will not permit all
required documents to reach the Exchange Agent (as defined below) prior to the
Expiration Date (as defined in the Prospectus) of the Exchange Offer (as defined
below) or if the procedures for book-entry transfer cannot be completed on a
timely basis. Such form may be delivered by hand or transmitted by telegram,
facsimile transmission or mail to the Exchange Agent.

       To: UNITED STATES TRUST COMPANY OF NEW YORK (THE "EXCHANGE AGENT")

  BY REGISTERED OR                BY HAND:            BY OVERNIGHT COURIER:
  CERTIFIED MAIL:
 United States Trust         United States Trust      United States Trust 
   Company of New York        Company of New York      Company of New York 
   P.O. Box 844               111 Broadway             770 Broadway, 13th Floor
   Attn: Corporate Trust      Lower Level              New York, New York 10003
   Services                   Attn: Corporate Trust    Attn: Corporate Trust 
   Cooper Station             Services                 Services
   New York, New York         New York, New York 10006    
   10276-0844


                              CONFIRM BY TELEPHONE:
                                 1-800-548-6565

                            FACSIMILE TRANSMISSIONS:
                          (ELIGIBLE INSTITUTIONS ONLY)
                     United States Trust Company of New York
                                 (212) 420-6152
                         Attn: Corporate Trust Services



    DELIVERY OF THIS NOTICE OF GUARANTEED DELIVERY TO AN ADDRESS OTHER THAN
       AS SET FORTH ABOVE OR TRANSMISSION OF INSTRUCTIONS VIA A FACSIMILE
             TRANSMISSION TO A NUMBER OTHER THAN AS SET FORTH ABOVE
                     WILL NOT CONSTITUTE A VALID DELIVERY.

<PAGE>


Ladies and Gentlemen:


     The undersigned hereby tenders to the Company upon the terms and conditions
set forth in the Prospectus and the Letter of Transmittal (which together
constitute the "Exchange Offer"), receipt of which is hereby acknowledged, the
principal amount of Private Notes set forth below, pursuant to the guaranteed
delivery procedure described in the Prospectus and the Letter of Transmittal.

Signature(s) ________________________   Address ____________________________
_____________________________________   ____________________________________

Name(s)______________________________   Area Code and Tel.No.(s)____________
_____________________________________   If Private Notes will be delivered by 
Please Type or Print                    book-entry transfer, check box and
                                        provide account number.

Certificate Nos. (if available)______   / / The Depository Trust Company
                                        Account Number:_____________________
Principal Amount of Private Notes
Represented by Certificate(s)________________


                                    GUARANTEE

     The undersigned, member of a recognized signature guarantee medallion
program within the meaning of Rule 17Ad-15 under the Securities Exchange Act of
1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"), hereby guarantees (a) that the
above-named person(s) own(s) the above-described securities tendered hereby
within the meaning of Rule 10b-4 under the Exchange Act, (b) that such tender of
the above-described securities complies with Rule 10b-4 and (c) that delivery to
the Exchange Agent of certificates representing the principal amount of Private
Notes tendered hereby, in proper form for transfer, or timely confirmation of
the book-entry transfer of such Private Notes into the Exchange Agent's account
at the Depository Trust Company, in either case with a properly completed and
duly executed Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile thereof) with any required
signature guarantees and any other required documents, will be received by the
Exchange Agent at one of its addresses set forth above, no later than five New
York Stock Exchange trading days after the date of execution of this Notice of
Guaranteed Delivery.


_____________________________________     _____________________________________
         Name of Firm                           Authorized Signature

_____________________________________     _____________________________________
         Address                                Title

_____________________________________
         Zip Code                         Please Type or Print

Area Code and Tel. No. _______________    Dated________________________________




                                                               Exhibit 99.3


                                 INTERPOOL, INC.

                                OFFER TO EXCHANGE
                              6-5/8% NOTES DUE 2003
                           FOR ANY AND ALL OUTSTANDING
                              6-5/8% NOTES DUE 2003


                                                   ________________ __, 1998

TO SECURITIES DEALERS, COMMERCIAL BANKS,
TRUST COMPANIES AND OTHER NOMINEES:

     Interpool, Inc. (the "Company") is offering (the "Exchange Offer"), upon
the terms and subject to the conditions of the enclosed Prospectus, dated
________________ __, 1998 (as the same may be amended or supplemented from time
to time, the "Prospectus"), and the enclosed Letter of Transmittal (the "Letter
of Transmittal"), to exchange $1,000 principal amount of its 6-5/8% Notes due
2003 (the "Exchange Notes"), which exchange has been registered under the
Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"), for each $1,000
principal amount of its outstanding 6-5/8% Notes due 2003 (the "Private Notes"),
of which $100,000,000 aggregate principal amount was issued and sold on February
24, 1998 in a transaction exempt from registration under the Securities Act and
is outstanding on the date hereof. The Company will accept for exchange any and
all Private Notes properly tendered according to the terms of the Prospectus and
the Letter of Transmittal. Consummation of the Exchange Offer is subject to
certain conditions described in the Prospectus.

     WE ARE ASKING YOU TO CONTACT YOUR CLIENTS FOR WHOM YOU HOLD PRIVATE NOTES
REGISTERED IN YOUR NAME OR IN THE NAME OF YOUR NOMINEE OR WHO HOLD PRIVATE NOTES
REGISTERED IN THEIR OWN NAMES.

     The Company will not pay any fees or commissions to any broker or dealer or
other person for soliciting tenders of Private Notes pursuant to the Exchange
Offer. You will, however, be reimbursed by the Company for customary mailing and
handling expenses incurred by you in forwarding any of the enclosed materials to
your clients. The Company will pay all transfer taxes, if any, applicable to the
tender of Private Notes to it or its order, except as otherwise provided in the
Prospectus and the Letter of Transmittal.

         Enclosed are copies of the following documents:

         1.       A form of letter which you may send, as a cover letter to
                  accompany the Prospectus and related materials, to your
                  clients for whose accounts you hold Private Notes registered
                  in your name or the name of your nominee, with space provided
                  for obtaining the clients' instructions with regard to the
                  Exchange Offer.

         2.       The Prospectus.

         3.       The Letter of Transmittal for your use in connection with the
                  tender of Private Notes and for the information of your
                  clients.

         4.       A form of Notice of Guaranteed Delivery.

         5.       Guidelines for Certification of Taxpayer Identification Number
                  on Substitute Form W-9.

     Your prompt action is requested. The Exchange Offer will expire at 5:00
P.M., New York City time, on ________________ __, 1998, unless the Exchange
Offer is extended by the Company. The time at which the Exchange Offer expires
is referred to as the "Expiration Date." Tendered Private Notes may be
withdrawn, subject to the procedures described in the Prospectus, at any time
prior to 5:00 P.M. on the Expiration Date.

     To participate in the Exchange Offer, certificates for Private Notes, or a
timely confirmation of a book-entry transfer of such Private Notes into the
Exchange Agent's account at the Depository Trust Company, together with a duly
executed and properly completed Letter of Transmittal or facsimile thereof, with
any required signature guarantees, and any other required documents, must be
received by the Exchange Agent by the Expiration Date as indicated in the Letter
of Transmittal and the Prospectus.

     If holders of the Private Notes wish to tender, but it is impracticable for
them to forward their Private Notes prior to the Expiration Date or to comply
with the book-entry transfer procedures on a timely basis, a tender may be
effected by following the guaranteed delivery procedures described in the
Prospectus under "The Exchange Offer -- Guaranteed Delivery Procedures" and the
Letter of Transmittal.

     Additional copies of the enclosed material may be obtained from the
Exchange Agent, United States Trust Company of New York, by calling (800)
548-6565 directing your inquiries to Corporate Trust Services.

                                                 Very truly yours,

                                                 INTERPOOL, INC.


     NOTHING HEREIN OR IN THE ENCLOSED DOCUMENTS SHALL CONSTITUTE YOU OR ANY
PERSON AS AN AGENT OF THE COMPANY OR THE EXCHANGE AGENT, OR AUTHORIZE YOU OR ANY
OTHER PERSON TO MAKE ANY STATEMENTS ON BEHALF OF EITHER OF THEM WITH RESPECT TO
THE EXCHANGE OFFER, EXCEPT FOR STATEMENTS EXPRESSLY MADE IN THE PROSPECTUS AND
THE LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL.



                                                         Exhibit 99.4


                                 INTERPOOL, INC.

                                OFFER TO EXCHANGE
                              6-5/8% NOTES DUE 2003
                           FOR ANY AND ALL OUTSTANDING
                              6-5/8% NOTES DUE 2003

                                                     ______________ __, 1998

TO OUR CLIENTS:

     Enclosed for your consideration is a Prospectus, dated ____________ __,
1998 (as the same may be amended or supplemented from time to time, the
"Prospectus"), and a Letter of Transmittal (the "Letter of Transmittal"),
relating to the offer (the "Exchange Offer") by Interpool, Inc. (the "Company")
to exchange $1,000 principal amount of its 6-5/8% Notes due 2003 (the "Exchange
Notes"), which exchange has been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended (the "Securities Act"), for each $1,000 principal amount of its
outstanding 6 -5/8% Notes due 2003 (the "Private Notes"), of which $100,000,000
aggregate principal amount was issued and sold on February 24, 1998 in a
transaction exempt from registration under the Securities Act and is outstanding
on the date hereof. The Company will accept for exchange any and all Private
Notes properly tendered according to the terms of the Prospectus and the Letter
of Transmittal. Consummation of the Exchange Offer is subject to certain
conditions described in the Prospectus.

     This material is being forwarded to you as the beneficial owner of Private
Notes carried by us for your account or benefit but not registered in your name.
A tender of such Private Notes may only be made by us as the registered holder
and pursuant to your instructions. Therefore, the Company urges beneficial
owners of Private Notes registered in the name of a broker, dealer, commercial
bank, trust company or other nominee to contact such registered holder promptly
if such beneficial owners wish to tender Private Notes in the Exchange Offer.

     Accordingly, we request instructions as to whether you wish us to tender
any or all such Private Notes held by us for your account, pursuant to the terms
and conditions set forth in the enclosed Prospectus and Letter of Transmittal.
However, we urge you to read the Prospectus carefully before instructing us as
to whether or not to tender your Private Notes.

     Your instructions to us should be forwarded as promptly as possible in
order to permit us to tender Private Notes on your behalf in accordance with the
provisions of the Exchange Offer. The Exchange Offer will expire at 5:00 P.M.,
New York City Time, on ____________ __, 1998, unless the Exchange Offer is
extended by the Company. The time the Exchange Offer expires is referred to as
the "Expiration Date." Tenders of Private Notes may be withdrawn at any time
prior to the Expiration Date.

     IF YOU WISH TO HAVE US TENDER ANY OR ALL OF YOUR PRIVATE NOTES, PLEASE SO
INSTRUCT US BY COMPLETING, EXECUTING AND RETURNING TO US THE INSTRUCTION FORM ON
THE REVERSE HEREOF. The accompanying Letter of Transmittal is furnished to you
for your information only and may not be used by you to tender Private Notes
held by us and registered in our name for your account or benefit.

     If we do not receive written instructions in accordance with the procedures
presented in the Prospectus and the Letter of Transmittal, we will not tender
any of the Private Notes on your account.

     Please carefully review the enclosed material as you consider the Exchange
Offer.

<PAGE>

                                  INSTRUCTIONS

                        INSTRUCTION TO REGISTERED HOLDER
                              FROM BENEFICIAL OWNER
                                       OF
                              6-5/8% NOTES DUE 2003
                               OF INTERPOOL, INC.

     The undersigned hereby acknowledges receipt of the Prospectus dated
________ __, 1998 (the "Prospectus") of Interpool, Inc., a Delaware corporation
(the "Company") and the accompanying Letter of Transmittal (the "Letter of
Transmittal"), that together constitute the exchange offer by the Company (the
"Exchange Offer"). Capitalized terms used but not defined herein have the
meanings ascribed to them in the Prospectus.

     This will instruct you, the registered holder, as to the action to be taken
by you relating to the Exchange Offer with respect to the 6- 5/8% Notes due 2003
(the "Private Notes") held by you for the account of the undersigned.

     The aggregate face amount of the Private Notes held by you for the account
of the undersigned is (FILL IN AMOUNT):

     $_____________________ of the Private Notes.

     With respect to the Exchange Offer, the undersigned hereby instructs you
(CHECK APPROPRIATE BOX):

/ /   To TENDER the following Private Notes held by you for the account of the
undersigned (INSERT PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF PRIVATE NOTES TO BE TENDERED, IF ANY):

     $_____________________ of the Private Notes.

/ /   NOT to TENDER any Private Notes held by you for the account of the
undersigned.

     If the undersigned instructs you to tender the Private Notes held by you
for the account of the undersigned, it is understood that you are authorized (a)
to make, on behalf of the undersigned (and the undersigned, by its signature
below, hereby makes to you), the representations and warranties contained in the
Letter of Transmittal that are to be made with respect to the undersigned as a
beneficial owner of the Private Notes, including but not limited to the
representations that (i) the undersigned is acquiring the Exchange Notes in the
ordinary course of business of the undersigned, (ii) the undersigned is not
participating, does not intend to participate, and has no arrangement or
understanding with any person to participate, in the distribution of Exchange
Notes, (iii) the undersigned acknowledges that any person participating in the
Exchange Offer for the purpose of distributing the Exchange Notes must comply
with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act
of 1933, as amended, in connection with any resale transaction of the Exchange
Notes acquired by such person and cannot rely on the position of the Staff of
the Securities and Exchange Commission set forth in certain no-action letters
(See the section of the Prospectus entitled "The Exchange Offer C Resale of the
Exchange Notes"), (iv) the undersigned understands that a secondary resale
transaction described in clause (iii) above should be covered by an effective
registration statement containing the selling securityholder information
required by Item 507 of Regulation S-K of the Commission, (v) the undersigned is
not an "affiliate," as defined in Rule 405 under the Securities Act, of the
Company, (vi) if the undersigned is not a broker-dealer, that it is not
participating in, does not intend to participate in, and has no arrangement or
understanding with any person to participate in, the distribution of Exchange
Notes and (vii) if the undersigned is a broker-dealer that will receive Exchange
Notes for its own account in exchange for Private Notes that were acquired as a
result of market-making activities or other trading activities, it acknowledges
that it will deliver a prospectus meeting the requirements of the Securities Act
in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes received in respect of such
Private Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer; however, by so acknowledging and
by delivering a prospectus, the undersigned will not be deemed to admit that it
is an "underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act; (b) to agree, on
behalf of the undersigned, as set forth in the Letter of Transmittal; and (c) to
take such other action as necessary under the Prospectus or the Letter of
Transmittal to effect the valid tender of Private Notes.

                                    SIGN HERE

Name of Beneficial Owner(s):___________________________________________________
Signature(s):__________________________________________________________________
Name(s) (Please Print):________________________________________________________
Address:_______________________________________________________________________
Telephone Number:______________________________________________________________
Taxpayer Identification or Social Security Number:_____________________________
Date:__________________________________________________________________________



                                                             Exhibit 99.5


             GUIDELINES FOR CERTIFICATION OF TAXPAYER IDENTIFICATION
                          NUMBER ON SUBSTITUTE FORM W-9

     GUIDELINES FOR DETERMINING THE PROPER IDENTIFICATION NUMBER TO GIVE THE
PAYER. -- Social Security numbers have nine digits separated by two hyphens:
i.e. 000-00-0000. Employee identification numbers have nine digits separated by
only one hyphen: i.e. 00-0000000. The table below will help determine the number
to give the payer.

                                                GIVE THE SOCIAL SECURITY
FOR THIS TYPE OF ACCOUNT:                       NUMBER OF-

1.  An individual                               The individual
2.  Two or more individuals (joint account)     The actual owner of the 
                                                account or, if combined funds,
                                                any one of the individuals(1)
3.  Husband and wife (joint account)            The actual owner of the account
                                                or, if joint funds, either
                                                person(1)
4.  Custodian account of a minor                The minor(2)
    (Uniform Gift to Minors Act)
5.  Adult and minor (joint account)             The adult or, if the minor
                                                is the only contributor, the
                                                minor(1)
6.  Account in the name of guardian             The ward, minor, or incompetent 
    or committee for a designated               person(3)
    ward, minor, or incompetent person
7.  a. The usual revocable savings              The grantor-trustee
    trust account (grantor is also
    trustee)
    b. So-called trust account that
    is not a legal or valid trust
    under State law

                                                GIVE THE EMPLOYER
FOR THIS TYPE OF ACCOUNT:                       INDENTIFICATION NUMBER OF-

8.  Sole proprietorship account                 The Owner(4) 
9.  A valid trust, estate, or                   The Legal entity (Do not
    pension trust                               furnish the identifying
10. Corporate account                           number of the personal
11. Religious, charitable, or                   representative or trustee
    educational organization account            unless the legal entity
12. Partnership account held in the             itself is not designated in
    name of the business                        the account title.)(5)
13. Association, club, or other                 The corporation
    tax-exempt organization                     The organization
14. A broker or registered nominee
15. Account with the Department of              The partnership
    Agriculture in the name of a
    public entity (such as a State              The organization
    or local government, school
    district, or prison) that                   The broker or nominee
    receives agricultural program               The public entity
    payments

<PAGE>

(1)   List first and circle the name of the person whose number you furnish.
(2)   Circle the minor's name and furnish the minor's social security number.
(3)   Circle the ward's, minor's or incompetent person's name and furnish
      such person's social security number.
(4)   Show the name of the owner.
(5)   List first and circle the name of the legal trust, estate, or pension
      trust.

NOTE: If no name is circled when there is more than one name, the number will be
considered to be that of the first name listed.

OBTAINING A NUMBER

If you don't have a taxpayer identification number or you don't know your
number, obtain Form SS-5, Application for a Social Security Number Card, or Form
SS-4, Application for Employer Identification Number, at the local office of the
Social Security Administration or the Internal Revenue Service and apply for a
number.

PAYEES EXEMPT FROM BACKUP WITHHOLDING

     Payees specifically exempted from backup withholding on ALL payments
include the following:

- -    A corporation
- -    A financial institution
- -    An organization exempt from tax under section 501(a) or an individual 
     retirement plan.
- -    The United States or any agency or instrumentality thereof.
- -    A State, the District of Columbia, a possession of the United States, or 
     any subdivision or instrumentality thereof.
- -    A foreign government, a political subdivision of a foreign government, or 
     any agency or instrumentality thereof.
- -    An international organization or any agency, or instrumentality thereof.
- -    A registered dealer in securities or commodities registered in the U.S. or 
     a possession of the U.S.
- -    A real estate investment trust.
- -    A common trust fund operated by a bank under section 584(a).
- -    An exempt charitable remainder trust, or a nonexempt trust describe in 
     section 4947(a)(1).
- -    An entity registered at all times under the Investment Company Act of 1940.
- -    A foreign central bank of issue.

     Payments of dividends and patronage dividends not generally subject to
     backup withholding include the following:

- -    Payments to nonresident aliens subject to withholding under section 1441.
- -    Payments to partnerships not engaged in a trade or business in the U.S. 
     and which have at least one nonresident partner.
- -    Payments of patronage dividends where the amount received is not paid in 
     money.
- -    Payments made by a certain foreign organizations.
- -    Payments made to a nominee.

     Payments of interest not generally subject to backup withholding include 
     the following:

- -    Payments of Interest on obligations issued by individuals.  Note: You may 
     be subject to backup withholding if this interest is $600 or more and is 
     paid in the course of the payer's trade or business and you have not 
     provided your correct taxpayer identification number to the payer.
- -    Payments of tax-exempt interest (including exempt-interest dividends under 
     section 852). Payments described in section 6049(b)(5) to non-resident 
     aliens.
- -    Payments on tax-free covenant bonds under section 1451
- -    Payments made by certain foreign organizations.
- -    Payments made to a nominee.

Exempt Payees described above should file form W-9 to avoid possible
erroneous backup withholding. FILE THIS FORM WITH THE PAYER, FURNISH YOUR
TAXPAYER IDENTIFICATION NUMBER, WRITE "EXEMPT" ON THE FACE OF THE FORM, AND
RETURN IT TO THE PAYER. IF THE PAYMENTS ARE INTEREST, DIVIDENDS, OR PATRONAGE
DIVIDENDS, ALSO SIGN AND DATE THE FORM.

     Certain payments other than interest, dividends, and patronage dividends,
that are not subject to information reporting are also not subject to backup
withholding. For details, see the regulations under sections 6041, 6041(A)(a),
6045, and 6050A.

PRIVACY ACT NOTICE. -- Section 6109 requires most recipients of dividend,
interest or other payments to give taxpayer identification numbers to payers who
must report the payments to IRS. IRS uses the numbers for identification
purposes. Payers must be given the numbers whether or not recipients are
required to file tax returns. Beginning January 1, 1993, payers must generally
withhold 31% of taxable interest, dividend, and certain other payments to a
payee who does not furnish a taxpayer identification number to a payer. Certain
penalties may also apply.

PENALTIES

(1) PENALTIES FOR FAILURE TO FURNISH TAXPAYER IDENTIFICATION NUMBER. -- If
you fail to furnish your taxpayer identification number to a payer, you are
subject to a penalty of $50 for each such failure unless your failure is due to
a reasonable cause and not to willful neglect.

(2) FAILURE TO REPORT CERTAIN DIVIDEND AND INTEREST PAYMENTS. -- If you fail to
include any portion of an includible payment for interest, dividends, or
patronage dividends in gross income, such failure will be treated as being due
to negligence and will be subject to a penalty of 5% on any portion of an under-
payment attributable to that failure unless there is clear and convincing
evidence to the contrary.

(3) CIVIL PENALTY FOR FALSE INFORMATION WITH RESPECT TO WITHHOLDING -- If you
make a false statement with no reasonable basis which results in no imposition
of backup withholding, you are subject to a penalty of $500.

(4) CRIMINAL PENALTY FOR FALSIFYING INFORMATION. -- Falsifying certifications or
affirmations may subject you to criminal penalties including fines and/or
imprisonment.

                   FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION CONTACT YOUR TAX
                   CONSULTANT OR THE INTERNAL REVENUE SERVICE.



© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission